form20f_2011.htm
 


 

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

FORM 20-F

o REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934; or

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF
THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended August 31, 2011; or

o TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF
THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period ________ to ________; or

o SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF
THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
Date of event requiring this shell company report

Commission File No. 0-30895

EXFO INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Not Applicable
(Translation of Registrant’s name into English)

Canada
(Jurisdiction of Incorporation or organization)

400 Godin Avenue, Quebec, Quebec, G1M 2K2, Canada
(Address of principal executive offices)

Benoit Ringuette, (418) 683-0211, benoit.ringuette@exfo.com, (418) 683-9839, 400 Godin Avenue, Quebec, Quebec, G1M 2K2, Canada
(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of each class
Name of each exchange on which registered
Subordinate Voting Shares without par value
NASDAQ
Subordinate Voting Shares without par value
TSX

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

None

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:

None
 
 



 
 

 
 
As of August 31, 2011, the registrant had 28,621,999 Subordinate Voting Shares outstanding.

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.

Yes o  No x

If this report is an annual report or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15 (d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

Yes o No x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

Yes x No o

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).

Yes x No o

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

Large accelerated filer      o
Accelerated filer      x
Non-accelerated filer      o

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

U.S. GAAP      o
International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the      o
International Accounting Standards Board
Other      x

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.
Item 17 o Item 18 x

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).
 
Yes o        No x


 
 

 
 
 
TABLE OF CONTENTS

PART I

Item 1.                 Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisers

Item 2.                 Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable

Item 3.                 Key Information

Item 4.                 Information on the Company

Item 4A.              Unresolved Staff Comments

Item 5.                 Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

Item 6.                 Directors, Senior Management and Employees

Item 7.                 Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions

Item 8.                 Financial Information

Item 9.                 The Offer and Listing
 
Item 10.               Additional Information
                                      C.  


 
 

 
 
 
Item 11.               Qualitative and Quantitative Disclosures about Market Risk

Item 12.               Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities


PART II

Item 13.               Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies

Item 14.               Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds

Item 15.               Controls and Procedures
 
Item 16.               [Reserved]

Item 16A.            Audit Committee Financial Expert

Item 16B.            Code of Ethics

Item 16C.            Principal Accountant Fees and Services

Item 16D.            Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees

Item 16E.             Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers

Item 16F.             Change in Registrant's Certifying Accountant

Item 16G.             Corporate Governance


PART III

Item 17.               Financial Statements

Item 18.               Financial Statements

Item 19.               Exhibits
 


DISCLOSURE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING INFORMATION

This Annual Report contains or incorporates by reference statements which constitute forward-looking statements within the meaning of the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 and we intend that such forward-looking statements be subject to the safe harbors created thereby. Forward-looking statements are statements other than historical information or statements of current condition that refer to expectations, projections or other characterizations of future events and circumstances. They are not guarantees of future performance and involve risks and uncertainties. Actual results may differ materially from those in forward-looking statements due to various factors including those that are discussed under “Risk Factors” set forth in Item 3D of this Annual Report. Assumptions relating to forward-looking statements involve judgments and risks, all of which are difficult or impossible to predict and many of which are beyond our control. When used in this Annual Report, the words “believe”, “anticipate”, “plan”, “expect”, “intend”, “estimate” or similar expressions are intended to identify forward-looking statements, although not all forward-looking statements contain such identifying words. We believe that the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are reasonable based on information currently available to us, but we cannot assure you that the expectations will prove to have been correct. Accordingly, you should not place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements. These statements speak only as of the date of this document. Unless required by law or applicable regulations, we undertake no obligation to revise or update any of them to reflect events or circumstances that occur after the date of this document.

All dollar amounts in this Annual Report are expressed in US dollars, except as otherwise noted.



PART I.                      

Item 1.  
Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisers
 
           Not Applicable.


Item 2.  
Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable
 
           Not Applicable.


Item 3.  
Key Information
 
 A.  Selected Financial Data
 
The consolidated statements of earnings data for the years ended August 31, 2007 and 2008 and the consolidated balance sheets data as at August 31, 2007, 2008 and 2009 are derived from our audited consolidated financial statements not included in this Annual Report. The consolidated statements of earnings data for each of the three years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011 and the consolidated balance sheets data as at August 31, 2010 and 2011 are derived from our audited consolidated financial statements that are included elsewhere in this Annual Report.

Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in Canada (“Canadian GAAP”) and significant differences in measurement and disclosure from generally accepted accounting principles in United States (“U.S. GAAP”) are set out in note 22 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report. The historical results below are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for any future periods.
 


The selected financial data should be read in conjunction with our audited consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this Annual Report, and “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects” of this Annual Report.
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data)
 
Consolidated Statements of Earnings Data:
                             
Amounts under Canadian GAAP
                             
Sales                                                                  
  $ 269,743     $ 202,757     $ 153,082     $ 160,981     $ 129,839  
Cost of sales (1)
    100,296       73,901       57,897       64,364       53,896  
Gross margin
    169,447       128,856       95,185       96,617       75,943  
                                         
Operating expenses
                                       
Selling and administrative
    87,062       66,612       58,067       54,869       43,885  
Net research and development
    47,927       37,847       27,213       24,580       14,863  
Amortization of property, plant and equipment
    6,772       5,757       4,453       4,137       2,696  
Amortization of intangible assets
    9,183       7,773       5,033       3,862       2,861  
Restructuring charges
                963              
Government grants
                            (1,079 )
Impairment of goodwill
                21,713              
Total operating expenses
    150,944       117,989       117,442       87,448       63,226  
Earnings (loss) from operations
    18,503       10,867       (22,257 )     9,169       12,717  
Interest and other income (expenses)
    511       (292 )     592       4,381       4,676  
Foreign exchange gain (loss)
    (3,808 )     (1,496 )     1,074       404       (44 )
Earnings (loss) before income taxes
    15,206       9,079       (20,591 )     13,954       17,349  
Income tax expense (recovery)
    8,783       5,529       266       337       (20,825 )
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before extraordinary gain
    6,423       3,550       (20,857 )     13,617       38,174  
Net earnings from discontinued operations
    12,926       3,069       4,272       1,771       4,101  
Earnings (loss) before extraordinary gain
    19,349       6,619       (16,585 )     15,388       42,275  
Extraordinary gain
                      3,036        
Net earnings (loss) for the year
  $ 19,349     $ 6,619     $ (16,585 )   $ 18,424     $ 42,275  
Basic earnings (loss) from continuing operations before extraordinary gain per share
  $ 0.11     $ 0.06     $ (0.34 )   $ 0.20     $ 0.55  
Diluted earnings (loss) from continuing operations before extraordinary gain per share
  $ 0.10     $ 0.06     $ (0.34 )   $ 0.20     $ 0.55  
Basic net earnings from discontinued operations per share
  $ 0.22     $ 0.05     $ 0.07     $ 0.02     $ 0.06  
Diluted net earnings from discontinued operations per share
  $ 0.21     $ 0.05     $ 0.07     $ 0.02     $ 0.06  
Basic and diluted extraordinary gain per share
  $     $     $     $ 0.05     $  
Basic net earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.32     $ 0.11     $ (0.27 )   $ 0.27     $ 0.61  
Diluted net earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.31     $ 0.11     $ (0.27 )   $ 0.27     $ 0.61  
Basic weighted average number of shares used in per share calculations (000’s)
    60,000       59,479       61,845       68,767       68,875  
Diluted weighted average number of shares used in per share calculations (000’s)
    61,488       60,616       61,845       69,318       69,555  
Other consolidated statements of earnings data:
                                       
Gross research and development
  $ 57,226     $ 44,551     $ 33,584     $ 30,167     $ 23,396  
Net research and development
  $ 47,927     $ 37,847     $ 27,213     $ 24,580     $ 14,863  
Amounts under U.S. GAAP
                                       
Net earnings (loss) for the year
  $ 26,164     $ 3,777     $ (8,179 )   $ 18,424     $ 42,257  
Basic net earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.44     $ 0.06     $ (0.13 )   $ 0.27     $ 0.61  
Diluted net earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.43     $ 0.06     $ (0.13 )   $ 0.27     $ 0.61  
Basic weighted average number of shares used in per share calculations (000’s)
    60,000       59,479       61,845       68,767       68,875  
Diluted weighted average number of shares used in per share calculations (000’s)
    61,488       60,616       61,845       69,318       69,555  
 
   
As at August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(in thousands of US dollars)
 
Consolidated Balance Sheets Data:
                             
Amounts under Canadian GAAP
                             
Cash                                                                  
  $ 22,771     $ 21,440     $ 9,777     $ 5,329     $ 5,175  
Short-term investments
    47,091       10,379       59,105       81,626       124,217  
Total assets                                                                  
    321,086       273,502       240,371       293,066       279,138  
Long-term debt (excluding current portion)
    968       1,419                    
Share capital                                                                  
    110,341       106,126       104,846       142,786       150,019  
Shareholders’ equity                                                                  
  $ 263,746     $ 220,419     $ 208,045     $ 259,515     $ 250,165  
Amounts under U.S. GAAP
                                       
Cash                                                                  
  $ 22,771     $ 21,440     $ 9,777     $ 5,329     $ 5,175  
Short-term investments
    47,091       10,379       59,105       81,626       124,217  
Total assets                                                                  
    321,133       269,556       236,492       280,426       268,389  
Long-term debt (excluding current portion)
    968       1,419                    
Share capital                                                                  
    422,837       418,622       417,342       568,917       599,519  
Shareholders’ equity                                                                  
  $ 263,382     $ 213,740     $ 204,093     $ 246,802     $ 239,343  
 
(1)  
The cost of sales is exclusive of amortization, shown separately.
 
 
 
 B.  Capitalization and Indebtedness
 
Not Applicable.
 
 
 C.  Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds
 
Not Applicable.
 
 
 D.  Risk Factors
 
Fluctuations in the exchange rates between the Canadian dollar, US dollar, euro and other currencies may adversely affect our operating results.
 
Most of our sales are denominated in US dollars and euros. However, a significant portion of our cost of goods sold, operating expenses and capital expenditures are denominated in Canadian dollars and foreign currencies such as euros, British Pounds, Rupee (India) and Renminbi (China). As a result, even though we manage to some extent our exposure to currency risks with forward exchange contracts (by selling US dollars for Canadian dollars) and certain operating expenses denominated in currencies other than the Canadian dollar, we are exposed to fluctuations in the exchange rates between the US dollar on one hand and the Canadian dollar, euro and other currencies on the other. For example, the average exchange rate of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar was 0.9894 in fiscal 2011 compared to 1.0446 in fiscal 2010, resulting in an increase of 5.6% of our Canadian-based costs year-over-year when reported in US dollars. Any further decrease in the value of the US dollar relative to the Canadian dollar and other currencies, or any unfavorable variance between the value of the Canadian dollar and the contractual rates of our forward exchange contracts, could have a material adverse effect on our operating results and provide competitive advantages to our competitors.
 
Our business and operating results could be adversely affected by unfavorable macro-economic and market conditions and resulting reductions in capital and operating expenditures by our customers.
 
Broad macro-economic weakness previously resulted in sustained periods of decreased demand for our products and services that have adversely affected our operating results. In response to these conditions, many of our customers significantly reduced their capital and operating expenditures as they sought to conserve capital, reduce debt or address uncertainties or changes in their own business models. We continue to experience cautious spending among our customers following the 2009 global economic recession and remain uncertain as to how long these macro-economic and market conditions will persist, the pace of recovery, and the magnitude of the impact of these market conditions on our business and results of operations.
 
Continued or increasingly adverse economic and market conditions could result in:
 
·  
Difficulty forecasting, budgeting and planning due to the uncertain spending plans of current or prospective customers;
 
·  
Increased competition for fewer network projects and sales opportunities;
 
·  
Increased pricing pressure that may adversely affect revenue and gross margin;
 
·  
Higher cost structure compared to revenue level;
 
·  
Increased risk of charges related to excess and obsolete inventories and the write off of other intangible assets and
 
·  
Customer financial difficulty and increased difficulty in collecting accounts receivable.
 
Our business and operating results could be materially affected by periods of unfavorable macro-economic and market conditions, globally or specific to a particular region where we operate, and any resulting reductions in the level of capital and operating expenditures by our customers.
 

 
We must continue to overcome significant competition in our targeted industries in order to gain market share and achieve our growth strategy.
 
The market for our business activity ─ namely designing, manufacturing, marketing and selling telecommunications test and service assurance equipment for fixed and mobile networks ─ is rapidly evolving and is marked by intense competition and technical innovation. In addition, we are facing new competitors in the wireless test sector following our acquisition of NetHawk Oyj in March 2010. We anticipate the pace of change to remain high or even accelerate for our targeted industries in the future. We might see the emergence of new competitors or the consolidation of current competitors, as the market for telecommunications test and service assurance equipment evolves in response to technical innovations and economic conditions.
 
Main competitors in the test environment include global suppliers like Anritsu Corporation, JDS Uniphase Corporation, and Yokogawa Electric Corporation, as well as niche players like Fluke (an operating division within Danaher Corporation), IXIA and VeEX Inc. On the service assurance side, we mainly compete against Anritsu Corporation, Ineoquest Technologies, Inc., JDS Uniphase Corporation, NetScout Systems, Inc., Spirent Communications plc, and Tektronix, Inc., (an operating division within Danaher Corporation).
 
Some competitors may have greater financial, technical and/or marketing resources than us. Consequently, they may be able to devote greater resources to the development, marketing, manufacturing, selling and support of their products in order to capture market share.
 
Competitors also may be better positioned than us to capture market share or to acquire companies and new technologies that would potentially displace our products or render them obsolete. We cannot predict whether current or future competitors will develop or market products that offer higher performance, more features, or are more cost-effective than our current or future products. To remain competitive and achieve our growth strategy, we must increase our sales and develop cost-effective products and product enhancements that offer higher performance and more functionality, in current and new sectors, so that we can increase our market share. Our failure to do so may harm our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
We have faced pricing pressure on our existing products and expect that this pressure will continue. If we do not keep lowering our manufacturing costs or introducing new products with higher margins, our gross margin may decrease and our operating results may be adversely affected.
 
We continue to implement measures to attempt to protect our gross margin, despite sharp fluctuations between the US and Canadian currencies in recent years. Iincreased competition in the telecommunications test and service assurance industry, along with consolidation among competitors and customers, will likely result in ongoing downward pressure on average selling prices. This, in turn, may negatively affect our gross margin. Pricing pressure can result from a number of factors such as:
 
·  
increased competition for business;
·  
reduced demand;
·  
limited number of potential customers;
·  
competition from companies with lower production costs, including companies operating in lower-cost environments;
·  
introduction of new products by competitors;
·  
greater economies of scale for higher-volume competitors;
·  
large customers, who buy in high volumes, can exert substantial negotiating leverage over us; and
·  
resale of used equipment.
 
In addition, our gross margin may be negatively affected by fluctuations between the US and Canadian currencies, increased costs of raw materials, obsolescence and excess costs, product and customer mix, and under-absorption of fixed manufacturing costs.
 

 
As pricing pressure will likely continue to affect our existing products, we may have to increase the number of units sold to maintain our existing sales levels. If we are unable to increase our sales levels, lower our manufacturing costs, or introduce new products with higher margins, our gross margin may decline and our operating results may suffer.
 
We may not be able to make the acquisitions or strategic alliances needed for the development of our business or, if we do make such acquisitions or strategic alliances, we cannot assure you that we will successfully integrate the businesses, products, technologies and personnel.
 
We intend to carefully seek businesses, whose products and technologies are complementary to ours, or which will enable us to expand our markets and/or our market share. There can be no assurance that we will ultimately make any such transactions. Our competitors may be in a better position to acquire the same businesses, products and technologies that we wish to acquire. Our fluctuating stock price, cash position, or ability to raise capital or issue debt on favorable terms at the time of an acquisition may affect our ability to complete such an acquisition. In addition, such acquisitions could distract management’s attention from our day-to-day business and operations.
 
In the event of any future acquisition, we could:
 
·  
issue shares that would dilute individual shareholder percentage ownership;
·  
incur debt;
·  
assume liabilities and commitments;
·  
incur significant expenses related to acquisition costs;
·  
incur significant expenses related to amortization of additional intangible assets;
·  
incur significant impairment losses of goodwill and intangible assets related to such acquisitions; and
·  
incur losses from operations.
 
These deals could also involve numerous risks, including:
 
·  
the risk of not realizing the expected benefits or synergies of such acquisitions;
·  
problems integrating the acquired operations, technologies, products and personnel;
·  
risks associated with the transfer of acquired know-how and technology;
·  
unanticipated costs or liabilities;
·  
diversion of management’s attention from our core business;
·  
adverse effects on existing business relationships with suppliers and customers;
·  
risks associated with entering markets in which we have no or limited prior experience; and
·  
potential loss of key employees, particularly those of acquired organizations.
 
Ultimately, the failure to make strategic acquisitions or the inability to effectively integrate them could disrupt our overall business and harm our financial condition.
 
If we fail to adapt appropriately to the challenges associated with operating internationally, the expected growth of our business may be impeded and our operating results may be affected.
 
For the fiscal year ended August 31, 2011, customers outside of the United States and Canada accounted for 55.4% of our sales. Our international sales will be limited if we cannot establish and maintain relationships with international distributors, set up additional foreign operations, expand international sales channel management, hire additional personnel, develop relationships with international network operators and network equipment manufacturers, and operate adequate after-sales support internationally.
 
Even if we are able to successfully operate and expand our international operations, we may not be able to maintain or increase international market demand for our products. Our international operations are subject to a number of risks, including:
 

 
·  
challenges in staffing and managing foreign operations due to the limited number of qualified candidates, employment laws and business practices in foreign countries, any of which could increase the cost and reduce the efficiency of operating in foreign countries;
·  
fluctuations among currencies;
·  
our inability to comply with import/export, environmental and other trade compliance regulations of the countries in which we do business, together with unexpected changes in such regulations;
·  
measures to ensure that we design, implement and maintain adequate controls over our financial processes and reporting in the future;
·  
failure to adhere to laws, regulations and contractual obligations relating to customer contracts in various countries;
·  
difficulties in establishing and enforcing our intellectual property rights;
·  
inability to maintain a competitive list of distributors for indirect sales;
·  
tariffs and other trade barriers;
·  
economic instability in foreign markets;
·  
wars, acts of terrorism and political unrest;
·  
language and cultural barriers;
·  
lack of integration of foreign operations;
·  
potential foreign and domestic tax consequences;
·  
technology standards that differ from those on which our products are based, which could require expensive redesign and retention of personnel familiar with those standards;
·  
longer accounts receivable payment cycles and possible difficulties in collecting payments which may increase our operating costs and hurt our financial performance; and
·  
failure to meet certification requirements.
 
Any of these factors could harm our international operations and negatively affect our business, results of operations and financial condition. The recurrence of weakness in these economies or of weakness in other foreign economies could have a significant negative effect on our future operating results.
 
Our reliance on software development resources in India and manufacturing personnel in China may expose us to unanticipated costs or liabilities.
 
In fiscal 2007, we established a software development center in Pune, India, to supplement the efforts of our R&D centers in Quebec City, Canada, Montreal, Canada, Concord, Canada, and Boston, United States. In addition, in fiscal 2008, we began manufacturing high-volume, low-complexity telecom products at our wholly-owned production facility in Shenzhen, China, with the goal of lowering our manufacturing costs. Following the acquisition of NetHawk Oyj in 2010, we further expanded our R&D development operations with activities at Bhubaneswar in India. Over the years, we have significantly increased headcount as well as software development and manufacturing activities in India and China, respectively.
 
There is no assurance that our reliance on software development resources in India and manufacturing personnel in China will enable us to maintain our cost structure at current levels, achieve additional cost reductions, or generate greater resource efficiency. Furthermore, our software development and manufacturing efforts abroad involve significant risks in addition to the ones disclosed in previous risk factors:
 
·  
difficulty hiring and retaining appropriate engineering and manufacturing resources due to intense competition for such resources and resulting wage inflation;
·  
exposure to misappropriation of intellectual property and proprietary information;
·  
heightened exposure to changes in the economic, regulatory, security, and political conditions of these countries;
·  
fluctuations in currency exchange rates and tax compliance in India and China;
·  
cash management and repatriation of profit; and
·  
high inflation rates which could increase our operating costs.
 

 
Our intellectual property and proprietary technology are important to the continued success of our business. Our failure to protect this proprietary technology may significantly impair our competitive position.
 
Our success and ability to compete depend to a significant extent on our proprietary technology, with which we attempt to keep others from using the innovations that are central to our existing and future products. As of August 31, 2011, our records indicate that we held 34 actively-maintained granted patents from the U.S., 14 patents in Finland, 7 patents in Canada, 4 patents in China, 9 patents in Germany (including one “Utility Model”), 8 patents in the United Kingdom, 8 patents in France, 4 patents in Italy, 4 patents in Sweden and one patent in Russia, as well as one patent in each of three other European countries. In addition, we have 24 patent applications pending in the U.S, 8 in Canada, 6 in China, one in Australia, one in Japan, one in Korea, one in India and 10 regional applications pending in Europe, and as well as 4 International Applications under the Patent Cooperation Treaty, which have not yet entered the national/regional phase.  We also rely on a combination of copyright and trademark laws, trade secrets, confidentiality procedures, contractual provisions and license agreements to protect our proprietary technology. We may have to engage in litigation or formal Opposition Proceedings in order to protect our patents and other intellectual property rights, or to determine the validity or scope of the proprietary rights of others. Such litigation and Opposition Proceedings can be time-consuming and expensive, regardless of whether we win or lose.
 
The process of seeking patent protection can be long and expensive and we cannot be certain that any currently pending or future applications will actually result in issued patents, or that, even if patents are issued, they will be of sufficient scope or strength to provide meaningful protection or any commercial advantage to us. We also rely on trade secret protection for our technology, in part through confidentiality agreements with our employees, consultants, distributors and third parties. However, these agreements may be breached or otherwise not effective and we may not have adequate remedies for any breach or shortfall of these agreements. In any case, others may come to know about our trade secrets through a variety of methods. In addition, the laws of some jurisdictions in which we sell our products may not protect our intellectual property rights to the same extent as do the laws of Canada and the United States.
 
Our intellectual property rights, particularly our existing or future patents, may be invalidated, circumvented, challenged or required to be licensed to others.
 
Our intellectual property rights are important assets for us. Various events outside of our control pose a threat to our intellectual property rights, as well as to our products, services and technologies. For example, effective intellectual property protection may not be available in every country in which our products and services are distributed. Also, the efforts we have taken to protect our proprietary rights may not be sufficient or effective.
 
Furthermore, others may develop technologies that are similar or superior to our technology, duplicate or reverse engineer our technology, or design around the patents owned or licensed by us. We cannot be sure that the steps that we take to protect our technology will prevent misappropriation or infringement. If we fail to protect our technology so that others may copy or use it, we will be less able to differentiate our products and our sales may decline.
 
Others may claim that our products infringe upon their intellectual property rights, or they may infringe our intellectual property, and we may expend significant resources enforcing or defending our rights or suffer competitive injury.
 
Litigation regarding intellectual property rights is common in the technology industry and third-party infringement claims involving technologies may increase. If an infringement claim is filed against us, we may be prevented from using some of our technologies and may incur significant costs to resolve the claim. Conversely, we may be required to spend significant resources to monitor and enforce our intellectual property rights.
 

 
We could incur substantial costs in defending ourselves and our customers against infringement claims or in bringing infringement claims against others. Litigation could also adversely affect sales of the challenged product or technology and divert the efforts of our management and technical personnel. In the event of an infringement claim, we may be required to obtain one or more licenses from third parties. We cannot assure you that we, or our customers, could obtain necessary licenses from third parties at a reasonable cost or at all. If we fail to obtain a license where one is required, we could incur substantial liabilities and be forced to suspend the marketing of the challenged products.
 
Our products may have unforeseen defects that could harm our reputation, impede market acceptance of our products and negatively impact our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
Given their complexity, our products may contain undetected software or hardware defects, inaccurate calibration or compatibility problems, or regulatory compliance issues, particularly when they are first introduced or when new versions are released. There can be no assurance that, despite our testing and diligent efforts, defects will not be found in new products after they have been fully deployed and operated under peak stress conditions, or that customized products will meet customer sign-off acceptance requirements. If we are unable to fix defects or other problems or meet custom requirements, we could experience, among other things:
 
·  
costly repairs;
·  
product returns or recalls;
·  
damage to our brand reputation;
·  
loss of customers, failure to attract new customers or achieve market acceptance;
·  
diversion of development and engineering resources;
·  
legal actions by our customers, including claims for consequential damages and loss of profits; and
·  
legal actions by governmental entities, including actions to impose product recalls and/or forfeitures.
 
The occurrence of any one or more of the foregoing could seriously harm our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
We may make misjudgments in our strategic planning that could have material adverse effects on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
We devise a three-year strategic business plan, which is prepared by management and approved by our Board of Directors. This strategic plan, reviewed by management on a regular basis, is mainly based on market research and analysis related to future market trends and demands. In our strategic plan, we have made and will continue to make judgments based on our analysis of future market trends and customer requirements. These decisions may involve substantial investments in the development of new product lines, diversification of our business on a geographic basis, as well as expansion into new market segments — either organically or through acquisitions. We may make misjudgments in our strategic planning that could have material adverse effects on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
Our quarterly revenues and operating results are subject to significant fluctuations and you should not rely on them as an indication of our future performance.
 
Our sales and operating results have fluctuated from quarter to quarter in the past and significant fluctuations may occur in the future. Given that we’re increasingly selling service assurance and wireless test systems that vary in size and complexity and in certain instances require customer acceptance before revenue recognition occurs, our sales may fluctuate significantly on a quarterly basis. Many of our deals involve lengthy sales cycles, and contract negotiations, as well as extensive product testing, laboratory or network certification, including network-specific or region-specific processes.
 

 
In addition, our sales and operating results generally depend on the volume and timing of the orders we receive from customers as well as our ability to fulfill received orders. Our operating expenses, which include manufacturing overhead costs, selling and administrative, research and development, and amortization expenses, are relatively fixed in the short term. If we sell fewer products than anticipated, if there is a delay in the launch of new products, or if prices for our products decline, we may not be able to quickly reduce our operating expenses in response to lower sales. Factors that could affect the amount and timing of our sales, and cause quarterly fluctuations in our revenue and operating results include:
 
·  
length of the sales cycle for certain products, especially those that are higher priced and more complex;
·  
sales cycle prolonged by lengthy customer acceptance;
·  
timing of product launches and market acceptance of new products for us as well as our competitors;
·  
our ability to sustain product volumes and high levels of quality across all product lines;
·  
timing of shipments for large orders;
·  
effect of seasonality on sales and bookings; and
·  
losing key accounts and not successfully developing new ones.
 
Our sales and operating results could also be volatile due to the following factors, some of which we have little or no control over:
 
·  
fluctuating demand for telecommunications test and service assurance equipment;
·  
changes in the capital spending and operating budgets of our customers, which may cause seasonal or other fluctuations in product mix, volume, timing and number of orders we receive from our customers;
·  
order cancellations or rescheduled delivery dates;
·  
pricing changes by our competitors or suppliers;
·  
variations in the mix between higher and lower-margin products and services;
·  
customer bankruptcies and difficulties in collecting accounts receivable;
·  
restructuring and impairment charges;
·  
foreign exchange rate fluctuations; and
·  
general economic conditions, including a slowdown or recession.
 
We may in the future choose to reduce prices, increase spending, or modify our product portfolio in response to actions by competitors or as an effort to pursue new market opportunities. These actions may also adversely affect our business and operating results and may cause our quarterly results to be lower than the results of previous quarters. Due to these factors, you should not rely on quarter-to-quarter comparisons of our results of operations as an indication of our future performance.
 
If we are unable to adapt to current and future changes in technology or if we are unable to introduce new and enhanced products on a timely basis, our products may become obsolete, which could prevent us from achieving our growth strategy and adversely affect our operating results.
 
The industries that we target are characterized by rapidly evolving technology and industry standards that result in frequent new product introductions. Any failure by us to anticipate or respond to new technological developments, customer requirements or evolving standards could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. The development of proprietary technology entails significant technical and business risks and requires substantial expenditures and lead times. The success of our new product introductions will depend on several factors, including our ability to:
 
·  
properly identify and anticipate customer needs;
·  
innovate and develop new products;
·  
gain timely market acceptance for new products;
·  
manufacture and deliver our new products on time, in sufficient volume and with adequate quality;
·  
price our products competitively;
·  
continue investing in our research and development programs; and
·  
anticipate competitors’ announcements of new products.
 
 
 
9

 
 
Failure to do the above could be exploited by our competitors. If we lose market share as a result of lapses in our product development, our business would suffer.
 
If customers fail to meet their financial commitments to us, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
Some of our customers experienced cash flow problems during the global economic recession in 2009 and may continue to do so. Consequently, our customers may delay payments or may not be able to meet their financial commitments to us. Furthermore, they may not order as many products from us as originally forecasted or they may cancel their orders outright. The failure of customers to meet their financial commitments to us or a material decrease in sales would result in decreased revenues for us, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
As our customers consolidate, they may reduce or halt purchases of our products, which would harm our sales and operating results.
 
Consolidation in the telecommunications industry could reduce the number of customers to which our products are sold. Some of our customers have been subject to consolidation and could obtain products from a vendor other than us, or demand more favorable terms and conditions from us, which would harm our sales and operating results. In addition, some customers may merge with or acquire our competitors and discontinue their relationships with us.
 
If we fail to predict our supply requirements accurately, we may have excess inventory or insufficient inventory, either of which could cause us to incur additional costs and/or experience manufacturing delays.
 
We provide non-binding forecasts of our requirements to some of our suppliers up to six months prior to scheduled delivery of products to our customers. If we overestimate our forecasted requirements, we may have excess inventory, which could harm our relationships with our suppliers due to reduced future orders, increase our costs and require inventory write-offs. If we underestimate our requirements, we may have an inadequate inventory of parts, which could interrupt manufacturing of our products and result in shipment delays. In addition, lead times for our raw materials and parts may be long and depend on factors such as the procedures of, or supply terms with, a specific supplier, worldwide demand for each part at a given time, or the onset of a natural disaster.
 
We depend on a single supplier or a limited number of suppliers for some key components and materials in our products, which makes us susceptible to supply shortages or price fluctuations that could adversely affect our operating results.
 
We depend on a limited number of suppliers for some of the parts used to manufacture our products for which alternative sources may not be readily available. In addition, all our orders are placed through individual purchase orders and, therefore, our suppliers may stop supplying parts to us at any time. The reliance on a single source or limited number of suppliers could result in increased costs, delivery problems and reduced control over product pricing and quality, as well as stockpiling critical parts. Following the natural disaster in Japan in March 2011, for example, we increased our inventory of critical parts from certain Japanese single-source suppliers to ensure that we were able to deliver our products to customers without interruption.
 
Financial difficulties of suppliers could also affect our ability to obtain necessary parts in a timely manner. Any interruption or delay in the supply of any of these parts could significantly harm our ability to meet scheduled product deliveries to our customers and cause us to lose sales. Furthermore, the process of qualifying a new manufacturer for complex parts designed to our specifications, such as our optical and mechanical parts, is lengthy and would consume a substantial amount of time of our technical personnel and management. If we were required to change a supplier in a short period of time, our business would be disrupted. In addition, we may be unsuccessful in identifying a new supplier capable of meeting and willing to meet our needs on acceptable terms. Consolidation involving suppliers could further reduce the number of alternatives available to us and increase the cost of parts, which would make our products less competitive and result in lower margins.
 


If we fail to maintain an effective system of internal controls, we may not be able to accurately report our financial information or prevent fraud, which could harm our operating results and cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial information.
 
Effective internal controls are necessary for us to provide reliable and accurate financial information and effectively prevent fraud. We devote significant resources and time to comply with the internal control over financial reporting requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. In addition, Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 requires that we assess and that our auditors attest to the design and operating effectiveness of our controls over financial reporting. Our compliance with the annual internal control report requirement for each fiscal year will depend on the effectiveness of our financial reporting as well as data systems and controls throughout our company and operating subsidiaries. Furthermore, we cannot be certain that these measures will ensure that we design, implement and maintain adequate controls over our financial processes and reporting in the future, especially in the event of acquiring companies that are not in compliance with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. As well, the complexity of our systems and controls may become more difficult to manage as we transform our operating structure and continue to reduce infrastructure costs. To effectively manage these changes, we will need to continue to improve our operational, financial and management controls and our reporting systems and procedures. Any failure to implement required new or improved controls, difficulties encountered in their implementation or operation, or difficulties in the assimilation of acquired businesses into our control system, could harm our operating results or cause it to fail to meet our financial reporting obligations. Inferior internal controls could also cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial information, which could have a negative effect on our share price and our access to capital.
 
Regulatory changes may cause us to incur increased costs.
 
Changes in the laws and regulations affecting public companies may increase our expenses as we may have to devote resources to respond to these new requirements. In particular, we incurred and may incur additional general administrative expenses to comply with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, which requires management to report on internal controls over financial reporting. In addition, the process of moving from Canadian GAAP to IFRS, which comes into effect in the first quarter of fiscal 2012, will require additional management time and attention, and may cause our general and administrative expenses to increase. Compliance with new rules could require the further commitment of significant financial resources and result in the diversion of management’s time and attention from revenue-generating activities. Finally, the impact of these changes could make it more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified persons to serve on our Board of Directors or as executive officers, which could harm our business.
 
We require employees and managers who are knowledgeable about the specialized nature of our business. If we are unable to attract and retain sufficient numbers of highly skilled technical, sales, marketing, senior management and other personnel, our operations and financial results will suffer.
 
Due to the specialized nature of our business, we are highly dependent on the continued service of and on our ability to attract qualified engineering, sales, marketing, senior management and other personnel. If we are unable to attract and retain such qualified personnel, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
We must also provide significant training for our employee base due to the highly specialized nature of the telecommunications test and service assurance industry. Our current personnel may be inadequate and we may fail to assimilate and train new employees. Highly skilled employees with the education and training that we require – especially employees with significant experience and expertise in international business development, product management, sales, engineering and operations – may be difficult to find. Once trained, our employees may also be hired by our competitors or leave the organization.
 


Our insurance may not be sufficient to cover all potential liability. A successful claim exceeding our policy limits will reduce our cash position, increase our expenses and have a negative effect on our business, operating results and financial condition.
 
Our products are designed to help network operators, network equipment manufacturers, cable operators and component manufacturers ensure network reliability. The failure of our products to perform to customer expectations could give rise to product liability and warranty claims. We carry insurance for product liability and take accounting reserves for warranty claims that we consider adequate in view of industry practice.
 
In addition, we may face other types of claims by third parties in relation to the conduct of our business; a successful claim against us for an amount exceeding our policy limits would force us to use our own resources to pay the claim, which could result in a reduction of our cash available for other uses, increase our expenses and have a negative effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
Our reported financial results could suffer if there are charges related to impairment of goodwill or of intangible assets.
 
We are required to test annually and review, when events or circumstances warrant, our goodwill related to business combinations, and determine if impairment has occurred. Intangible assets are also reviewed for impairment at each reporting date whether there is an indication that an asset may be impaired. As at August 31, 2011, we had $30.9 million of goodwill and $16.7 million of intangible assets on our balance sheet related to the acquisitions of Brix Networks and NetHawk Oyj.
 
The turmoil in credit markets and in the broader economy has contributed to share price and volume fluctuations in global stock markets that have reduced the market price of many technology stocks, including ours in fiscal 2009. In addition, in fiscal 2011, our stock price has experienced substantial volatility as the stock market experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations. Our stock price may remain volatile in the future. Future discounted cash flows may be lower than expected or our stock price may decrease, which may lead to goodwill impairment in the future. In addition, discounted cash flows may be lower than expected, which may cause the recoverable amount of certain intangible assets to be lower than their carrying value. Consequently, this could result in future intangible asset impairment. Any additional impairment of goodwill or of intangible assets would negatively impact our operating results. In fiscal 2009, we recorded a pre-tax impairment charge of $21.7 million. We performed our last impairment test of goodwill on the third quarter of fiscal 2011.
 
We may become involved in costly and time-consuming litigation that may substantially increase our costs and harm our business.
 
We may from time to time become involved in various lawsuits and legal proceedings. For example, we are a defendant in a putative securities class action suit filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York involving approximately 300 other issuing companies. Litigation is subject to inherent uncertainties, and an adverse result in these or other matters that may arise from time to time could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition. Any litigation to which we are subject could require significant involvement of our senior management and may divert management attention from our business and operations.
 
If we suffer loss to our factories or facilities, our operations could be seriously harmed.
 
Our factories and facilities are subject to catastrophic losses due to fire, vandalism, terrorism or other natural or man-made disasters. We do not have redundant multiple-site capacity and if any of our facilities or factories were to experience a catastrophic loss, it would disrupt our operations, delay production, shipments and revenue and result in large expenses, thereby harming our results of operation.
 

 
Unexpected declines in our research and development and other tax credits and grants may have an adverse effect on our business.
 
Our historical operating results reflect substantial benefits from programs sponsored by federal and provincial governments for the support of research and development activities, as well as in relation to other activities. In addition, newly acquired NetHawk Oyj is entitled to government grants from a Finnish technology organization for research and development activities conducted in Finland.  Altogether, research and development tax credits and grants represented 16.2% of our gross research and development expenses for the year ended August 31, 2011.
 
If changes in laws or government policies terminate or adversely modify the Canadian and Quebec government programs or the Finnish government program, under which we receive the majority of our research and development and other tax credits and grants, or if we unexpectedly become unable to participate in or take advantage of these programs, then our net research and development and other expenses will materially increase or we may decrease our research and development activities. In addition, to the extent that we increase our research and development activities in India, or potentially acquire new companies, our increased R&D activities may not be eligible for these programs. If we were required to decrease our research and development activities, or were unable to benefit from other tax credits and grants, this could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
Changes in our effective tax rate or adverse outcomes resulting from tax audits may have an adverse impact on our results.
 
As an international corporation, we are subject to taxation in the various jurisdictions in which we conduct business. Significant judgment is required in the determination of our worldwide provision for income taxes and this determination requires the interpretation and application of complex tax laws and regulations. Our effective tax rate may be adversely impacted by the level of earnings, by changes in the mix of earnings among companies and countries which may have different statutory tax rates, by the valuation of our deferred tax assets, and by changes in tax rules and regulations. We are also subject to income tax audits and transfer pricing audits in the respective jurisdictions in which we conduct business and we regularly assess the likelihood of adverse outcomes resulting from these audits to ascertain the adequacy of our provisions for income taxes and transfer pricing policies. There can be no assurance that the outcomes of these tax audits, if any, will not have an adverse impact on our result and financial condition.
 
Our current principal stockholder has effective control over our business.
 
As of November 1, 2011, Germain Lamonde, our Chairman of the Board, President and Chief Executive Officer, held 92.85% of the voting rights in our stock. By virtue of such stock ownership, Mr. Lamonde has effective control over all matters submitted to our stockholders, including the election of our Directors, and exercises significant control over our policies and affairs. Such concentration of voting power could have the effect of delaying, deterring or preventing a change in control or other business combinations that might otherwise be beneficial to our stockholders and may harm the market price of our shares.
 
If we complete major acquisitions of complementary businesses, products or technologies, we may need additional capital, and may not be able to raise additional capital on favorable terms or at all, which could limit our ability to grow and could increase our costs.
 
Our future liquidity and capital requirements are difficult to predict because they depend on numerous factors, including the success of our existing and new product offerings as well as competing technology and market developments. As a result, we may not be able to generate sufficient cash flows from our operations to meet additional working capital requirements, support additional capital expenditures or take advantage of acquisition opportunities. As at August 31, 2011, we held $69.9 million in cash and short-term investments.
 

 
We may need to raise additional capital in the future. Our ability to obtain additional financing will be subject to a number of factors, including market conditions, effects of the financial crisis, reduced access to credit facilities and our operating performance. These factors may render the timing, amount, terms and conditions of additional financing unattractive for us. If we raise additional funds by selling equity securities, the relative ownership of our existing investors could be diluted or new investors could obtain terms more favorable than previous investors. If we raise funds through debt financing, we could incur significant borrowing costs and be required to meet more restrictive debt covenants. If we are unable to raise additional funds when needed or at terms satisfactory to us, our ability to operate and grow our business could be impeded.
 
Our business and operations would suffer in the event of a failure of our information technology infrastructure.
 
We rely upon the capacity, efficiency and security of our information technology hardware and software infrastructures as well as our ability to expand and update these infrastructures in response to our evolving needs. Any failure to manage, expand or update our information technology infrastructures or any failure in the operation of this infrastructure could harm our business.
 
Our information systems are vulnerable to damages from computer viruses, natural disasters, unauthorized access and other similar disruptions. Any system failure, accident or security breach could result in disruptions to our operations. To the extent that any disruption or security breach results in a loss or damage to our data, or inappropriate disclosure of our confidential information, it could harm our business. In addition, these events may force us to devote more money and resources in order to protect ourselves against damages caused by these disruptions or security breaches in the future.
 
Our stock price is volatile.
 
Our stock price has experienced substantial volatility in the past and may remain volatile in the future. Volatility in our stock price can arise from a number of factors discussed in this “Risk Factors” section. During fiscal 2011, our closing stock price ranged from a high of US$12.96 per share to a low of US$5.28 per share. The stock market has experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations that have affected the market price of many technology companies, with such volatility often unrelated to the operating performance of these companies. Divergence between our actual or anticipated financial results and published expectations of analysts can cause significant swings in our stock price. Our stock price can also be affected by announcements that we, our competitors, or our customers may make, particularly announcements related to acquisitions or significant transactions. These factors, as well as conditions affecting the general economy or financial markets, may materially affect our stock price in the future.
 


Item 4.  
Information on the Company
 
 A.  History and Development of the Company
 
Our legal name and commercial name is EXFO Inc. / EXFO inc. Our head office is located at 400 Godin Avenue, Quebec, Quebec, Canada, G1M 2K2 and our main telephone number is (418) 683-0211. Our e-mail address is info@EXFO.com and our website is www.EXFO.com. Information on our website is not incorporated by reference in this Annual Report. Our agent for service in the United States is CT Corporation System, 111 Eighth Avenue, New York, New York 10011. Our Transfer Agent and Registrar is Canadian Stock Transfer Inc. (CST) as administrative agent for CIBC Mellon Trust Company, 2001 University Street, Suite 1600, Montreal, Quebec, Canada, H3A 2A6. This Annual Report contains trademarks and registered trademarks of us and other companies.
 
We were incorporated in Canada on September 18, 1985 pursuant to the Canada Business Corporations Act. Since that date, we have amended our articles on various occasions mainly to modify our legal and corporate names and our share capital.
 
Since we are using this Form 20-F as an annual report, we have provided the required information herein for the period beginning as at September 1, 2010 until the date of this Annual Report. For information responsive to this Item 4A for prior periods, please refer to our previously filed Annual Reports on Form 20-F.
 
In September 2010 and in April 2011, we purchased premises in Magarpatta, Pune, India, and in July 2011 we finalized the relocation of our R&D activities previously based in Wadgaon Sheri, Pune, India to these new premises in Magarpatta, Pune, India.
 
On October 1, 2010, we announced and closed the sale of our Life Sciences and Industrial Division for total net proceeds of $21.6 million. As such, this Division has been presented as discontinued operations in our consolidated financial statements. Assets and liabilities for the comparative year ended August 31, 2010 have been reclassified as assets held for sale and liabilities related to assets held for sale; revenues and expenses have been classified as discontinued operations for all years presented. The Life Sciences and Industrial Division included the operations of EFOS Inc. (renamed EXFO Photonic Solutions Inc.), acquired in March 2001 for its precision light-based, adhesive spot-curing technology as well as most of the operations of Burleigh Instruments, Inc. (renamed EXFO Burleigh Products Group Inc.), acquired in December 2000 for its wavelength measurement instruments and nanopositioning alignment systems, which were consolidated since then with those of EXFO Photonic Solutions Inc. The operations of that Division were located in Toronto, Canada.
 
On November 5, 2010 we announced that our Board of Directors approved the renewal of our share repurchase program, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market of up to 10% of our public float (as defined by the Toronto Stock Exchange), or 2.0 million of subordinate voting shares at the prevailing market price. We repurchased for cancellation 34,946 shares under that program for an aggregate net purchase price of $203,521.
 
In June 2011, we undertook the construction of a new building in Montreal, Canada. We estimate that total costs for the new building will be approximately $22 million (CA$21.5 million). We expect the construction to be completed in the third quarter of fiscal 2012 and then occupy approximately 50% of the premises and lease the remaining for an undetermined period.
 
On November 7, 2011 we announced that our Board of Directors approved the renewal of our share repurchase program, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market of up to 2% of our issued and outstanding subordinate voting shares, representing 575,690 subordinate voting shares at the prevailing market price. We expect to use cash, short-term investments or future cash flow from operations to fund the repurchase of shares. The normal course issuer bid started on November 10, 2011, and will end on November 9, 2012, or on an earlier date if we repurchase the maximum number of shares permitted under the bid. The program does not require that we repurchase any specific number of shares, and it may be modified, suspended or terminated at any time and without prior notice. All shares repurchased under the bid will be cancelled. We shall provide to any person or company, upon request to our Secretary, at 400 Godin Avenue, Quebec, Province of Quebec, Canada, G1M 2K2, phone number (418) 683-0913 ext. 23704 or fax number (418) 683-9839, a copy of the notice sent to the Toronto Stock Exchange (TSX) according to our normal course issuer bid.
 

 
 B.  Business Overview
 
EXFO is a leading provider of next-generation test and service assurance solutions for wireline and wireless network operators and equipment manufacturers in the global telecommunications industry. We offer core-to-edge solutions that assess the performance and reliability of converged IP networks. Our test and service assurance solutions specifically target high-growth market opportunities related to optimizing next-generation networks: wireless backhaul, 4G/LTE (Long-Term Evolution), fiber-to-the-home (FTTH)/fiber-to-the-curb (FTTC)/fiber-to-the-node (FTTN), carrier Ethernet, and 40G/100G network upgrades. The Life Sciences and Industrial Division, which provided solutions in medical device and opto-electronics assembly, fluorescence microscopy and other life science sectors, was sold to The Riverside Company, a private equity firm, in October 2010.
 
We were founded in 1985 in Quebec City, Canada. Our original products were focused on the needs of installers and operators of fiber-optic networks. Customers use these field-portable test solutions for the installation, maintenance and troubleshooting of optical networks. Over the past several years, we have enhanced our competitive position in the global telecommunications test and service assurance industry through the acquisitions of transport and datacom, copper/xDSL and wireless test companies as well as an IP service assurance business.
 
We launched 19 new products in fiscal 2011 compared to 20 in 2010 and 26 in 2009. Key product introductions in fiscal 2011 included EXFO Connect, a software suite of test management solutions for network operators. We expect that EXFO Connect, which leverages an established base of more than 30,000 portable platforms and related test modules, will enable operators to significantly increase productivity and reduce operating costs. We also launched our intelligent Optical Link Mapper (iOLM), an innovative test solution that we believe will characterize fiber-to-the-home (FTTH) networks up to 85% faster than the traditional method through the automated setting of complex OTDR acquisition parameters. In addition, we introduced our FTB-1 platform for FTTH and Ethernet testing applications. As well, we released BrixHawk DA and BrixHawk SA, fully integrated solutions for the turn up, troubleshooting and monitoring of 2G, 3G, and 4G/LTE wireless networks.
 
Industry Background
 
Market conditions in the telecommunications industry remain tenuous based on weak global economic growth and unresolved sovereign debt issues in Europe. Despite this economic uncertainty, we believe the fundamental drivers toward broadband deployments and fixed-mobile IP (Internet protocol) network convergence are entrenched in the telecommunications industry. Although many network operators did not increase capital expenditures so far in calendar 2011, we believe they may have spent more in select, high-growth areas to accommodate bandwidth-intensive broadband applications and to facilitate the migration to more flexible and cost-effective fixed and mobile IP networks.
 
According to Cisco’s Visual Networking Index, global IP traffic will quadruple from 2010 to 2015, reaching 966 exabytes per year in 2015. (An exabyte is equal to 1 billion gigabytes or 250 million DVDs). Global mobile traffic, a subset of this larger group, is expected to increase 26-fold during the same period. We believe this growth is being driven by a proliferation of media-rich communication devices (smartphones and tablets), growing number of Internet users, faster broadband speeds and increased video usage.
 
To support such bandwidth growth, wireline networks are being transformed into next-generation IP-based infrastructures. Legacy SONET/SDH networks, which were established in the mid-1980s, do not have the flexibility to seamlessly mix and transport voice, data and video services. These networks are not capable of efficiently carrying triple-play services because they were designed for point-to-point voice communication. As a result, new optical transport network (OTN) standards, which are at the very heart of what the industry is labeling next-generation IP networks, have been defined to carry IP applications over Ethernet. Network operators are increasingly turning to such next-generation, IP-based networks in order to offer customers higher-margin triple-play services while lowering their operating costs.
 


Fiber-to-the-home (FTTH) has also become the access network architecture of choice for wireline operators wishing to provide a superior user experience for a combined voice, data and video offering. This architecture allows operators to meet heightened bandwidth requirements and future-proof their access networks as residential bandwidth demands grow from 1 to 5 Mbit/s (megabits per second) to 30 to 100 Mbit/s required for the long term. Hybrid architectures, combining copper and fiber (fiber-to-the-curb, or FTTC, and fiber-to-the-node, or FTTN), will also increase in the short term, since they are less expensive methods to increase bandwidth and can be mass-deployed quickly.
 
As bandwidth growth in access networks continues to increase, it has begun placing a strain on metro rings and core networks. It is also driving the need for higher-speed technologies. For example, 43 Gbit/s (gigabits per second) SONET/SDH is becoming mainstream, while commercial deployments of 100 Gbit/s Ethernet networks are beginning to take place. In the long run, these solutions will offer a more economical way to add capacity to saturated network links, especially if trenches need to be dug in order to deploy new fiber in metro and long-distance routes.
 
On the wireless side, operators are also faced with major investments to meet soaring bandwidth demand. Wireless operators are accelerating deployments of 3G networks, fast-tracking 4G/LTE (long-term evolution) adoption, and investing in mobile backhaul networks in order to increase transmission rates for bandwidth-hungry consumers to approach wireline speeds. Furthermore, as these consumers expect wireline and wireless networks to transport any content to any device at any time, both fixed and mobile networks are converging to a common IP-based infrastructure supported by IMS (IP multimedia subsystem) for seamless network interoperability.
 
Strategy and Corporate Objectives
 
Our long-term goal is to become the market leader in the global telecom test and service assurance industry. Given explosive bandwidth demand and IP convergence, wireless and wireline network operators and equipment manufacturers are faced with a major investment cycle.
 
To achieve our goal, we plan to:
 
·  
Capitalize on bandwidth explosion in the telecom industry with the introduction of innovative, market-driven test and service assurance solutions;
·  
Focus on the convergence of IP fixed and mobile networks, including emerging technologies like high-speed Ethernet and 4G/LTE;
·  
Leverage our leadership in optical testing for new opportunities like wireless backhaul, fiber-to-the-home, and 40G and 100G network upgrades;
·  
Move up the value chain on IP networks by leveraging the intelligence, or computing capabilities, of our modular test platforms to develop a series of value-added solutions; and
·  
Accelerate profitability through globalization and execution.
 
To gauge the success of our strategy, we had established three corporate performance objectives for the three-year period ending in fiscal 2012. Following are our results after two years into the three-year plan:
 
Corporate Performance Objectives (Fiscal 2010-2012)
Objectives
Metrics
Results After Two Years
Increase sales by a CAGR* of at least:
25%
25.4%
Raise gross margin from 61.3% to:
65%
62.7%
Increase adjusted EBITDA** in dollars by a CAGR* of at least:
30%
45.4%
 
*
Compound annual growth rate.
**
EBITDA is defined as net earnings (loss) before interest, income taxes, amortization of property, plant and equipment, amortization of intangible assets and impairment of goodwill. Adjusted EBITDA represents EBITDA excluding the gain from the disposal of discontinued operations.
 
 
 
In fiscal 2011, sales, including those from our divested Life Sciences and Industrial Division (discontinued operations), reached $271.7 million, resulting in a CAGR of 25.4% after two years. Our gross margin, including the effect of discontinued operations, reached 62.7% or up 140 basis points after two years. Finally, adjusted EBITDA, including the operating results of discontinued operations, amounted to $30.6 million in fiscal 2011, representing a two-year CAGR of 45.4%.
 
See item 5 on page 61 for a reconciliation of the GAAP sales and GAAP gross margin to the global sales and global gross margin, including the effect of the discontinued operations and a reconciliation of GAAP net earnings (loss) to EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA.
 
Customers
 
Telecom customers on a global basis utilize our test and service assurance solutions to enable their wireline and wireless networks to perform optimally during their complete life cycles: research, development, manufacturing, installation, maintenance and monitoring. From December 2000 to October 2010, we also had select customers in the high-precision assembly and life science sectors that required our solutions to render them more efficient in their respective fields.
 
Our success has been largely predicated on our core expertise in developing telecom test equipment for wireline network operators and to a lesser extent equipment manufacturers, but over the years we have expanded our offering to wireless network operators, cable television companies, public utilities, private network operators, third-party installers, equipment rental companies, large enterprises, component vendors and laboratory researchers.
 
Our life science and industrial customers consisted of major manufacturers of medical devices, microelectronics, optical displays, electronic storage systems, photonic components and microscopes, as well as universities, medical schools, governments, and private and industrial research laboratories. Our UV digital print customers consisted of printing equipment manufacturers who develop products for wide format graphics printing, label production and product marking.
 
In fiscal 2011, our top customer accounted for 7.2% of our sales and our top three customers represented 16.3%.  In comparison, our top customer accounted for 4.9% of sales and our top three customers represented 12.2% in 2010, while our top customer accounted for 13.1% of sales and our top three customers represented 20.1% in 2009.
 
Products
 
We offer an extensive range of wireline and wireless test and service assurance solutions to the global telecommunications industry. We believe our success has largely been predicated on our core expertise in developing test equipment for wireline networks. Following the acquisition of Brix Networks in April 2008, we expanded our product portfolio into the service assurance business for next-generation IP networks. Through the acquisition of NetHawk Oyj in March 2010, we offer test and service assurance solutions for 2G, 3G and 4G/LTE wireless networks.
 
We believe the competitive advantages of our products include a high degree of innovation, modularity (especially wireline products) and ease of use. Ultimately, we believe our products enable network equipment manufacturers and operators to design, deploy, troubleshoot and monitor wireline and wireless networks, and also help them reduce their operating expenses.
 

 
Products for Network Operators
 
Wireline Test Equipment
 
We provide an extensive range of portable test solutions that are mainly used by network operators to install, turn up and maintain their optical and copper-based telecommunications networks. These products are available as handheld test instruments, portable platforms with related modules, and as rack-mount chassis with related modules. Our handheld instruments are durable, compact and easy to use. Our field-test platforms, namely the FTB-1 Platform, FTB-200 Compact Platform and FTB-500 Platform, are at the core of our wireline product portfolio. Our FTB-1 Platform, which is designed for frontline technicians in the field, is a single-slot, modular platform dedicated to fiber-to-the-home and Ethernet testing applications. It supports USB, mobile, Wi-Fi, and Bluetooth connectivity capabilities to efficiently manage testing and reporting operations in the field.
 
Our FTB-200 Compact Platform, designed for the “super field technician”, holds up to two interchangeable modules that are fully compatible with our more advanced FTB-500 platform. Test technologies well suited for the FTB-200 Compact Platform include a wide range of singlemode and multimode optical time-domain reflectometers (OTDRs), automated optical loss test sets (OLTSs), SONET/SDH analyzers up to 10 Gbit/s, as well as Gigabit Ethernet (GigE) and 10 Gigabit Ethernet testers. Our third-generation field-testing platform, the FTB-500, is available in two configurations for various high-end applications. The four-slot model is designed for datacom testing, OTDR analysis, optical loss, and Ethernet (up to 10 Gbit/s) testing. The eight-slot model is a high-performance, multiple-protocol unit that allows users to combine next-generation SONET/SDH functions with Ethernet, Fibre Channel and optical-layer testing capabilities. It also supports dispersion characterization (PMD and CD), as well as DWDM/ROADM testing with optical spectrum analysis.
 
These PC-centric, Windows-based portable platforms can also be leveraged through a suite of software solutions, called EXFO Connect, which enable network operators to increase productivity and reduce operating expenses. For example, Test Equipment Manager helps customers keep track of their test fleet, manage software updates and schedule calibration procedures. Test Data Manager allows customers to store all their measurements in a central database and use them as point of reference against future data.
 
Wireless Test Equipment
 
We offer 2G, 3G and 4G/LTE protocol analyzers for network operators. These instruments analyze mobile network elements in order to validate functionality according to wireless technology specifications, whether these elements interoperate with each other effectively when combined to form a network, and how well the live network performs. These test tools allow engineers to troubleshoot networks in order to find the source of errors and fix them as fast as possible. Our protocol analyzers support multi-interface testing and all major mobile technologies: GSM/GPRS/EDGE/UMTS/LTE. They enable fully automated testing and run powerful applications for protocol monitoring, call and session tracing, quality of service and radio optimization measurement.
 
Wireline/Wireless Service Assurance Systems
 
We provide a converged service assurance solution, called the Brix System, for wireline and wireless network operators, as well as for the managed services arms of telecom equipment manufacturers in support of service-level agreements (SLAs) required by their customers.
 
The Brix System is an integrated hardware and software solution that delivers end-to-end quality of service (QoS) and quality of experience (QoE) visibility as well as real-time IP service monitoring and verification for next-generation networks. Built around a distributed architecture, we believe the Brix System enables the successful launch and ongoing profitable operation of IP-based voice, video and data applications and services across wireline and wireless networks.
 
We believe a competitive advantage of EXFO’s service assurance solution is the ability to implement SLA monitoring and assure any IP service, over any network, to any endpoint—all from the same open and extensible platform. Key capabilities include:
 

 
·  
Performance monitoring and analysis;
·  
Correlation and analysis engine;
·  
VoIP service assurance;
·  
IP/MPLS service assurance;
·  
Mobile backhaul and metro Ethernet service assurance;
·  
Mobile service assurance;
·  
IP video service assurance;
·  
Advanced analytics; and
·  
Custom solutions services.
 
The Brix System offers a multi-play capability such that customers can leverage one, several or all of the above on a single platform, which we believe can deliver significant savings in capital and operating expenditures.
 
We believe the highly scalable BrixWorx correlation and analysis engine architecture is well suited for the needs of operators’ networks and IP services.  It works together with network-wide monitoring sources — including Brix verifiers, Brix software agents, third-party devices and standards-based interfaces — and Brix software applications. BrixWorx conducts network and IP service testing and monitoring, while collecting, storing, correlating and analyzing essential data to produce detailed graphical reports and analytics on end-to-end service performance.
 
Brix software applications include:
 
·  
BrixCall: Voice quality and performance management;
·  
BrixNGN: IP/MPLS and carrier Ethernet (mobile backhaul and metro Ethernet) service quality monitoring;
·  
BrixHawk SA: Mobile network service quality monitoring and customer experience management;
·  
BrixVision: Comprehensive IP video quality and performance management; and
·  
BrixView: Advanced analytics and business intelligence software.
 
Products for Network Equipment Manufacturers
 
Wireline Test Equipment
 
Our network equipment manufacturer solutions, mainly built around our IQS-600 platform, are available as test modules or stand-alone benchtop instruments. The next-generation IQS-600 platform can efficiently run as many as 100 optical test modules using a single controller unit. The IQS-600 platform is equipped with the software and hardware technology to support single-button operation for automated testing. Its system-based approach – one box, several test modules – combined with an open architecture (PXI, Windows, LabVIEW™, etc.) and ease of programming, produces a highly flexible test environment.
 
The IQS-600 also provides backward compatibility with recent IQ-generation test modules, while delivering all the power and advantages of a next-generation platform. EXFO’s wide selection of high-performance test modules includes high-speed power meters, light sources, WDM laser sources, tunable laser sources, variable attenuators, polarization controllers and optical switches.
 
Outside our IQS family of products, we offer advanced, stand-alone test solutions for network equipment manufacturers in the process of developing ultra high-speed optical networks.
 
The PSO-200 is the first turn-key optical modulation analyzer for complete characterization of signals up to 100 GBaud. Very high-speed network transmission is enabled through the efficient modulation of signals, whether it is phase, amplitude or both. To design 100G systems based on such advanced modulation schemes and to make sure they are ready for deployment, network equipment manufacturers have used in-house test solutions, which are often complex or limited. The introduction of the PSO-200 Optical Modulation Analyzer changes the picture as engineers working in R&D labs and manufacturing environments now have access to a turnkey and comprehensive test instrument that makes bandwidth limitation irrelevant.
 

 
The PSO-100 Series consists of the industry's fastest sampling oscilloscopes, allowing characterization of optical signals at data rates up to 640 Gbits/s. The PSO-100 all-optical sampling oscilloscopes enable distortion-free, eye-diagram analysis and pattern visualization within existing high-speed optical networks.
 
Wireless Test Equipment
 
We offer 2G, 3G and 4G/LTE test solutions mainly for network equipment manufacturers, but also for network operators and government agencies. We provide two main product lines for the wireless test and measurement market: simulators and analyzers.
 
EXFO’s network simulators simulate real-world, large-scale network traffic and end-user behavior in a laboratory environment in order to predict network behavior, uncover faults and optimize networks before wireless networks and services are deployed. Typical tests include regression and load testing.
 
EXFO’s protocol analyzers analyze mobile network elements in order to validate functionality according to wireless technology specifications, whether these elements interoperate with each other effectively when combined to form a network, and how well the live network performs. These test tools allow engineers to troubleshoot networks in order to find the source of errors and quickly fix them. Our protocol analyzers support multi-interface testing and all major mobile technologies: GSM/GPRS/EDGE/UMTS/LTE. They enable fully automated testing and run powerful applications for protocol monitoring, call and session tracing, quality of service and radio optimization measurement.
 
We believe our wireless test tools optimize network performance and ensure a high-quality user experience. The following table summarizes our wireless test solutions and their typical applications for the telecommunications industry.
 
Wireless Test and Solutions
Product Type
Product Line
Typical Application
Protocol Analyzer, Distributed Analyzer bridging to Service Assurance
Hawk portfolio
Protocol analysis to verify correct network behavior.
Network Simulator
EAST portfolio, Navtel portfolio
Regression and load testing.
Mobile Communications Intelligence Tools
NetHawk F10, NetHawk X6 and NetHawk C2
Intelligence tools for police, armed forces and other governmental organizations to fight organized crime and terrorists.
 
Products for Life Sciences and Industrial Customers
 
From December 2000 until the divestiture of our Life Sciences and Industrial Division in October 2010, we developed and acquired a number of core technologies that we leveraged in selected high-precision assembly and life sciences markets. For example, we offered several light-based curing solutions for optical component manufacturing applications and adapted our approach for other industries, such as semiconductor, microelectronic, and medical device manufacturing, in order to maximize revenues. Omnicure® systems delivered precise doses of the appropriate spectral light onto photosensitive adhesives to significantly reduce bonding time and increase repeatability. These light-based curing systems, supported by patented optical feedback, thermal control and radiometry technology, produced a high-quality bonding solution. Our technology and application knowledge placed us at the forefront of this market.
 

 
Another key product line was the X-Cite fluorescence illumination systems for microscope manufacturers. X-Cite systems deliver excellent image quality and at least 2000 hours of lamp life, which is over 60% longer than previous models and up to 10 times longer than conventional illumination systems. X-Cite systems are self-contained illumination units separate from a microscope.  A simple light guide attachment through custom-coupling optics ensures a uniformly illuminated field of view with no heat from the lamp being transferred to the microscope.  Models range from the basic X-Cite 120XL for routine imaging applications to the full-featured X-Cite Exacte, designed to provide maximum illumination stability and control for the most advanced live cell research. In addition, this division was developing UV curing solutions for the graphics digital printing market.
 
Research and Development
 
Our global R&D operations fall under the management of a vice-president. We believe that our future success largely depends on our ability to maintain and enhance our core technologies and product functionalities. To keep developing new products and enhancements, it is important that we retain and recruit highly skilled personnel.
 
In fiscal 2011, we continued to invest in our R&D teams located worldwide: Quebec City, Canada, Montreal, Canada, Toronto, Canada, Chelmsford, USA, Oulu. Finland, Lappeenranta, Finland, Gothenburg, Sweden as well as Pune and Bhubaneswar, India. We particularly increased our software development capabilities at our two R&D sites in India: Pune and Bhubaneswar. Gross research and development expenditures in fiscal 2011 totaled $57.2 million, compared to $44.6 million in 2010 and $33.6 million in 2009.
 
Through market-oriented product portfolio review processes, we ensure that our investments in research and development are aligned with market opportunities and customers’ needs. This process enables us to maximize our returns on R&D investments by focusing our resources on prioritized projects. Product portfolio review meetings happen three times per year and enable us to select a realistic, balanced mix of new products and allocate the necessary resources for their development. All our projects, including those already underway, are reviewed, given a priority rating and allocated budgets and resources. Our existing projects can be stopped or substantially redefined if there have been significant changes in market conditions, or if the project development schedule or budget has significantly changed.
 
Product development projects, once they are underway, are managed through a structured process known as the stage-gate approach. The stage-gate approach is based on a systematic review of a project’s progress at various stages of its life cycle. The following are the key review stages of the stage-gate approach:
 
·  
market study and research feasibility;
·  
product definition;
·  
development feasibility;
·  
development;
·  
qualification; and
·  
transfer to production.
 
At each stage, we review our project risks, costs and estimated completion time. We compare our design to anticipated market needs and ensure that our new product development is synchronized with other internal departments and external industry events.
 
We also maintained research and development programs for our Life Sciences and Industrial Division in Toronto, Canada, until its divestiture in October 2010. The product development process was managed using a similar stage-gate process, while projects were reviewed and approved through a portfolio review.
 

 
Sales
 
We sell our telecom wireline and wireless test and service assurance solutions through direct and indirect sales channels in the Americas (US, Canada, Central and South America), Europe, Middle East and Africa (EMEA) and Asia-Pacific regions.
 
In the Americas, we use a hybrid model, combining key account management with direct and indirect sales coverage. We typically use key account managers to serve large customers that generate high sales volumes or might potentially represent high sales volumes in the future. These key account managers are supplemented by regional sales managers, sales engineers, sales representatives and distributors in the US as well as Central and South American metropolitan areas, and regional sales managers and sales engineers in Canada.
 
We opt for a direct sales approach when selling higher-end, highly technical products to sophisticated buyers. Sales of low- to medium-level complexity products to less stringent technical buyers are usually done through a manufacturer representative organization or distributors supported by regional sales managers. Our main sales offices in the Americas are located in Plano, Texas, Quebec City, Canada, and Toronto, Canada. They are supplemented by a regional presence in cities across the US, Central and South America, as well as Canada.
 
On the international front, we have sales personnel covering strategic areas in EMEA and Asia-Pacific.
 
Our sales network in EMEA is supported by a main office and service center in Southampton, UK, which serves as headquarters of our European sales operations and also provides repair, calibration and technical support services for our EMEA customers. We also have additional sales offices in multiple countries across EMEA to serve and support our various customers and distribution partners.
 
As for Asia-Pacific, our main sales offices for South East Asia are located in Singapore and Hong Kong, while our main sales representative offices for mainland China are located in Beijing and Shenzhen. The latter site also hosts a service center to better serve our customer base in China. In addition, we have other sales offices in strategic locations around the world to support our network of distributors and various customers.
 
We also rely on a network of distributors worldwide to work with us in supporting mostly our international sales and to participate in a large number of international events. We believe that the local presence and cultural attributes of our distributors allow us to better serve our global markets.
 
Our direct telecom sales team consists of a vice-president for each major geographic region: Americas, EMEA and Asia-Pacific. These three sales executives are supported by regional sales directors that lead a widely distributed team acting as key account managers, regional sales managers, sales engineers and application engineers. Our sales people are located throughout major metropolitan areas around the world. This group of sales professionals has on average more than 15 years of experience in the fields of telecommunications, fiber optics, or test and service assurance. Within each major geographic region, we have sales staff dedicated to wireline, wireless and service assurance customers.
 
We also have an in-house Customer Service Group to meet the needs of existing and new customers. This group is responsible for providing quotations to customers, supporting our sales force, managing demonstration units, order management, technical support and training as well as calibration and repair services.
 
Sales to customers in the Americas (US, Canada, Central and Latin America) represented 51% of our sales in fiscal 2011, while sales to customers in EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa) and Asia-Pacific accounted for 32% and 17% of sales, respectively. In comparison, the Americas, EMEA and Asia-Pacific accounted for 52%, 30% and 18% of sales, respectively, in 2010, and 57%, 28% and 15%, respectively, in 2009.
 

 
The main office for our Life Sciences and Industrial Division was located in Toronto, Canada. We used mixed sales channels to serve various markets supported by this division, depending on product line and geography. Optical light sources and related accessories used for industrial applications were sold in North America through a network of manufacturer representatives and, internationally, through a network of distributors. UV light sources for digital print applications were sold directly to customers globally. The X-Cite 120 and Exacte Fluorescence Illumination Systems were sold through value-added reseller agreements with major microscope companies and system integrators in North America and Europe. Positioning products were sold directly to customers in North America, which includes the United States and Canada, and internationally through a network of technical distributors.
 
Product Management, Marketing/Communications and Global Services
 
Product Management
 
Our telecom product management duties fall under the responsibility of a specific vice-president for wireline, wireless and service assurance activities. Each product management executive is supported by directors and product managers who have various degrees in engineering, science and business administration. Directors and product managers are responsible for all aspects of our telecom marketing program including product strategy, new product introductions, definition of new features and functions, pricing, product launches and advertising campaigns. We follow up our marketing initiatives by attending industry trade shows. Furthermore, we have a customer relationship management (CRM) system to compile market and customer information including forecasts, opportunities, leads and competitive data. We use this information to make strategic business decisions. Finally, strategic marketing specialists analyze our markets of interests, compile competitive information and identify macro-trends in our sector.
 
Our Life Sciences and Industrial Group consisted of a Director – responsible for both life sciences and precision assembly sectors – as well as product managers who had various degrees in engineering, science and business administration. Product managers, under the direction of the Director, were responsible for all aspects of their business line marketing programs including product strategy, new product introductions, definition of new features and functions, pricing, product launches and advertising campaigns.
 
Marketing/Communications
 
The Telecom Division’s Marketing-Communications team, which mainly consists of project managers, marketing writers, translators and graphic artists, supports our product management team by producing marketing and corporate documentation. Literature includes specification sheets, application notes, product catalogues, advertising copy and an electronic corporate newsletter. This Marketing-Communications team is also responsible for all sales tools required by our worldwide sales force and for updating the marketing contents of our website.
 
The Life Sciences and Industrial Division’s Marketing-Communications team shared a variety of marketing initiatives within EXFO.  This group was assisted by product managers, who provided the technical data and collaborative support required to produce product specification sheets, catalogues, application notes and multimedia marketing tools. This Marketing-Communications team was responsible for all advertising material, Website updates, events planning (including trade shows) and direct promotional marketing such as mass mailings and telemarketing. This team also provided the sales tools required by the Life Sciences and Industrial Division’s worldwide sales channels, including maintaining our channel partner programs and support.
 
Global Services
 
EXFO’s Global Services operation, which falls under the responsibility of a Senior Director, provides customers with a broad array of support and services worldwide. This team has direct staff in North America, Europe, and Asia. It also provides local support in other regions through select partners. Such a strategy enables EXFO to have a global reach while maintaining strong local ties.
 

 
This team’s objective is to directly contribute to the customer’s success and to achieve EXFO’s long-term mission by providing internal and customer-facing services. Specifically, it fulfills its mission by offering:
 
·  
Customer Relationship Management (CRM) Administration – Business Ownership of EXFO’s CRM toolset and evolution.
 
·  
Sales Support – Leverage the effectiveness of its sales force by providing pre-sales and demo support, as well as guiding customers in purchasing the correct equipment for their respective applications, issuing quotations, and promoting our extended warranty service and support program.
 
·  
Order Management – Accurately process customer orders from entry through fulfillment and delivery, and manage order changes.
 
·  
Customer ServiceServe as a primary interface for inbound and outbound customer communication. Provide customers with one central point of contact and work with the customer from purchasing equipment to helping them arrange for service, if necessary.
 
·  
Product Support – Provide expert technical support and deliver product service worldwide. Directly manage EXFO’s Worldwide Service Centers, and the Service Partner Program. Where applicable, furnish installation and on-site servicing for more complex equipment and applications.
 
·  
Systems Services – Provide pre-sale, delivery, post-sale technical support, and system actualization of EXFO’s test and service assurance systems.
 
·  
Education Services – Aggregate expertise, develop material, and deliver free and fee-based training.
 
·  
Professional Services – Provide value-added solution services for EXFO’s test and system customers.
 
Manufacturing
 
Our telecom manufacturing operations consist mainly of material planning, procurement, sub-assembly, final assembly and test, software loading, calibration, quality control, shipping, billing and customs management. Most of our telecom manufacturing activities, which occupy a total of approximately 125,000 square feet, take place at our plants in Quebec City, Canada (2) and Shenzhen, China (1), but we also have facilities in Chelmsford, USA, and Oulu, Finland, for final assembly of service assurance and wireless test equipment. All our manufacturing operations fall under the supervision of a vice-president.
 
Our Quebec City, Canada, operations mainly produce low-volume, high-complexity telecom products. They have maintained ISO 9001 certification since 1994 and are certified to the 2008 edition of the standard. Our manufacturing plant in Shenzhen, China, which started operations in September 2007, is responsible for the production of high-volume, low-complexity telecom products. Our Shenzhen plant follows the same corporate quality standards and was certified ISO 9001 in January 2009.
 
All of our products meet required industry standards, and some of our products meet additional voluntary standards, such as those set by Telcordia, formerly Bellcore, IEC, IETF, ETSI and other bodies that issue industry standards. During manufacturing, each product has a related quality-assurance plan, with rigorous checkpoints, to ensure product conformity. Various tasks in the quality assurance process include quality control, conformity testing, product documentation, product improvement, regulatory compliance, metrology and calibration.
 
Our telecom manufacturing operations include the following responsibilities:
 
·  
Production.  From production planning to product shipment, our production department is responsible for manufacturing high-quality products on time. Factories are organized in work cells; each cell consists of specialized technicians and equipment and has full responsibility over a product family. Technicians are cross-trained and versatile enough, so that they can carry out specific functions in more than one cell. This allows shorter lead times by alleviating bottlenecks.
 

 
·  
Product Engineering and Quality.  This department, which supports our production cells, acts like a gatekeeper to ensure the quality of our products and the effectiveness of our manufacturing processes. It is responsible for the transfer of products from research and development to manufacturing, product improvement, documentation, metrology, and the quality control and regulatory compliance process. Quality control represents a key element in our manufacturing operations. Quality is assured through product testing at numerous stages in the manufacturing process to ensure that our products meet stringent industry requirements and our customers’ performance requirements.
 
·  
Supply-Chain Management.  This department is responsible for sales forecasting, raw material procurement, material-cost reduction and vendor performance management. Our products consist of optical, electronic and mechanical parts, which are purchased from suppliers around the world. Approximately one-third of our parts are manufactured to our specifications. Materials represent the largest portion of our cost of goods. Our performance is tightly linked to vendor performance, requiring greater emphasis on this critical aspect of our business.
 
Our manufacturing operations are subject to environmental laws in various jurisdictions around the world. Our product designs comply with Directive 2002/96/EC, legislation enacted by the European Union regarding the disposal of waste electrical and electronic equipment (WEEE), for all products exported to Europe. In regard to Directive 2002/96/EC (RoHs), test and measurement manufacturers have been provided a limited exemption until 2017, but we have established a plan for our applicable products to become compliant in 2012.
 
Our Life Sciences and Industrial Division’s manufacturing operations occupied 8,000 square feet in Toronto, Canada. This group manufactured light sources and related accessories, fluorescence illumination systems and precise positioning equipment for the life sciences and high-precision assembly markets. Operations consisted of manufacturing, procurement, warehousing, quality control and document control managed by various elements of the ISO 9001 certified quality system. Recognizing the importance of reduced time-to-market for our solutions, we focused efforts on designing products with an emphasis on standardization, modularity, as well as ease of fabrication and assembly.
 
Sources and Availability of Raw Materials
 
We use various suppliers to provide parts for the manufacture and support of multiple product lines. Although our intention is to establish at least two sources of supply for materials whenever possible for certain parts, we have sole or limited source supply arrangements. We may not be able to procure these parts from alternative sources at acceptable prices within a reasonable time; therefore, the loss or interruption of such arrangements could have an impact on our ability to deliver certain products on a timely basis.
 
We will continue to reduce the risk of production interruptions and shortages of parts by: (1) selecting and qualifying alternative sources of supplies for key parts whenever possible, and (2) maintaining an appropriate supply of key parts. Following the natural disaster in Japan in March 2011, for example, we increased our inventory of critical parts from certain Japanese single-source suppliers to ensure we are able deliver our products to customers without interruption.
 
Seasonality
 
Historically, we have not been subject to much seasonality with the exception of our second quarter (December, January and February) due to the Christmas holidays and delays in approval of network operators spending budgets for the new calendar year. These two factors can have negative effects on our bookings in our second quarter, but they are mitigated by the renewal of annual maintenance contracts and sometimes calendar year-end budget spending on the part of network operators. We are also subject to seasonality in the fourth quarter (June, July and August) since bookings activity tends to slow down during the summer months, especially in Europe. These seasonal effects do not apply consistently and do not always correlate to our financial results. Accordingly, they should not be considered as a reliable indicator of our future revenue or results of operations.
 

 
Competition
 
The wireline and wireless test and service assurance industry is highly competitive and subject to rapid change as a result of technological developments and market conditions. We compete with many different companies, depending on product family and geographical market. We believe that the main competitive factors in the industry include the following:
 
·  
product performance and reliability;
·  
price;
·  
level of technological innovation;
·  
product lead times;
·  
breadth of product offerings;
·  
ease of use;
·  
brand-name recognition;
·  
customer service and technical support;
·  
strength of sales and distribution relationships; and
·  
financial stability.
 
Main competitors in the test environment include global suppliers like Anritsu Corporation, JDS Uniphase Corporation, and Yokogawa Electric Corporation, as well as niche players like Fluke (an operating division within Danaher Corporation), Ixia and VeEX Inc. On the service assurance side, we mainly compete against Anritsu Corporation, Ineoquest Technologies, Inc., JDS Uniphase Corporation, NetScout Systems, Inc., Spirent Communications plc, and Tektronix, Inc. (an operating division within Danaher Corporation).
 
Competition for our life sciences and industrial solutions was quite varied, depending upon product line. OmniCure’s competitors, which sell light-based curing products, included Dymax Corporation, Henkel Corporation in North America and Europe, as well as Hamamatsu Photonics K.K., Ushio Inc., Omron Corporation, Hoya Corporation  and Panasonic Corporation in Asia. Excelerate competed globally with products from well-established companies such as Dr. Honle, Nordson and Integration Technologies. With regard to the X-Cite® Fluorescence Illumination Systems, main competitors consisted of microscope manufacturers who had developed lamp housings for low-wattage mercury burners in-house. Additional competitors included CoolLED and Prior Scientific. Finally, our motion-control instruments, which were designed for various life science applications, competed against products from companies like Sutter Instruments and Narishige.
 
Employees
 
As at November 1, 2011, we had approximately 1,752 full-time employees compared to 1,656 and 1,205 for the same periods in 2010 and 2009, respectively. Our workforce as of November 1, 2011 included approximately 365 employees in manufacturing, 818 employees in research and development, and 569 employees in sales and marketing as well as general and administrative functions.
 
Our future performance depends, to a significant degree, on our continued ability to attract and retain highly skilled and qualified technical, sales and marketing, and senior management personnel. Our employees are not represented by a labor union with the exception of our manufacturing personnel in Quebec City, Canada. We consider relations with our employees to be good.
 
 Regulatory Environment
 
In most countries where our products are sold, our products must comply with the regulations of one or more governmental entities. These regulations often are complex and vary from country to country. Depending upon the country and the relevant product, the applicable regulations may require product testing, approval, registration, marking and unique design restrictions. Accordingly, we have appointed a team of engineers who are responsible for ensuring that our products comply with all applicable regulations.
 

 
In the United States, our products must comply with the regulations of several agencies of the U.S. federal government, including the Federal Communications Commission (FCC), the Food and Drug Administration (FDA) and the Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA). Under the FCC’s regulations, our products must comply with certain electromagnetic compatibility (EMC) requirements to insure they do not generate and are immune from electrical noise which could possibly cause undesirable operation, as well as affect other surrounding devices. Depending upon the product, compliance with these rules may necessitate applying for and obtaining an FCC equipment authorization prior to importing into the United States, or marketing, any units of the relevant product. Additionally, some of our products must comply with the FDA’s non-medical performance standards and related rules concerning light-emitting products, such as lasers. The FDA’s regulations applicable to our products are intended to promote safety by limiting human exposure to harmful non-iodizing radiation. Similarly, our products must comply with safety standards adopted by OSHA. Furthermore, for our Life Science and Industrial Division, certain U.S. states require mandatory product registration and reporting of Mercury-added products being imported. This registration is controlled by the Interstate Mercury Education and Reduction Clearinghouse (IMERC).
 
Similar regulations apply in other countries. For example, in Canada our products must comply with the applicable standards adopted by the Standards Council of Canada (SCC). These include product safety standards developed by the Canadian Standards association as well as EMC requirements adopted by Industry Canada. Countries in the European Union require product compliance as dictated by an applicable directive, often referred to as CE marking. This includes testing to ensure compliance with harmonized European Norm (EN) standards for both product safety and EMC requirements.
 
In Europe, with the implementation of the WEEE directives for recycling of electronic products in selected European Countries (2002/96/EC), we have appointed a task force committee consisting of our management and employees, distributors and other partners as the case may be, to ensure full compliance with regulations and oversee the management, logistics, recycling rate, disposal services and activities related to recycling of electronic equipment and products within the member states.
 
Additionally, to address the issue of environmental compliance, the European Union has mandated the Restriction of the Use of Certain Hazardous Substances or “RoHS” Directive (2002/95/EC), which applies to all products included within the scope of WEEE directive with the exception of Categories 8 (Medical devices) and 9 (Monitoring and control instruments). Mandatory product compliance includes the ban of certain substances within specified concentrations, unless formally exempted by the directive. To ensure compliance to this directive, a formal restricted substances control (RSC) program was implemented for our products included within the scope of WEEE. This program ensures the design, procurement and manufacturing of affected products prevents the inclusion of the banned substances as specified by the RoHS directive.
 
Other significant types of regulations not described in this Annual Report also may apply, depending upon the relevant product and country of destination.
 
 Intellectual Property
 
Our success and ability to compete are dependent in part on our ability to develop and protect our proprietary technology. We file U.S. and international applications to protect technology, inventions and improvements important to the development of our business. We also rely on a combination of copyright, trademark, trade secret rights, licensing and confidentiality agreements.
 
As of August 31, 2011, our records indicate that we held 34 actively-maintained granted patents from the U.S., 14 patents in Finland, 7 patents in Canada, 4 patents in China, 9 patents in Germany (including one “Utility Model”), 8 patents in the United Kingdom, 8 patents in France, 4 patents in Italy, 4 patents in Sweden and one patent in Russia, as well as one patent in each of three other European countries. In addition, we have 24 patent applications pending in the U.S., 8 in Canada, 6 in China, one in Australia, one in Japan, one in Korea, one in India and 10 regional applications pending in Europe, and as well as 4 International Applications under the Patent Cooperation Treaty, which have not yet entered the national/regional phase. The expiration dates of our active issued patents range from October 2012 to June 2028.

 
We consider seven of our inventions for which patents have either been granted or are pending to be material. These inventions are:
 
·  
a method and apparatus for characterizing optical power levels in three-wavelength, bidirectional fiber-to-the-home systems. This invention describes how the optical power can be measured at the two-downstream and one upstream wavelengths used to connect a residence or business customer, while maintaining the signal continuity necessary to keep the home-based Optical Network Terminal operating.  This invention underlies the two-port version of our PPM-350 series of PON power meters;
 
·  
a method for determining the optical signal-to-noise ratio employing an optical spectrum analyzer, which is particularly advantageous for use with tightly-filtered DWDM signals used in high-bandwidth optical networks.  This invention is a key value-added option to our FTB-5240-S series of portable optical spectrum analyzers;
 
·  
a method and apparatus to determine the theoretical and practical data rates for a cable under test. This invention forms the basis of the EXFO CableSHARK product, describing how two test devices, communicating with each other via the cable under test, can predict the performance of a pair of ADSL (Asymmetric Digital Subscriber Line) modems, and in case of problems, analyze the cause of the modems’ failure to synchronize;
 
·  
a method and system for hardware time stamping packetized data to provide sub-microsecond accuracy in test measurements, which is embedded in the Brix100M, Brix1000, and Brix2500 Series Verifiers;
 
·  
a method for actively analyzing a data packet delivery path to provide diagnostics and root cause analysis of network delivery path issues, which is embedded in BrixCall, BrixNGN, and BrixVision applications of EXFO Service Assurance;
 
·  
a distributed protocol analyzer for quality-of-service measurement. This invention underlies the combined QoS measurements offered in the NetHawk iPro and NetHawk M5 products; and
 
·  
a communication methodology used to perform independent bi-directional protocol testing over a connection or connectionless network between two test instruments, wherein the transfer mechanism of status and intermediate test results during an active test and the transmission of the final results to one of the instruments enables the user to perform a bidirectional single-ended test. This invention is at the heart of the EXFO Datacom product families, including applications in conformity with our EtherSAM standard test suite.
 
Confidentiality and proprietary information agreements with our senior management, employees and others generally stipulate that all confidential information developed or made known to these individuals by us during the course of their relationship is to be kept confidential and not disclosed to third parties, except in specific circumstances. The agreements also generally provide that all intellectual property developed by the individual in the course of rendering services to us belongs exclusively to us. These efforts afford only limited protection.
 
 
 
C.  Organizational Structure
 
As of November 1, 2011, the following chart presents our corporate structure, the jurisdiction of incorporation of our subsidiaries and the percentage of shares (which is also the percentage of voting power) that we hold in those subsidiaries.
 
 
 
 
 
D.  Property, Plants and Equipment
 
Our head offices are located in Quebec City, Province of Quebec, Canada where we occupy two buildings. These buildings house our executive and administrative offices, research and development facilities and production facilities. We also have offices in Montreal, Province of Quebec, Canada (formerly Avantas Networks Inc), in Concord, Ontario, Canada (formerly Consultronics Limited), in Chelmsford, Massachusetts, United States (formerly Brix Networks Inc now EXFO Service Assurance Inc.), in Eastleigh, Hampshire, United Kingdom (EXFO Europe Limited), in Shenzhen, China (EXFO Telecom Equipment (Shenzhen) Co. Ltd.), in Pune, India (EXFO Electro-Optical Engineering India Private Ltd.), in Gothenburg, Sweden (EXFO Sweden Aktiebolag), in Oulu, Finland (NetHawk Oyj), in Lappeenranta, Finland (NetHawk Oyj), in Bhubaneswar, India (NetHawk Networks India Pvt. Ltd.), in Richardson, Texas, United States (EXFO America Inc.).
 
In addition, we maintain sales offices and/or have regional sales managers located in China, Czech Republic, France, Germany, Great Britain, India, Mexico, Singapore, Spain, Sweden, United Arab Emirates and the United States.
 
In September 2010 and in April 2011, we purchased premises in Magarpatta, Pune, India, and in July 2011 we finalized the relocation of our R&D activities previously based in Wadgaon Sheri, Pune, India to these new premises in Magarpatta, Pune, India.
 
In fiscal 2011, we undertook the construction of a new building of 125,000 sq ft in St-Laurent Technopark, Montreal, Quebec. We expect to complete the construction and relocate our R&D activities (located in St-Laurent) in May 2012. We then expect to occupy approximately 50% of the premises and lease the remaining for an undetermined period. As at November 1, 2011, costs incurred in conjunction with the construction of the building, including land-related costs, amounted to $6.3 million (CA$6.2 million). This project will be paid cash. 
 
The following table sets forth information with respect to the main facilities that we occupy as of November 1, 2011.
 
Location
Use of Space
Square
Footage
% of
Utilization
Type of
Interest
436 Nolin Street
Quebec (Quebec)
G1M 1E7
 
Occupied for manufacturing of products
 44,000
   50%
Owned
400 Godin Avenue
Quebec (Quebec)
G1M 2K2
 
Occupied for research and development, customer services, manufacturing, management and administration
    129,000  (1)
   80%
Owned
2650 Marie-Curie
St-Laurent (Quebec)
H4S 2C3
 
Occupied for research and development, management and administration
 26,000
100%
Leased
160 Drumlin Circle
Concord (Ontario)
L4K 3E5
 
Occupied for research and development, product management and administration
 23,500
   60%
Owned
270 Billerica Road
Chelmsford, MA 01824
United States
 
Occupied for research and development, manufacturing, management and administration
 29,000
   60%
Leased
 
 
 
31

 
 
Location
Use of Space
Square
Footage
% of
Utilization
Type of
Interest
Omega Enterprise Park
Electron Way, Chandlers Ford
Eastleigh, Hampshire
S053 4SE
United Kingdom
 
Occupied for European customer service, sales management and administration
 10,000
   90%
Leased
3rd Floor, Building 10,
Yu Sheng Industrial Park
(Gu Shu Crossing)
No. 467, National Highway 107
Xixiang, Bao An District
Shenzhen 518126, China
 
Occupied for manufacturing of telecom products
 56,000
   70%
Leased
Offices No 602, 603, 604 and 702
Tower S-4 Cybercity
Magarpatta , Hadapsar
Pune 411 013
India
 
Occupied for research and development
 24,668
   80%
Owned
NetHawk Oyj (Headquarters)
Elektroniikkatie 2
FI-90590 Oulu, Finland
 
Occupied for research and development, manufacturing, management and administration
 47,097
   80%
Leased
NetHawk Networks India Pvt. Ltd.
5th floor, IDCO Tower 2000
Mancheswar Industrial Area
Bhubaneswar  751010, India
Occupied for research and development
 25,239
   90%
Leased
 
(1)  
Including the warehouse space. Premises without the warehouse are approximately 115,000 square feet.
 
 
Item 4A.  
Unresolved Staff Comments
 
Not applicable.
 

 
Item 5.  
Operating and Financial Review and Prospects
 
This discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, and we intend that such forward-looking statements be subject to the safe harbors created thereby. Forward-looking statements are statements other than historical information or statements of current condition. Words such as may, will, expect, believe, anticipate, intend, could, estimate, continue, or the negative or comparable terminology are intended to identify forward-looking statements. In addition, any statements that refer to expectations, projections or other characterizations of future events and circumstances are considered forward-looking statements. They are not guarantees of future performance and involve risks and uncertainties. Actual results may differ materially from those in forward-looking statements due to various factors including economic uncertainty (including our ability to quickly adapt cost structures with anticipated levels of business, ability to manage inventory levels with market demand); future economic, competitive, financial and market condition; capital spending levels in the telecommunications industry; limited visibility with regards to customer orders and the timing of such orders; fluctuating exchange rates; our ability to successfully integrate our acquired and to-be-acquired businesses; consolidation in the global telecommunications test and service assurance industry and increased competition among vendors; concentration of sales; market acceptance of our new products and other upcoming products; our ability to successfully expand international operations; and the retention of key technical and management personnel. Assumptions relating to the foregoing involve judgments and risks, all of which are difficult or impossible to predict and many of which are beyond our control. Other risk factors that may affect our future performance and operations are detailed in our Annual Report, on Form 20-F, and our other filings with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission and the Canadian securities commissions. We believe that the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are reasonable based on information currently available to us, but we cannot assure you that the expectations will prove to have been correct. Accordingly, you should not place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements. These statements speak only as of the date of this document. Unless required by law or applicable regulations, we undertake no obligation to revise or update any of them to reflect events or circumstances that occur after the date of this document.
 
The following discussion and analysis of the consolidated financial condition and results of operations is dated November 7, 2011.
 
All dollar amounts are expressed in US dollars, except as otherwise noted.
 
 
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
 
Market conditions in the telecommunications industry remain tenuous based on weak global economic growth and unresolved sovereign debt issues in Europe. Despite this economic uncertainty, the fundamental drivers toward broadband deployments and fixed-mobile IP (Internet protocol) network convergence are entrenched in the telecommunications industry. Although network operators are not necessarily increasing capital expenditures in calendar 2011, they are spending more in select, high-growth areas to accommodate bandwidth-intensive broadband applications and to facilitate the migration to more flexible and cost-effective fixed and mobile IP networks.
 
According to Cisco’s Visual Networking Index, global IP traffic will quadruple from 2010 to 2015, reaching 966 exabytes per year in 2015. (An exabyte is equal to 1 billion gigabytes or 250 million DVDs). Global mobile traffic, a subset of this larger group, is expected to increase 26-fold during the same period. This explosive growth is being driven by a proliferation of media-rich communication devices (smartphones and tablets), growing number of Internet users, faster broadband speeds and increased video usage.
 


To support such bandwidth growth, wireline networks are being transformed into next-generation IP-based infrastructures. Legacy SONET/SDH networks, which were established in the mid-1980s, do not have the flexibility to seamlessly mix and transport voice, data and video services. These networks are not capable of efficiently carrying triple-play services because they were designed for point-to-point voice communication. As a result, new optical transport network (OTN) standards, which are at the very heart of what the industry is labeling next-generation IP networks, have been defined to carry IP applications over Ethernet. Network operators are increasingly turning to such next-generation, IP-based networks in order to offer customers higher-margin triple-play services while lowering their operating costs.
 
Fiber-to-the-home (FTTH) has also become the access network architecture of choice for wireline operators wishing to provide a superior user experience for a combined voice, data and video offering. This architecture allows operators to meet heightened bandwidth requirements and future-proof their access networks as residential bandwidth demands grow from 1 to 5 Mbit/s (megabits per second) to 30 to 100 Mbit/s required for the long term. Hybrid architectures, combining copper and fiber (fiber-to-the-curb, or FTTC, and fiber-to-the-node, or FTTN), will also increase in the short term, since they are less expensive methods to increase bandwidth and can be mass-deployed quickly.
 
As bandwidth growth in access networks continues to increase, it has begun placing a strain on metro rings and core networks. It is also driving the need for higher-speed technologies. For example, 43 Gbit/s (gigabits per second) SONET/SDH is becoming mainstream, while commercial deployments of 100 Gbit/s Ethernet networks are beginning to take place. In the long run, these solutions will offer a more economical way to add capacity to saturated network links, especially if trenches need to be dug in order to deploy new fiber in metro and long-distance routes.
 
On the wireless side, operators are also faced with major investments to meet soaring bandwidth demand. Wireless operators are accelerating deployments of 3G networks, fast-tracking 4G/LTE (long-term evolution) adoption, and investing in mobile backhaul networks in order to increase transmission rates for bandwidth-hungry consumers to approach wireline speeds. Furthermore, as these consumers expect wireline and wireless networks to transport any  content  to any device  at any time, both fixed and mobile networks are converging to a common IP-based infrastructure supported by IMS (IP multimedia subsystem) for seamless network interoperability.
 
These market dynamics affected telecom test and service assurance suppliers in fiscal 2011.
 
 
COMPANY OVERVIEW
 
We are a leading provider of next-generation test and service assurance solutions for wireline and wireless network operators and equipment manufacturers in the global telecommunications industry. We offer core-to-edge solutions that assess the performance and reliability of converged, IP fixed and mobile networks. Our test and service assurance solutions specifically target high-growth market opportunities related to optimizing next-generation networks: wireless backhaul, 4G/LTE (long-term evolution), fiber-to-the-home (FTTH)/fiber-to-the-curb (FTTC)/fiber-to-the-node (FTTN), carrier Ethernet, and 40G/100G network upgrades. Customers on a global basis rely on our test and service assurance solutions to enable their wireline and wireless networks to perform optimally during their complete lifecycles: research, development, manufacturing, installation, maintenance and monitoring. Our success has been largely predicated on our core expertise in developing telecom test equipment for wireline network operators and to a lesser extent equipment manufacturers, but over the years we have expanded our offering to wireless network operators, cable television companies, public utilities, private network operators, third-party installers, equipment rental companies, large enterprises, component vendors and laboratory researchers.
 
We have a staff of approximately 1800 people in 25 countries, supporting more than 2000 telecom customers in approximately 100 countries around the world. We operate three main manufacturing sites, which are located in Quebec City, Canada, in Shenzhen, China and in Oulu, Finland. We also have six main research and development expertise centers in Boston, Toronto, Montreal, Quebec City, Oulu and Lappeenranta, supplemented by two software development centers in India.
 


In June 2011, we undertook the construction of a new building in Montreal, Canada. Total costs for the new building are estimated to approximately $22 million (CA$21.5 million). The construction is expected to be completed in the third quarter of fiscal 2012.
 
In fiscal 2010, we engaged in a plan to sell our Life Sciences and Industrial Division to focus our activities in the telecom test and service assurance market. On October 1, 2010, we closed the sale of that Division for total proceeds of $21.6 million, net of a bank overdraft of $303,000, selling costs of $909,000 and future income taxes of $141,000. As such, this Division has been presented as a discontinued operation in our consolidated financial statements. Assets and liabilities for the comparative year ended August 31, 2010 have been reclassified as assets held for sale and liabilities related to assets held for sale; revenues and expenses have been classified as discontinued operations for all years presented. The Life Sciences and Industrial Division included the operations of EFOS Inc. (renamed EXFO Photonic Solutions Inc.), acquired in March 2001 for its precision light-based, adhesive spot-curing technology as well as most of the operations of Burleigh Instruments, Inc. (renamed EXFO Burleigh Products Group Inc.), acquired in December 2000 for its wavelength measurement instruments and nanopositioning alignment systems, which were consolidated since then with those of EXFO Photonic Solutions Inc. The operations of that Division were located in Toronto, Canada.
 
On March 12, 2010, we acquired 91% of the issued and outstanding common shares of NetHawk Oyj (NetHawk). Headquartered in Oulu, Finland, NetHawk was a privately owned company providing 2G, 3G and 4G/LTE protocol analyzers and simulators aimed mostly at network equipment manufacturers and wireless network operators. On March 15, 2010, we made a voluntary offer to purchase the remaining issued and outstanding shares; this offer expired on April 30, 2010. Simultaneously, we entered into a statutory procedure under the Finnish Companies Act by which we acquired the remaining issued and outstanding common shares that were not tendered under the voluntary offer. Total consideration was comprised of a cash consideration of €37.3 million (US$51.1 million), including acquisition-related costs of $2.8 million, or €25.1 million (US$34.4 million), excluding NetHawk’s cash of €12.1 million (US$16.7 million) at the acquisition date, plus a cash contingent consideration of up to €8.7 million (US$11.0 million) based on a certain sales volume of NetHawk products over the three years following the acquisition. The cash contingent consideration will be accounted for as additional goodwill when the amounts of any contingent consideration can be reasonably estimated and the outcome of the contingency is resolved. Acquisition-related costs included an amount of $780,000 for a statutory transfer tax payable in Finland based on the purchase price of shares.
 
We launched 19 new products in fiscal 2011, compared to 20 in fiscal 2010. Key product introductions in fiscal 2011 included EXFO Connect, a software suite of test management solutions for network operators to significantly increase productivity and reduce operating expenses. We also launched our intelligent Optical Link Mapper (iOLM), an innovative test solution that characterizes fiber-to-the-home (FTTH) networks 85% faster than the traditional method through the automated setting of complex OTDR acquisition parameters. In addition, we introduced our FTB-1 platform for FTTH and Ethernet testing applications. Finally, we released BrixHawk DA and BrixHawk SA, fully integrated solutions for the turn-up, troubleshooting and monitoring of 2G, 3G and 4G/LTE wireless networks.
 
We reported record-high sales of $269.7 million from our continuing operations (formerly our Telecom Division) in fiscal 2011, which represented an increase of 33.0% year-over-year from $202.8 million in 2010. Sales for fiscal 2011 included $29.7 million from NetHawk, which was acquired on March 12, 2010, compared to $14.5 million in 2010. Excluding the positive impact of the acquisition of NetHawk and the foreign exchange gains on our forward exchange contracts ($2.8 million in 2011 vs. $1.5 million in 2010), our sales would have increased 27.1% year-over-year organically.
 
In fiscal 2011, we believe that we benefited from increased capital-intensive deployments and capacity expansion from wireless and wireline network operators compared to 2010. In addition, in fiscal 2011, we benefited from improved market conditions compared to 2010, following the worldwide economic recession in 2009. Furthermore, we benefited from our strong product offering that we believe is greatly aligned with the major trend of bandwidth demand. Also, we believe we gained overall market share in fiscal 2011, which contributed also to the increase in our sales year-over-year. Finally, in fiscal 2011, we benefited from larger calendar year-end budget spending from some of our customers, compared to 2010, which increased our sales year-over-year.
 


We reported GAAP net earnings from continuing operations of $6.4 million, or $0.10 per diluted share, in fiscal 2011, compared to $3.6 million, or $0.06 per diluted share, in 2010. Net earnings from continuing operations for fiscal 2011 included $8.7 million in after-tax amortization of intangible assets and $2.0 million in stock-based compensation costs. Net earnings from continuing operations for fiscal 2010 included $6.5 million in after-tax amortization of intangible assets and $1.7 million in stock-based compensation costs. Earnings from operations (from continuing operations) significantly improved 70.3% year-over-year from $10.9 million, or 5.4% of sales in fiscal 2010, to $18.5 million, or 6.9% of sales in 2011, despite a headwind from a stronger Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar year-over-year.
 
Adjusted EBITDA (net earnings before interest, income taxes, amortization of property, plant and equipment, amortization of intangible assets and gain from disposal of discontinued operations) reached $30.6 million or 11.3% of global sales in fiscal 2011, compared to $27.3 million, or 12.0% of global sales in 2010. Adjusted EBIDTA in fiscal 2011 included a foreign exchange loss of $3.8 million ($1.5 million in 2010). See further in this document for a complete reconciliation of adjusted EBITDA to GAAP net earnings.
 
In fiscal 2011, we faced a substantial increase in the value of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar compared to 2010; this had a two-fold negative impact on our financial results. Firstly, the average value of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar increased 5.6% in fiscal 2011, compared to 2010. Given that a significant portion of our sales are denominated in US dollars but a significant portion of our expenses are denominated in Canadian dollars, our financial results were negatively affected as these expenses (denominated in Canadian dollars) increased when translated in US dollars for reporting purposes in fiscal 2011.
 
Secondly, we recorded a significant foreign exchange loss of $3.8 million in fiscal 2011, which mainly represents the effect of the 9.0% increase in the period-end value of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar on our balance sheet items during that year. In comparison, in fiscal 2010, we reported a foreign exchange loss of $1.5 million following the increase in the value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar, the euro and the British pound during that year.
 
On November 5, 2010 we announced that our Board of Directors approved the renewal of our share repurchase program, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market of up to 10% of our public float (as defined by the Toronto Stock Exchange), or 2.0 million of subordinate voting shares at the prevailing market price. The normal course issuer bid started on November 10, 2010, and will end on November 9, 2011. As at November 7, 2011, the company had redeemed for cancellation 25,055 shares under that program for an aggregate net purchase price of $144,197.
 
On November 7, 2011 we announced that our Board of Directors approved the renewal of our share repurchase program, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market of up to 2% of the issued and outstanding subordinate voting shares, representing 575,690 subordinate voting shares at the prevailing market price. We expect to use cash, short-term investments or future cash flow from operations to fund the repurchase of shares. The normal course issuer bid will start on November 10, 2011, and will end on November 9, 2012, or on an earlier date if we repurchase the maximum number of shares permitted under the bid. The program does not require that we repurchase any specific number of shares, and it may be modified, suspended or terminated at any time and without prior notice. All shares repurchased under the bid will be cancelled. We shall provide to any person or company, upon request to our Secretary, at 400 Godin Avenue, Quebec, Province of Quebec, Canada, G1M 2K2, phone number (418) 683-0913 ext. 23704 or fax number (418) 683-9839, a copy of the notice sent to the Toronto Stock Exchange (TSX) according to our normal course issuer bid.

 

Sales
 
We sell our products to a diversified customer base in approximately 100 countries through our direct sales force and channel partners, such as sales representatives and distributors. Most of our sales are denominated in US dollars and euros.
 
In fiscal 2010 and 2011, no customer accounted for more than 10% of our sales, with our top customer representing 4.9% and 7.2% of our sales, respectively. In fiscal 2009, our top customer accounted for 13.1% of sales.
 
We believe that we have a vast array of products, a diversified customer base, and a good spread across geographical areas, which provides us with reasonable protection against the concentration of sales and credit risk.
 
Cost of Sales
 
The cost of sales includes raw materials, salaries and related expenses for direct and indirect manufacturing personnel (net of government grants), as well as overhead costs. Excess, obsolete and scrapped materials are also included in the cost of sales. However, the cost of sales is exclusive of amortization, which is shown separately in the statements of earnings.
 
Operating Expenses
 
We classify our operating expenses into three main categories: selling and administrative expenses, research and development expenses, and amortization expenses.
 
Selling and administrative expenses consist primarily of salaries and related expenses for personnel, sales commissions, travel expenses, marketing programs, professional services, information systems, human resources and other corporate expenses.
 
Gross research and development expenses consist primarily of salaries and related expenses for engineers and other technical personnel, material component costs as well as fees paid to third-party consultants. We are eligible to receive research and development tax credits and grants on research and development activities carried out in Canada and Finland. All related research and development tax credits and grants are recorded as a reduction of gross research and development expenses.
 
 
OUR STRATEGY, KEY PERFORMANCE INDICATORS AND CAPABILITY TO DELIVER RESULTS
 
Three-Year Strategic Objectives
 
Our long-term goal is to become the market leader in the global telecom test and service assurance industry. Given explosive bandwith demand and IP convergence, wireless and wireline network operators and equipment manufacturers are faced with a major spending cycle to meet soaring bandwidth demand on their converged, IP fixed and mobile networks.
 
To achieve our goal, we plan to:
 
·  
Capitalize on bandwidth explosion in the telecom industry with the introduction of innovative, market-driven test and service assurance solutions;
 
·  
Focus on the convergence of IP fixed and mobile networks, including emerging technologies like 4G/LTE and high-speed Ethernet;
 
·  
Leverage our leadership in optical testing for new opportunities like wireless backhaul, fiber- to-the-home, and 40G and 100G network upgrades;
 
·  
Move up the IP networks value chain by leveraging the intelligence, or computing capacities, of our modular test platforms with our service assurance systems to develop a series of value-added solutions; and
 
·  
Accelerate profitability through globalization and execution.
 
 

To gauge the success of our strategy, we had established three corporate performance objectives for the three-year period ending in fiscal 2012:
 
o  
Increase sales by a CAGR* of at least 25%
o  
Raise gross margin to 65%
o  
Increase adjusted EBITDA** in dollars by a CAGR of at least 30%
 
*
Compound annual growth rate
**
EBITDA is defined as net earnings (loss) before interest, income taxes, amortization of property, plant and equipment, amortization of intangible assets and impairment of goodwill. Adjusted EBITDA represents EBITDA excluding the gain from the disposal of discontinued operations.
 
These three-year objectives were established based on results achieved in the past few years as well as on our strategic plan for that three-year period. We are witnessing a period of significant investments in the telecom industry and we believe that we are well-positioned to take advantage of the wealth of growth opportunities—from the network core to the edge. Namely, we expect to benefit from high-growth sectors like 4G/LTE applications, wireless backhaul, fiber-to-the-home, Carrier Ethernet, as well as 40G and 100G network upgrades to bolster sales and earnings. These objectives will guide our actions in upcoming years as we are committed to maximizing shareholder value.
 
Results Achieved in Fiscal 2011
 
Our corporate performance objectives take into account the sales and operating results of our Life Sciences and Industrial Division, which are now presented as discontinued operations in our GAAP figures for fiscal 2009, 2010 and 2011. As such, sales and operating results of that Division were included in the results achieved in fiscal 2011.
 
Following are our results after two years into our three-year plan:
 
Corporate Performance Objectives (Fiscal 2010-2012)
Objectives
Metrics
Results After Two Years
Increase sales by a CAGR* of at least:
25%
25.4%
Raise gross margin from 61.3% to:
65%
62.7%
Increase adjusted EBITDA** in dollars by a CAGR* of at least:
30%
45.4%
 
In fiscal 2011, sales including those of the discontinued operations amounted to $271.7 million, which represents a CAGR of 25.4% after two years. Our gross margin, including the effect of the discontinued operations, reached 62.7%, 0.3% higher compared to 62.4% in 2010. Finally, adjusted EBITDA, including the operating results of the discontinued operations, amounted to $30.6 million or 11.3 % of sales in fiscal 2011, representing a CAGR of 45.4% after two years. See further in this document for a reconciliation of the GAAP sales and GAAP gross margin to the global sales and global gross margin, including the effect of the discontinued operations and a reconciliation of GAAP net earnings (loss) to adjusted EBITDA.
 
Given our strong positioning for key growth opportunities and disciplined focus on execution, we remain committed achieving or finishing close to our three-year corporate performance objectives that reach maturity at the end of fiscal 2012. However, continuing uncertainty in the global economy or possible worldwide recession will impact the achievement of our three-year objectives.
 

 
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND ESTIMATES
 
Management’s discussion and analysis of financial conditions and results of operations is based on our consolidated financial statements. As previously mentioned, they have been prepared in accordance with Canadian GAAP. The preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, as well as the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting years. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate these estimates and assumptions, including those related to the fair value of financial instruments, the allowance for doubtful accounts receivable, the amount of tax credits recoverable, the provision for excess and obsolete inventories, the estimated useful lives of capital assets, the valuation of long-lived assets, the impairment of goodwill, the valuation allowance of future income tax assets, the amount of certain accrued liabilities and deferred revenue as well as stock-based compensation costs. We base our estimates and assumptions on historical experience and on other factors that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances, the result of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results could differ from these estimates.
 
The following summarizes our critical accounting policies as well as other policies that require the most significant judgment and estimates in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements.
 
Revenue recognition. Our multiple deliverable revenue arrangements may include tangible products (software and/or non-software components), extended warranties, maintenance contracts, post-contract customer support (PCS) on software components as well as installation.
 
Since September 1, 2010, when a sales arrangement contains multiple elements and software and non-software components function together to deliver the tangible products’ essential functionality, we allocate revenue to each element based on the relative selling price of each element. Under this approach, the selling price of a deliverable is determined by using a selling price hierarchy which requires the use of vendor-specific objective evidence (“VSOE”) of fair value if available, third-party evidence (“TPE”) if VSOE is not available, or best estimated selling price (“BESP”) if neither VSOE nor TPE are available.
 
We establish VSOE of selling price using the price charged for a deliverable when sold separately and, in some instances, using the price established by management having the relevant authority. TPE of selling price is established by evaluating similar and interchangeable competitor goods or services in sales to similarly situated customers. When VSOE or TPE are not available, we use BESP. We establish BESP using historical selling price trends, if available, and considering multiple factors including, but not limited to geography, market conditions, competitive landscape, internal costs and pricing practices. When determining BESP, management applies judgment when establishing pricing strategies and evaluating market conditions and product lifecycles. The determination of BESP is made through consultation with and approval by management. We may modify or develop new pricing practices and strategies in the future. As these pricing strategies evolve, we may modify our pricing practices in the future, which may result in changes in BESP. The aforementioned factors may result in a different allocation of revenue to the deliverables in multiple-element arrangements from the current period, which may change the pattern and timing of revenue recognition for these elements but will not change the total revenue recognized for the arrangement.
 
Maintenance contracts are usually offered to customers for periods of twelve to thirty-six months. They generally include the right to unspecified upgrades and enhancements on a when-and-if-available basis as well as customer service. They qualify as a separate unit of accounting. Revenue from these contracts is recognized ratably over the terms of the maintenance contracts on a straight-line basis. The selling price of the maintenance contracts is determined using VSOE.
 
Extended warranties are usually offered to customers for periods of twelve to forty-eight months. They qualify as a separate unit of accounting. Revenue from these extended warranties is recognized ratably over the warranty period on a straight-line basis. The selling price of the extended warranties is determined using BESP.
 

 
When a sales arrangement contains multiple elements and software and non-software components do not function together to deliver the tangible products’ essential functionality, we allocate revenue between the tangible products and the PCS, if any, based on VSOE of selling price of each element. PCS revenues are deferred and recognized ratably over the years of the support arrangement. PCS revenues are recognized at the time the product is delivered when provided substantially within one year of delivery, the costs of providing this support are insignificant (and accrued at the time of delivery), and no (or infrequent) software upgrades or enhancements are provided.
 
Allowance for doubtful accounts. We estimate collectability of accounts receivable on an ongoing basis by reviewing balances outstanding over a certain period of time. We determine our allowance for doubtful accounts receivable based on our historical accounts receivable collection experience and on the information that we have about the status of our accounts receivable balances. If the financial conditions of our customers deteriorate, resulting in an impairment of their ability to make required payments, additional allowance may be required, which could adversely affect our future results.
 
Reserve for excess and obsolete inventories. We state our inventories at the lower of cost, determined on an average cost basis, and net realizable value, and we provide reserves for excess and obsolete inventories. We determine our reserves for excess and obsolete inventories based on the quantities we have on hand versus expected needs for these inventories, so as to support future sales of our products. Expected needs are usually estimated over a twelve-month period. It is possible that additional inventory reserves may occur if future sales are less than our forecasts or if there is a significant shift in product mix compared to our forecasts, which could adversely affect our future results.
 
Research and development tax credits and grants. We record research and development tax credits and grants based on our interpretation of tax laws and grant programs, especially regarding related eligible projects and expenses, and when there is reasonable assurance that we have complied and will continue to comply with all conditions and laws. Also, our judgment and estimates are based on historical experience. It is possible, however, that the tax authorities or the sponsors of the grant programs have a different interpretation of laws and application of conditions related to the programs, or that we do not comply with all conditions related to grants in the future, which could adversely affect our future results. Furthermore, a significant part of our research and development tax credits are refundable against income taxes payable, causing their ultimate realization to be dependent upon the generation of taxable income. If we obtain information that causes our forecast of future taxable income to change or if actual taxable income differs from our forecast, we may have to revise the carrying value of these tax credits, which would affect our results in the period in which the change was made.
 
Impairment of long-lived assets and goodwill. Long-lived assets are reviewed for impairment when events or circumstances indicate that cost may not be recoverable. Impairment exists when the carrying amount of an asset, or a group of assets is greater than the undiscounted future cash flows expected to be provided by the asset or the group of assets. The amount of impairment loss, if any, is the excess of the carrying value over the fair value. We assess fair value of long-lived assets based on discounted future cash flows.
 
We assess impairment of goodwill on an annual basis, or more frequently, if events or circumstances indicate that it might be impaired. Recoverability of goodwill is determined at the reporting unit level, using a two-step approach. First, the carrying value of a reporting unit is compared to its fair value, which is usually determined based on a combination of discounted future cash flows and a market approach. If the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step is performed. In this step, the amount of impairment loss, if any, represents the excess of the carrying value of goodwill over its fair value, and the loss is charged to earnings in the period in which it is incurred. For the purposes of this impairment test, the fair value of goodwill is estimated in the same way as goodwill is determined in business combinations; that is, the excess of the fair value of a reporting unit over the fair value of its net identifiable assets. Future discounted cash flows may be lower than expected and our stock price may decrease to a level that would cause the fair value of our reporting units to be lower than their carrying value. This may lead to goodwill impairment loss in the future.
 

 
Future income taxes. We provide for income taxes using the liability method of tax allocation. Under this method, future income tax assets and liabilities are determined based on deductible or taxable temporary differences between financial statement values and tax values of assets and liabilities as well as the carry-forward of unused tax losses and deductions, using substantively enacted income tax rates expected for the years in which the assets are expected to be realized or the liabilities to be settled. In assessing the recoverability of our future income tax assets, we consider whether it is more likely than not that some or all of the future income tax assets will not be realized. The ultimate realization of our future income tax assets is dependent upon the generation of sufficient future taxable income during the periods in which those assets are expected to be realized.
 
Stock-based compensation costs. We account for stock-based compensation on stock options, restricted share units and deferred share units, using the fair value-based method. This method requires that we make estimates about the expected volatility of our shares, the expected life of the awards and the forfeiture rate.We account for stock-based compensation on stock appreciation rights, using the intrinsic value method. Stock-based compensation costs are amortized to expense over the vesting periods.
 
New accounting standards and pronouncements
 
Adopted in fiscal 2011
 
In December 2009, the Canadian Institute of Chartered Accountants’ (CICA) Emerging Issues Committee (EIC) issued EIC-175, “Multiple Deliverable Revenue Arrangements”, which is applicable prospectively (with retrospective adoption permitted) to revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables entered into or materially modified in the first annual period beginning on January 1, 2011. EIC-175 amends the guidance contained in EIC-142, “Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables”, and establishes additional requirements regarding revenue recognition related to multiple deliverables as well as supplementary disclosures. We adopted this standard prospectively to arrangements entered into on or after September 1, 2010, and its adoption had no material effect on our consolidated financial statements. However, a description of our revenue recognition policy has been modified accordingly.
 
Prior to September 1, 2010, for products in which software was incidental, we recognized revenue when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, the product had been delivered, the price was fixed or determinable, and collection of the resulting receivable was reasonably assured. Provisions were made for estimated returns, warranties and support obligations. For products in which software was not incidental, revenues were separated into two categories: product and post-contract customer support (PCS) revenues, based upon VSOE of fair value. Product revenues for these sales were recognized as described above. PCS revenues were deferred and recognized ratably over the years of the support arrangement. PCS revenues were recognized at the time the product was delivered when provided substantially within one year of delivery, the costs of providing this support were insignificant (and accrued at the time of delivery), and no (or infrequent) software upgrades or enhancements were provided.
 
To be adopted after fiscal 2011
 
We will cease to prepare our consolidated financial statements in accordance with Canadian GAAP as set out in Part V of the CICA Handbook – Accounting ("Canadian GAAP") for the periods beginning on September 1, 2011, when we will start to apply as our primary basis of accounting the International Financial Reporting Standards published by the International Accounting Standards Board and set out in Part I of the CICA Handbook – Accounting. Consequently, future accounting changes to Canadian GAAP are not discussed in these consolidated financial statements as they will never be applied by the company.
 
International financial reporting standards (IFRS)
 
In February 2008, the Canadian Accounting Standards Board announced that Canadian GAAP, as used by publicly accountable enterprises, will be converged with the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standard Board (IASB). Accordingly, we will adopt these standards during our fiscal year beginning on September 1, 2011, and we will be required to report under IFRS and to provide IFRS comparative information for the fiscal year ended on August 31, 2011 (current fiscal year). Although the conceptual framework of IFRS is similar to Canadian GAAP, there are significant differences on recognition, measurement and disclosures.
 

 
As part of the IFRS conversion project, we have set up an IFRS-dedicated team at different levels of the organization and have also retained the services of an external expert advisor to assist us. A process for reporting regular progress to senior management and to the Audit Committee on the status of the IFRS conversion project has been established.
 
The conversion project consists of four phases.
 
·  
Diagnostic phase – This phase involves an initial scoping of significant accounting differences between Canadian GAAP and IFRS, a preliminary evaluation of IFRS 1 exemptions for first-time IFRS adopters, and a high-level assessment of potential consequences on financial reporting, business processes, internal controls and information systems.
 
·  
Design and Solutions Development phase – This phase involves a detailed analysis of identified accounting treatment differences, reviewing and approving accounting policy choices, performing a detailed impact assessment and designing changes to systems and business processes, developing IFRS training material, and drafting IFRS financial statement content.
 
·  
Implementation phase – This phase involves embedding changes to systems, business processes and internal controls, determining the opening IFRS transition balance sheet and tax impacts, parallel accounting under Canadian GAAP and IFRS, and preparing detailed reconciliations of Canadian GAAP to IFRS financial statements.
 
·  
Post-Implementation phase – This phase involves conversion assessment, evaluating improvements for a sustainable operational IFRS model, and testing the internal controls environment.
 
We have completed the Diagnostic phase to assess and scope the significant differences between existing Canadian GAAP and IFRS as well as the impact on our consolidated financial statements.
 
In addition, we have completed the Design and Solutions Development phase to evaluate the overall impact of adopting these new standards on our consolidated financial statements. We have also completed a detailed analysis of the accounting policies affected by the adoption of IFRS.
 
Finally, we have completed the Implementation phase. The opening balance sheet as at September 1, 2010 is finalized while the IFRS model consolidated financial statements are being finalized. We have analyzed the effects on information technology and internal controls and have not identified significant modifications to our information technology, data systems and internal controls. We have provided training for key employees and stakeholders. Additional training will be given when necessary until full adoption in fiscal 2012.
 
IFRS 1, First-time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards, provides guidelines for the initial adoption of IFRS. IFRS 1 requires full retroactive application of applicable IFRS at the end of the first disclosure period. However, IFRS 1 sets out optional exemptions for some specific standards where costs of complying with these requirements may exceed the benefits for users of financial statements. IFRS 1 also sets out compulsory exceptions in specific cases where retroactive application would require management’s judgments on past events for which the conclusions are already known.
 
Our conclusions on the optional exemptions permitted by IFRS 1 as well as significant differences with respect to recognition, measurement, presentation and disclosure of financial information are in the following key accounting areas:
 

 
a)  
Tax credits recoverable
 
Under IFRS, long-term tax credits recoverable must be discounted using risk-free interest rates for the periods when tax credits will be recovered. Under Canadian GAAP, such treatment is not required. As at September 1, 2010, being the transition date, this resulted in a decrease of our long-term tax credits recoverable of $2.5 million and an increase of our deferred income tax assets of $678,000, with a net decrease of the opening balance of retained earnings (shareholders’ equity) of $1.8 million. As at August 31, 2011, this resulted in a decrease of our long-term tax credits recoverable of $2.5 million, an increase of our deferred income tax assets of $401,000 and a decrease of our deferred tax liabilities of $276,000. For the year ended August, 31, 2011, changes in the discounted value of our long-term tax credits recoverable resulted in an interest income of $227,000 and a related deferred income tax expense of $61,000. It also resulted in a net increase of shareholders’ equity of $2,000, which includes a foreign currency translation loss of $163,000.
 
b)  
Property, plant and equipment
 
IAS 16, “Property, Plant and Equipment”, reinforces the requirement under Canadian GAAP that requires that each part of property, plant and equipment that has a cost that is significant in relation to the overall cost of the item should be depreciated separately. Based on the analysis of our property, plant and equipment, we do not expect additional componentization under IFRS.
 
In addition, under IFRS, depreciation must be based on the allocation of the depreciable amount over the asset’s estimated useful life. Depreciable amount is defined as the cost of the asset less its residual value. Residual value is defined as the estimated amount that an entity would currently obtain from disposal of the asset, after deducting the estimated cost of disposal, if the asset were already of the age and in the condition expected at the end of its useful life. Under Canadian GAAP, the depreciable amount of an asset is the greater of the cost less salvage value over the life of the asset, and the cost less residual value over the useful life of the asset. Residual value is the estimated net realizable value of an item of property, plant and equipment at the end of its useful life to the company. Salvage value is the estimated net realizable value of an item of property, plant and equipment at the end of its life. Canadian GAAP concept of salvage value and economic life for purposes of calculating depreciation (i.e., the value of an asset at the end of its life) is disallowed under IFRS. On September 1, 2010, this resulted in an increase of the carrying value of property, plant and equipment of $1.3 million and a decrease of our deferred income tax assets of $345,000, with a net increase of the opening balance of retained earnings (shareholders’ equity) of $931,000. As at August 31, 2011, this resulted in an increase of our property, plant and equipment of $1.5 million, a decrease of our deferred tax assets of $241,000 and an increase of our deferred tax liabilities of $166,000. For the year ended August 31, 2011, this resulted in a decrease of depreciation of property, plant and equipment of $117,000 and a deferred income tax expense of $32,000. It also resulted in a net increase of shareholders’ equity of $171,000, which includes a foreign exchange translation gain of $86,000.
 
c)  
Business combinations
 
As permitted by IFRS 1, “First Time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS)”, we will not apply IFRS 3R, “Business Combinations”, to business combinations completed before the transition date, that is, September 1, 2010. However, under IAS 37, “Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets”, the cash contingent consideration for the acquisition of NetHawk Oyj, completed before the transition date and outstanding as at September 1, 2010, should be recorded at fair value on that date with a corresponding adjustment  to  opening  retained  earnings.  Thereafter, the fair value of the cash  contingent  consideration is re-assessed at the end of each reporting periods and any changes in the fair value will be recognized in the statement of earnings. On September 1, 2010, the fair value of the contingent cash consideration was estimated at $2.7 million based on information available at that time and recorded in long-term liabilities, with a corresponding decrease of the opening balance of retained earnings (shareholders’ equity). On August 31, 2011, the fair value of the contingent cash consideration was reassessed to $338,000, based on revised sales forecasts. The change in the fair value in the amount of $2.7 million, which includes the effect of the foreign currency translation of $363,000, was recorded in the statement of earnings in fiscal 2011. This also resulted in a net increase of the shareholders’ equity of $2.3 million as at August 31, 2011.
 

 
d)  
Presentation of financial statements
 
Under IFRS we elected to present non-refundable research and development tax credits against gross research and development expenses in the statement of earnings as currently required under Canadian GAAP.
 
e)  
Hedge accounting
 
IAS 39, “Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement”, does not permit to use the shortcut method to assess hedge effectiveness of hedging relationships. We have elected to use the dollar-offset method, as permitted by IFRS, to assess the effectiveness of our cash flow hedges and we will recalculate the effectiveness with this new method, which may potentially result into ineffectiveness that did not exist under the previous method. However, we do not anticipate significant reclassification of hedge relationships. The review of our documentation was completed as at September 1, 2010, being the transition date.
 
f)  
Impairment of assets
 
IAS 36, “Impairment of Assets”, requires a single-step approach for impairment testing of individual assets or a group of assets in cash-generating units (CGUs) on the basis of independent cash inflows whereas Canadian GAAP uses a two-step approach. However, there was no additional impairment due to that one-step approach.
 
g)  
Leases
 
Under IAS 17, “Leases”, a lease is classified as either a finance lease or an operating lease. Lease classification depends on whether substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to ownership of the leased assets have been transferred from the lessor to the lessee, and is made at inception of the lease. A number of indicators are used to assist in lease classification; however, quantitative thresholds are not offered as indicators as under current Canadian GAAP. We reviewed all existing significant leases, which are classified as operating leases under Canadian GAAP, and concluded that their classification is in accordance with IAS 17.
 
h)  
Translation of foreign operations
 
Under IAS 21, “The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates”, for foreign entities with the same functional currency as the parent company, the corresponding exchange difference is recognized in the statement of earnings of that entity; and for foreign entities with a functional currency other than the functional currency of the parent company, the corresponding exchange differences should be recognized in a separate component of other comprehensive income. We assessed the functional currency of our foreign operations and concluded that the adoption of IAS 21 will have no impact on our consolidated financial statements.
 
This is not an exhaustive list of all the impacts that could occur during the conversion to IFRS.
 
The following tables summarize the impacts that the transition to IFRS will have on our balance sheet items as at September 1, 2010 and August 31, 2011 as well as on our statement of earnings for the year ended August 31, 2011. The reported adjustments have no impact on sales, cost of sales, selling and administrative expenses, as well as net research and development expenses reported under Canadian GAAP for the year ended August 31, 2011.
 

 
         
As at September 1, 2010
 
                         
   
Note
   
Assets
   
Liabilities
   
Shareholders' equity
 
Under Canadian GAAP
        $ 273,502     $ 53,083     $ 220,419  
                               
Tax credits recoverable
    a)       (2,510 )           (2,510 )
Property, plant and equipment
    b)       1,275             1,275  
Deferred income taxes
    a), b)       333             333  
Cash contingent consideration
    c)             2,660       (2,660 )
              (902 )     2,660       (3,562 )
Under IFRS
          $ 272,600     $ 55,743     $ 216,857  

 
         
Year ended August 31, 2011
 
                               
   
Note
   
Earnings from operations
   
Net
earnings
   
Basic net earnings
per share
   
Diluted net earnings
per share
 
Under Canadian GAAP
        $ 18,503     $ 19,349     $ 0.32     $ 0.31  
                                       
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment
    b)       117       117                  
Change in the fair value of the cash contingent consideration
    c)       2,685       2,685                  
Interest income
    a)             227                  
Deferred income taxes
    a), b)             (93 )                
Under IFRS
          $ 21,305     $ 22,285     $ 0.37     $ 0.36  

 
         
As at August 31, 2011
 
                         
   
Note
   
Assets
   
Liabilities
   
Shareholders' equity
 
Under Canadian GAAP
        $ 321,086     $ 57,340     $ 263,746  
                               
Tax credits recoverable
    a)       (2,507 )           (2,507 )
Property, plant and equipment
    b)       1,510             1,510  
Deferred income taxes
    a), b)       160       (110 )     270  
Cash contingent consideration
    c)             338       (338 )
              (837 )     228       (1,065 )
Under IFRS
          $ 320,249     $ 57,568     $ 262,681  
 
As the IASB continues to amend and add to current IFRS standards with several projects underway, we continue to track the progress of these projects. Our IFRS project is progressing according to plan, and we will provide updates as further progress is achieved.
 


RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
The following table sets forth Canadian GAAP consolidated financial statements data in thousands of US dollars, except per-share data, and as a percentage of sales for the years indicated:
 
Consolidated statements of earnings data:
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Sales
  $ 269,743     $ 202,757     $ 153,082       100.0 %     100.0 %     100.0 %
Cost of sales (1) 
    100,296       73,901       57,897       37.2       36.4       37.8  
Gross margin
    169,447       128,856       95,185       62.8       63.6       62.2  
Operating expenses
                                               
Selling and administrative
    87,062       66,612       58,067       32.3       32.9       37.9  
Net research and development
    47,927       37,847       27,213       17.7       18.7       17.8  
Amortization of property, plant and equipment
    6,772       5,757       4,453       2.5       2.8       2.9  
Amortization of intangible assets
    9,183       7,773       5,033       3.4       3.8       3.3  
Restructuring charges
                963                   0.6  
Impairment of goodwill
                21,713                   14.2  
Total operating expenses
    150,944       117,989       117,442       55.9       58.2       76.7  
Earnings (loss) from operations
    18,503       10,867       (22,257 )     6.9       5.4       (14.5 )
Interest and other income (expenses)
    511       (292 )     592       0.1       (0.1 )     0.4  
Foreign exchange gain (loss)
    (3,808 )     (1,496 )     1,074       (1.4 )     (0.8 )     0.7  
Earnings (loss) before income taxes
    15,206       9,079       (20,591 )     5.6       4.5       (13.4 )
Income taxes
    8,783       5,529       266       3.2       2.7       0.2  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations
    6,423       3,550       (20,857 )     2.4 %     1.8 %     (13.6 ) %
Net earnings from discontinued operations
    12,926       3,069       4,272                          
Net earnings (loss) for the year
  $ 19,349     $ 6,619     $ (16,585 )                        
Basic net earnings (loss) from continuing operations per share
  $ 0.11     $ 0.06     $ (0.34 )                        
                                                 
Diluted net earnings (loss) from continuing operations per share
  $ 0.10     $ 0.06     $ (0.34 )                        
                                                 
Basic net earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.32     $ 0.11     $ (0.27 )                        
                                                 
Diluted net earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.31     $ 0.11     $ (0.27 )                        
                                                 
                                                 
Research and development data:
                                               
Gross research and development
  $ 57,226     $ 44,551     $ 33,584       21.2 %     22.0 %     21.9 %
Net research and development
  $ 47,927     $ 37,847     $ 27,213       17.7 %     18.7 %     17.8 %
                                                 
Consolidated balance sheets data:
                                               
Total assets
  $ 321,086     $ 273,502     $ 240,371                          
 
(1)  
The cost of sales is exclusive of amortization, shown separately.
 
 

RESULTS FROM CONTINUING OPERATIONS (formerly the Telecom Division)
 
SALES
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
In fiscal 2011, our sales increased 33.0% to a record-high $269.7 million, compared to $202.8 million in 2010.
 
The following table summarizes information about our sales for the years ended August 31, 2010 and 2011, in thousands of US dollars:
 
   
Year ended
August 31, 2011
   
Year ended
August 31, 2010
   
Change
in $
   
Change
in %
 
                         
Sales
  $ 269,743     $ 202,757     $ 66,986       33.0 %
                                 
Gains on forward exchange contracts
    (2,795 )     (1,517 )     (1,278 )        
                                 
Sales, excluding gains on forward exchange contracts (non-GAAP measure)
    266,948       201,240       65,708       32.7  
                                 
Impact of the recent acquisition (NetHawk)
    (29,652 )     (14,483 )     (15,169 )        
                                 
Organic sales (non-GAAP measure)
  $ 237,296     $ 186,757     $ 50,539       27.1 %
 
See further in this document for information about non-GAAP financial measures.
 
In the last few months, following the worldwide economic recession of 2009, wireless and wireline network operators have been investing in capital-intensive deployments and capacity expansion in order to accommodate bandwidth-intensive applications and to facilitate the migration to more flexible and cost-effective fixed and mobile IP architectures. We believe that our product offering is greatly aligned with the major trend of bandwidth demand, for which network operators are investing. In fiscal 2011, we also believe we gained overall market share, which contributed to the increase of our sales year-over-year. We must also recall that during the first months of fiscal 2010, we were at the beginning of a slow recovery from the economic recession.
 
In fiscal 2011, NetHawk, which was acquired on March 12, 2010, reported sales of $29.7 million compared to $14.5 million in 2010, which contributed to the increase in our sales year-over-year. NetHawk contributed to the increase of our sales of protocol test solutions year-over-year.
 
Also, in the second quarter of fiscal 2011, we benefited from larger calendar year-end budget spending from some of our customers, compared to 2010, which increased our sales year-over-year. The magnitude of customers’ calendar year-end budget spending may fluctuate year-over-year.
 
Finally, in fiscal 2011, we recorded in our sales foreign exchange gains of $2.8 million on our forward exchange contracts, compared to $1.5 million in 2010, which contributed to the increase of our sales year-over-year.
 
In addition to the above-mentioned explanations about the year-over-year sales increase, the following table summarizes changes in sales by product lines:
 
   
Year ended
August 31, 2011
   
Year ended
August 31, 2010
   
Change in %
 
                   
Optical test solutions
  $ 139,525     $ 109,124       27.9 %
Protocol test solutions
    108,946       78,709       38.4  
Copper -access test solutions
    18,477       13,407       37.8  
                         
Sales, excluding gains on forward exchange contracts (non-GAAP measure)
  $ 266,948     $ 201,240       32.7 %
 
 

Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
In fiscal 2010, our sales increased 32.4% to $202.8 million from $153.1 million in 2009.
 
The following table summarizes information about our sales for the years ended August 31, 2009 and 2010, in thousands of US dollars:
 
   
Year ended
August 31, 2010
   
Year ended
August 31, 2009
   
Change
in $
   
Change
in %
 
                         
Sales
  $ 202,757     $ 153,082     $ 49,675       32.4 %
                                 
(Gains) losses on forward exchange contracts
    (1,517 )     3,178       (4,695 )        
                                 
Sales, excluding gains/losses on forward exchange contracts (non-GAAP measure)
    201,240       156,260       44,980       28.8  
                                 
Impact of the recent acquisition (NetHawk)
    (14,483 )           (14,483 )        
                                 
Organic sales (non-GAAP measure)
  $ 186,757     $ 156,260     $ 30,497       19.5 %
 
In fiscal 2010, we believe we gained market share, namely in the optical and copper-access space, which contributed to the increase of our sales year-over-year.
 
In addition, in fiscal 2010, NetHawk, which was acquired on March 12, 2010, contributed about five and a half months to our sales, which caused them to increase $14.5 million year-over-year. NetHawk contributed to the increase of our sales of protocol test solutions year-over-year.
 
Furthermore, in fiscal 2010, we benefited from improving economic and market conditions following the global economic recession that negatively affected our sales in fiscal 2009, allowing customers to invest in their networks in order to accommodate bandwidth-intensive applications and to facilitate the migration to more flexible and cost-effective fixed and mobile IP architectures. In 2009, many network operators delayed capital-intensive deployment decisions on FTTx rollouts and capacity expansion. However, in fiscal 2010, network operators restarted investing worldwide in capital-intensive deployments and capacity expansion on the basis of the recovery in the telecom market. These improved market conditions mainly contributed to the increase of our sales of optical and copper-access test solutions.
 
Finally, in fiscal 2010, we recorded in our sales foreign exchange gains of $1.5 million on our forward exchange contracts, compared to foreign exchange losses of $3.2 million in 2009, which contributed to the increase of our sales of $4.7 million year-over-year.
 
In addition to the above-mentioned explanations about the year-over-year sales increase, the following table summarizes changes in sales by product lines:
 
   
Year ended
August 31, 2010
   
Year ended
August 31, 2009
   
Change in %
 
                   
Optical test solutions
  $ 109,124     $ 95,532       14.2 %
Protocol test solutions
    78,709       54,929       43.3  
Copper -access test solutions
    13,407       5,799       131.2  
                         
Sales, excluding gains on forward exchange contracts (non-GAAP measure)
  $ 201,240     $ 156,260       28.8 %
 
 

Net bookings
 
Net accepted orders increased 28.8% year-over-year to a record-high $272.3 million in fiscal 2011 from $211.4 million in 2010, for a book-to-bill ratio of 1.01 in fiscal 2011.
 
Bookings of fiscal 2010 included newly acquired NetHawk for about five and a half months compared to the whole year in 2011. The year-over-year increase in net bookings is mostly explained by generally improved market conditions following the 2009 recession, as well as worldwide capital-intensive deployments and capacity expansion.
 
Geographic distribution
 
In fiscal 2011, sales to the Americas, Europe, Middle East and Africa (EMEA) and Asia-Pacific (APAC) accounted for 51%, 32% and 17% of sales, respectively, compared to 52%, 30% and 18%  respectively in 2010 and compared to 57%, 28% and 15% respectively in 2009.
 
 
GROSS MARGIN
 
Gross margin amounted to 62.8%, 63.6% and 62.2% of sales in fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
The decrease in our gross margin in fiscal 2011 compared to 2010 can be explained by the following factors.
 
In fiscal 2011, there was an unfavorable wireless product mix, which resulted in a gross margin below our average for this product line.
 
In addition, in fiscal 2011, our warranty provision and our inventory reserve increased compared to 2010; this resulted in a negative impact on our gross margin year-over-year.
 
Finally, in fiscal 2011, the significant year-over-year increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar resulted in a higher cost of goods sold expressed in US dollars in the statement of earnings, as a portion of these costs are incurred in Canadian dollars and we report our results in US dollars.
 
However, these negative factors were offset in part by the following elements.
 
First, the significant year-over-year sales increase (27.1%, exclusive of business combination and foreign exchange gains on forward exchange contracts) resulted in an increase in our manufacturing activities in Canada and China, allowing us to better absorb our fixed manufacturing costs.
 
In addition, the increase in the value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar over the last few months had a positive impact on our gross margin in fiscal 2011; in fact, our procurement costs decreased as the Canadian dollar strengthened compared to the US dollar, as a significant portion of our raw material purchases are denominated in US dollars. This allowed us to improve our gross margin continually over the last few quarters, as our raw material costs of parts purchased in US dollars are measured in Canadian dollars in our financial statements.
 
Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
In fiscal 2010, we recorded in our sales foreign exchange gains totaling $1.5 million on our forward exchange contracts, compared to foreign exchange losses of $3.2 million in 2009. This contributed to a 1% increase in our gross margin year-over-year.
 
In addition, the acquisition of NetHawk had a positive impact on our gross margin in fiscal 2010 as its products deliver margins well above our average typical gross margin.
 


Furthermore, in fiscal 2010, a larger portion of our sales came from products manufactured in our facilities in China compared to 2009; those products have a lower cost of goods than those manufactured in our facilities in Canada, thus resulting in an improvement in gross margin year-over-year.
 
Also, an increased sales volume year-over-year resulted in an increase in manufacturing activities, allowing us to better absorb our fixed manufacturing costs.
 
Finally, the increase in the value of the Canadian dollar in 2010 compared to 2009 had a positive impact on our gross margin in 2010; in fact, our procurement costs decreased as the Canadian dollar strengthened compared to the US dollar, since a significant portion of our raw material purchases are denominated in US dollars. This allowed us to improve our gross margin continually over the last few quarters, as our raw material costs of parts purchased in US dollars are measured in Canadian dollars in our financial statements.
 
On the other hand, in fiscal 2010, our gross margin was negatively affected by the shift in product mix in favor of our copper-access test solutions, as these products deliver lower margins than our other test solutions and we had large orders on which we granted larger discounts.
 
In addition, the shift in the geographic distribution of our sales in favor of the EMEA and APAC markets in fiscal 2010, compared to 2009, resulted in a lower margin year-over-year. Sales to these markets tend to deliver lower margins than those made in the Americas, as they are made through distribution channels instead of being made directly with the end customers.
 
Finally, in fiscal 2010, the significant year-over-year increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar resulted in a higher cost of goods sold expressed in US dollars in the statement of earnings, as a portion of these costs are incurred in Canadian dollars and we report our results in US dollars.
 
Outlook for fiscal 2012
 
Considering the expected sales growth in fiscal 2012, the expected increase in sales of protocol products as well as software-intensive products and services, the cost-effective design of our products, our increased manufacturing activities in China and our tight control on operating costs, we expect our gross margin to continue to improve in the future. However, our gross margin may fluctuate quarter-over-quarter as our sales may fluctuate. Furthermore, our gross margin can be negatively affected by increased competitive pricing pressure, customer concentration and/or consolidation, increased obsolescence and warranty costs, shifts in customer and product mix, under-absorption of fixed manufacturing costs and increases in product offerings by other suppliers in our industry. Finally, any increase in the strength of the Canadian dollar, compared to the US dollar, may have a negative impact on our gross margin in fiscal 2012 and beyond.
 
 
SELLING AND ADMINISTRATIVE
 
Selling and administrative expenses were $87.1 million, $66.6 million and $58.1 million for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively. As a percentage of sales, selling and administrative expenses amounted to 32.3%, 32.9% and 37.9% for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively.
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
In fiscal 2011, NetHawk, acquired on March 12, 2010, contributed for the whole year to our selling and administrative expenses, which caused them to increase year-over-year. In addition, selling expenses for NetHawk tend to be higher in percentage of sales than the rest of our business, as NetHawk’s sales cycle is much longer and complex than that of most of our other product lines.
 
In addition, in fiscal 2011, our sales (excluding those of NetHawk) significantly increased compared to 2010, causing our selling expenses to increase year-over-year, namely our commission expenses.
 
Furthermore, in fiscal 2011, considering our goal of becoming the leading player in the telecom test and service assurance space, we intensified our sales and marketing efforts, both domestic and international, which caused our expenses to increase year-over-year.
 
 

Finally, in fiscal 2011, the increase (5.6%) in the average value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar had a negative impact on our selling and administrative expenses, since a certain portion of these expenses are denominated in Canadian dollars and we report our results in US dollars, and since these expenses increased year-over-year as our sales grew.
 
In fiscal 2011, the significant increase in sales year-over-year caused these expenses to significantly decrease as a percentage of sales, as a portion of these expenses is rather fixed.
 
Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
In fiscal 2010, NetHawk, acquired on March 12, 2010, contributed for about five and half months to our selling and administrative expenses, which caused them to increase year-over-year. In addition, as mentioned above, selling expenses for NetHawk tend to be higher in percentage of sales than the rest of our business, as its sales cycle is much longer and complex than that of our other product lines.
 
Furthermore, in fiscal 2010, the significant increase (12.8%) in the average value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar, year-over-year, had a negative impact on our selling and administrative expenses, since a certain portion of these expenses is denominated in Canadian dollars and since these expenses increased year-over-year as our sales grew.
 
Finally, in fiscal 2010, our sales (excluding those of NetHawk) significantly increased compared to 2009, causing our selling expenses to increase, namely our commission expenses.
 
However, given the restructuring actions taken in the end of fiscal 2009 to reduce our costs, we have been able to reduce some of our selling and administrative expenses in fiscal 2010 compared to 2009.
 
In fiscal 2010, the significant increase in sales year-over-year caused these expenses to significantly decrease as a percentage of sales, as a portion of these expenses is fixed.
 
Outlook for fiscal 2012
 
For fiscal 2012, we expect our selling and administrative expenses to increase in dollars and range between 32% and 34% of sales. In addition, in fiscal 2012, we expect our commission expenses to increase as the sales volume increases. Furthermore, considering our goal of becoming the leading player in the telecom test and service assurance space and to deliver the synergies expected from our recent acquisition, we plan to continue intensifying our sales and marketing efforts, both domestic and international, which will also cause our expenses to rise. Finally, any increase in the strength of the Canadian dollar and the euro versus the US dollar would also cause our selling and administrative expenses to increase, as a portion of these expenses are incurred in Canadian dollars and euros.
 
 
RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
 
Gross research and development expenses
 
Gross research and development expenses totaled $57.2 million, $44.6 million and $33.6 million for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively. As a percentage of sales, gross research and development expenses amounted to 21.2%, 22.0% and 21.9% for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively, while net research and development expenses accounted for 17.7%, 18.7% and 17.8% of sales for these respective years.
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
In fiscal 2011, NetHawk, acquired on March 12, 2010, contributed for the whole period to our gross research and development expenses, which caused them to increase year-over-year. NetHawk tends to incur higher research and development expenses in percentage of sales, compared to our other product lines, as its products are more software-intensive.
 


In addition, in fiscal 2011, we intensified our research and development activities, which resulted in increased gross research and development expenses compared to 2010.
 
Finally, in fiscal 2011, the increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar had a negative effect on our gross research and development expenses, as a large portion of these expenses are denominated in Canadian dollars and we report our results in US dollars, and since these expenses increased year-over-year.
 
The decrease in our gross research and development expenses as a percentage of sales year-over-year is mainly due to the significant increase in sales year-over-year.
 
Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
In fiscal 2010, NetHawk, acquired on March 12, 2010, contributed for about five and a half months to our gross research and development expenses, which caused them to increase year-over-year. As mentioned above, NetHawk tends to incur higher research and development expenses in percentage of sales, compared to our other product lines, as its products are more software-intensive.
 
In addition, the significant increase (12.8%) in the average value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar year-over-year is also responsible for the significant increase of our gross research and development expenses year-over-year, as a large portion of these expenses are denominated in Canadian dollars and we report our results in US dollars and as these expenses increased year-over-year.
 
Finally, we intensified our research and development activities, namely in our software development center in Pune, India, and in our service assurance development center, which resulted in increased gross research and development expenses in fiscal 2010, compared to 2009.
 
Tax credits and grants
 
We are entitled to tax credits from the Canadian federal and provincial governments for eligible research and development activities conducted in Canada. We are also eligible to grants by a Finnish technology organization on certain research and development projects conducted in Finland.
 
Tax credits and grants for research and development activities were $9.3 million, $6.7 million and $6.4 million for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively. As a percentage of gross research and development expenses, tax credits reached 16.2%, 15.0% and 19.0% for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively.
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
In fiscal 2011, the year-over-year increase of research and development activities in Canada, where we are entitled to tax credits, resulted in increased tax credits compared to 2010.
 
In addition, in fiscal 2011, the increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar compared to 2010 had a positive effect on our tax credits as they are denominated in Canadian dollars and we report our results in US dollars, and since these credits increased year-over-year.
 
Finally, a portion of the year-over-year increase in our tax credits and grants in  fiscal 2011, compared to 2010, comes from newly acquired NetHawk, which contributed for the whole year in 2011, compared to about five and half months in 2010.
 
Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
A significant portion of the increase in our tax credits and grants in fiscal 2010, compared to 2009, comes from newly acquired NetHawk, which contributed for about five and a half months to our grants. In addition, our research and development tax credits are denominated in Canadian dollars. The significant increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar, in fiscal 2010 compared to 2009, had a positive impact on these tax credits expressed in US dollars.
 


Outlook for fiscal 2012
 
For fiscal 2012, we expect our net research and development expenses to increase in dollars, and range between 17% and 19% of sales, given our focus on innovation, the addition of software features in our products, our desire to gain market share and our goal to exceed customer needs and expectations. Finally, any increase in the strength of the Canadian dollar and euro versus the US dollar in the upcoming quarters would also cause our net research and development expenses to increase, as a significant portion of these expenses are incurred in Canadian dollars and euros.
 
 
AMORTIZATION OF PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
 
In fiscal 2011, amortization of property, plant and equipment was $6.8 million, compared to $5.8 million in 2010 and $4.5 million in 2009.
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
The increase in amortization expense in fiscal 2011, compared to 2010, mainly comes from the acquisition of NetHawk (completed in the third quarter of 2010), the increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar year-over-year, as well as the additions to property, plant and equipment over the last few quarters.
 
Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
The increase in amortization expenses in fiscal 2010, compared to 2009, mainly comes from the acquisition of NetHawk in mid-March 2010, the increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar year-over-year as well as the additions to property, plant and equipment over the last few quarters.
 
Outlook for fiscal 2012
 
For fiscal 2012, considering the expected additions to property, plant and equipment will have on our amortization expenses, we expect our amortization expenses to increase in dollars in 2012.
 
 
AMORTIZATION OF INTANGIBLE ASSETS
 
In conjunction with the business combinations we completed over the past several years, we recorded intangible assets, primarily consisting of core technology and customer relationships. These intangible assets resulted in amortization expenses of $9.2 million, $7.8 million and $5.0 million for fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively.
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
The increase in amortization expense in fiscal 2011, compared to 2010, mainly comes from the acquisition of NetHawk (completed in the third quarter of fiscal 2010), the increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar year-over-year, as well as the additions to intangible assets over the last few quarters; this was offset in part by the fact that core technologies related to the acquisition of Consultronics Limited became fully amortized during the second quarter of fiscal 2011.
 
Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
The increase in amortization expenses in fiscal 2010, compared to 2009, is mainly due to the acquisition of NetHawk in mid-March 2010, as well as to the increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar versus the US dollar year-over-year.
 
 

Outlook for fiscal 2012
 
For fiscal 2012, considering no business combinations, our amortization expense of intangible assets will decrease as core technologies related to the acquisition of Consultronics Limited became fully amortized during the second quarter of fiscal 2011.
 
 
INTEREST AND OTHER INCOME (EXPENSES)
 
Our interest income mainly resulted from our short-term investments, less interests and bank charges. Interest and other income amounted to $511,000 in fiscal 2011 compared to interest expense of $292,000 in fiscal 2010 and interest income of $592,000 in fiscal 2009.
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
In fiscal 2011, we sold non-core capital assets for proceeds of $568,000, which resulted in a gain for the same amount recorded in the interest and other income (expenses) line item in the statements of earnings for these periods.
 
Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
The decrease in our interest income in fiscal 2010 compared to 2009 is mainly due to the decrease of our cash and short-term investments following the cash payment of $26.9 million for the redemption of share capital in fiscal 2009, in accordance with our share buy-back programs and the cash payment of $33.0 million for the acquisition of NetHawk in fiscal 2010.
 
 
FOREIGN EXCHANGE GAIN (LOSS)
 
Foreign exchange gains and losses are mainly the result of the translation of operating activities denominated in currencies other than the measurement currency (mainly the Canadian dollar). We manage our exposure to currency risks with forward exchange contracts. In addition, some of our entities’ operating activities are denominated in US dollars or other currencies, which further hedges these risks. However, any increase in the value of the Canadian dollar, compared to the US dollar, the euro and the British pound, would have a negative impact on our operating results.
 
We reported a foreign exchange loss of $3.8 million in fiscal 2011, compared to $1.5 million in 2010 and a foreign exchange gain of $1.1 million in 2009.
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
In fiscal 2011, the value of the Canadian dollar significantly increased versus the US dollar, compared to August 31, 2010, which resulted in a large foreign exchange loss of $3.8 million during the year. In fact, the period-end value of the Canadian dollar increased 9.0% versus the US dollar to CA$0.9784 = US$1.00 at the end of fiscal 2011, compared to CA$1.0665 = US$1.00 at the end of 2010. In addition, the volume of operations denominated in foreign currencies (including balance sheet items) increased year-over-year, further increasing the exchange loss compared to the same period last year.
 
Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
In fiscal 2010, the value of the Canadian dollar increased versus the US dollar, the euro and the British pound, compared to August 31, 2009, which resulted in a foreign exchange loss of $1.5 million during the year. In fact, the period-end value of the Canadian dollar increased 2.8% versus the US dollar to CA$1.0665 = US$1.00 at the end of fiscal 2010, compared to CA$1.0967 = US$1.00 at the end of 2009. It increased 16.5% versus the euro to CA$1.3515 = €1.00, compared to CA$1.5741 = €1.00 at the end of fiscal 2009. Finally, it increased 9.5% versus the British pound to CA$1.6337 = ₤1.00 at the end of fiscal 2010 compared to CA$1.7888 = ₤1.00 at the end of 2009. In addition, the volume of operations denominated in foreign currencies (including balance sheet items) increased year-over-year, further increasing the exchange loss compared to the same period last year.
 

 
Foreign exchange rate fluctuations also flow through the P&L line items as a significant portion of our operating items are denominated in Canadian dollars, and we report our results in US dollars. Consequently, the significant increase in the average value of the Canadian dollar in fiscal 2011, compared to 2010, resulted in a significant and negative impact on our financial results of 2011. This was amplified by the fact that our operating activities incurred in Canadian dollars increased year-over-year. In fact, the average value of the Canadian dollar in fiscal 2011 was CA$0.9894 = US$1.00 compared to CA$1.0446 = US$1.00 in 2010, representing an increase of 5.6% in the average value of the Canadian dollar year-over-year. In fiscal 2010, the average value of the Canadian dollar was CA$1.0446 = US$1.00 compared to CA$1.1782 = US$1.00 in 2009, representing a increase of 12.8% in the average value of the Canadian dollar year-over-year. This had a significant and negative impact on our financial results of 2010, compared to 2009.
 

INCOME TAXES
 
We recorded income tax expenses of $8.8 million, $5.5 million and $266,000 in fiscal 2011, 2010 and 2009 respectively.
 
Fiscal 2011
 
In fiscal 2011, we reported an income tax expense of $8.8 million on earnings before income taxes of $15.2 million, for an effective income tax rate of 57.8%. Our combined Canadian and provincial statutory tax rate is 29%. This situation mainly results from the fact that a significant portion of our foreign exchange loss is created by the translation of financial statements of our foreign integrated subsidiaries, and is therefore non-deductible. In addition, we continue to maintain a valuation allowance for some of our subsidiaries at loss and we have some non-deductible expenses, such as stock-based compensation costs. Otherwise, the actual tax rate would have been closer to the statutory tax rate.
 
Fiscal 2010
 
In fiscal 2010, we reported an income tax expense of $5.5 million on earnings before income taxes of $9.1 million, for an effective income tax rate of 60.9%. Our combined Canadian and provincial statutory tax rate was 30%. This situation mainly resulted from the fact that we continued to maintain a valuation allowance for some of our subsidiaries at loss and we had some non-deductible expenses, such as stock-based compensation costs. In addition, a portion of our foreign exchange loss was created by the translation of financial statements of our foreign integrated subsidiaries, and was therefore non-deductible. Otherwise, the actual tax rate would have been closer to the statutory tax rate for that year.
 
Fiscal 2009
 
In fiscal 2009, we reported an income tax expense of $266,000 on a loss before income taxes of $20.6 million, for a nominal effective tax rate. Our combined Canadian and provincial statutory tax rate was 31%. This situation mainly resulted from the fact that a significant portion of the impairment of goodwill of $21.7 million was not deductible for tax purposes. In addition, we continued to maintain a valuation allowance for some of our subsidiaries at loss and we had some non-deductible expenses, such as stock-based compensation costs. On the other hand, a significant portion of our foreign exchange gain was created by the translation of financial statements of our foreign integrated subsidiaries, and was therefore non-taxable. Otherwise, the actual tax rate would have been closer to the statutory tax rate for that year.
 
Future income tax assets
 
As at August 31, 2011, our net future income tax assets recognized in the balance sheet amounted to $12.2 million, and our non-refundable research and development tax credits amounted to $36.6 million. In order to realize these future income tax assets and non-refundable research and development tax credits, we need to generate approximately $240 million (CA$235 million) in pretax earnings at the Canadian federal level, approximately $18 million at the Canadian provincial levels, and approximately $32 million at the United States federal level.
 


Valuation allowance
 
As at August 31, 2010 and 2011, we were in a cumulative loss position in certain of our subsidiaries and negative evidence outweighed positive evidence. For these subsidiaries, we maintained a valuation allowance against our net future income tax assets. As at August 31, 2011, the valuation allowance for these subsidiaries amounted to $25 million and mainly related to operating losses and research and development expenses carried forward. Of the valuation allowance of $25 million, $11.4 million related to Brix Networks and NetHawk at the acquisition date. In the event that we reverse a portion of or all the valuation allowance at the acquisition date related to Brix Networks and NetHawk, the amount of such reversal would reduce the amount of goodwill recognized for these acquisitions.
 
Please refer to note 19 of our consolidated financial statements for more details on income taxes and a full reconciliation of the income tax provision.
 
 
RESULTS OF DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS (formerly the Life Sciences and Industrial Division)
 
On October 1, 2010, we completed the sale of our Life Sciences and Industrial Division, which contributed to our results for one month in fiscal 2011, compared to the whole year in fiscal 2010. That Division’s results from operations of fiscal 2019, 2010 and 2011 were included in net earnings from discontinued operations. Results for fiscal 2011 included the gain on the sale of that Division.
 
 
SALES
 
In fiscal 2011, sales of the discontinued operations (one-month contribution) amounted to $2.0 million. They reached $25.4 million and $19.8 million in fiscal 2010 and 2009 respectively (full contribution).
 
 
NET EARNINGS
 
In fiscal 2011, we reported net earnings from discontinued operations of $12.9 million. Net earnings from discontinued operations in fiscal 2011 included a gain on disposal of discontinued operations of $13.2 million and $264,000 in stock-based compensation costs. In fiscal 2010 and 2009, net earnings from discontinued operations amounted to $3.1 million and $4.3 million respectively.
 
 
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
 
Cash requirements and capital resources (from continuing operations)
 
As at August 31, 2011, cash and short-term investments totaled $69.9 million, while our working capital was at $143.8 million. Our cash and short-term investments increased $38.0 million in fiscal 2011, compared to 2010, mainly due to cash flows provided by operating activities of $23.3 million, the net proceeds of $22.1 million from the disposal of discontinued operations, the proceeds of $1.5 million received from the exercise of stock options and the increase of our bank loan of $772,000. In addition, we recorded an unrealized foreign exchange gain on our cash and short-term investments of $3.0 million. This unrealized foreign exchange gain resulted from the translation, in US dollars, of our Canadian-dollar and euro-denominated cash and short-term investments, and was included in the accumulated other comprehensive income in the balance sheet. However, these positive effects on cash elements were offset in part by the net purchases of capital assets of $11.6 million, the cash payments of $1.0 million in relation to the acquisition of NetHawk and the repayment of $619,000 of our long-term debt.
 


Our short-term investments consist of commercial paper issued by twelve (nine as at August 31, 2010) high-credit quality corporations and trusts; therefore, we consider the risk of non-performance of these financial instruments to be limited. None of these debt instruments are expected to be affected by a significant liquidity risk. For the purposes of managing our cash position, we have established a cash management policy, which we follow and monitor on a regular basis. Our short-term investments will be used for working capital and other general corporate purposes, including any payment for the cash contingent consideration related to the acquisition of NetHawk, any other potential acquisition, the construction of our new building in Montreal, Canada as well as our share repurchase program.
 
Newly acquired NetHawk has a long-term debt denominated in euros amounting to $1.6 million (€1.1 million) as at August 31, 2011. This debt, which matures in 2013, is collateralized by assets of NetHawk, bears interest at an annual rate of 2.95%, and is repayable in bi-annual installments of $323,000 (€224,000).
 
We believe that our cash balances and short-term investments will be sufficient to meet our liquidity and capital requirements for the foreseeable future, including the maximum cash contingent consideration of €8.7 million (US$12.0 million) that may become payable in conjunction with the acquisition of NetHawk if sales objectives are met, the payment of our long-term debt, the remaining construction costs, over the next nine months, of our new building in Montreal, Canada, estimated at $15.2 million (CA$14.9 million), as well as the effect of our normal course issuer bid. In addition to these assets, we have unused available lines of credit totaling $15.5 million for working capital and other general corporate purposes and unused lines of credit of $16.5 million for foreign currency exposure related to forward exchange contracts. However, possible operating losses and/or possible investments in or acquisitions of complementary businesses, products or technologies may require additional financing. There can be no assurance that additional debt or equity financing will be available when required or, if available, that it can be secured on satisfactory terms.
 
As at August 31, 2011, our commitments under operating leases for continuing operations amount to $4.7 million in 2012, $2.5 million in 2013, $1.4 million in 2014, $1.0 million in 2015 and $1.2 million in 2016 and after, for total commitments of $10.8 million.
 
In addition, in fiscal 2011, we undertook the construction of a new building in Montreal, Canada. As at August 31, 2011, we had commitments totaling $15,200,000 (CA$14,900,000) in relation to this building. Total costs for the new building are estimated to approximately $22 million (CA$21.5 million). We expect the construction to be completed in the third quarter of fiscal 2012.
 
Sources and uses of cash
 
We finance our operations and meet our capital expenditure requirements mainly through cash flows from operating activities, the use of our cash and short-term investments as well as the issuance of subordinate voting shares.
 
Operating activities (including discontinued operations)
 
Cash flows provided by operating activities were $23.3 million in fiscal 2011, compared to $1.8 million in 2010 and $22.6 million in 2009.
 
Fiscal 2011 vs. 2010
 
Cash flows provided by operating activities in fiscal 2011 were attributable to the net earnings after items not affecting cash of $31.7 million, offset in part by the negative net change in non-cash operating items of $8.4 million. The negative net change in non-cash operating items was mainly due to the negative effect on cash of the increase of $6.7 million of our income taxes and tax credits recoverable, the negative effect on cash of the increase of $8.8 million of our inventories and the negative effect on cash of the decrease of $2.7 million of our accounts payable and accrued liabilities and other liabilities. These negative effects were offset in part by the positive effect on cash of the decrease of $10.1 million of our accounts receivable. The increase in our income taxes and tax credits is mainly due to the increase in our tax credits recoverable that were earned during the year but not yet recovered. The increase in our inventories is mainly due to the increase in sales activities and the effect of our contingent plan to prevent potential shortage of optical and electronic parts following the natural disaster in Japan during the year. The decrease in our accounts payable and accrued liabilities and other liabilities is due to the timing of purchases and payments in fiscal 2011. Finally, the decrease of our accounts receivable is directly attributable to the timing of sales during the year.
 


Fiscal 2010 vs. 2009
 
Cash flows provided by operating activities in fiscal 2010 were attributable to the net earnings after items not affecting cash of $32.1 million, largely offset by the negative net change in non-cash operating items of $30.3 million. The negative net change in non-cash operating items was mainly due to the negative effect on cash of the increase of $22.5 million of our accounts receivable, the negative effect on cash of the increase of $9.3 million of our inventories and the negative effect on cash of the increase of $4.1 million of our income taxes and tax credits recoverable. These were offset in part by the positive effect on cash of the increase of $5.5 million of our accounts payable and accrued liabilities and other liabilities. The increase of our accounts receivable was directly attributable to the significant increase in sales year-over-year and the timing of sales during the year. The increase in our inventories was mainly due to increased activity levels year-over-year. The increase in our income taxes and tax credits was mainly due to the increase in our tax credits recoverable that were earned during the year but not yet recovered. The increase in our accounts payable and accrued liabilities and other liabilities was due to increased activities year-over-year and the timing of purchases and payments in fiscal 2010.
 
Investing activities (including discontinued operations)
 
Cash flows used by investing activities amounted to $25.3 million in fiscal 2011, compared to cash flows provided of $10.4 million in 2010 and $8.8 million in 2009.
 
Fiscal 2011
 
In fiscal 2011, we acquired (net of disposal) $34.7 million worth of short-term investments and we paid $12.2 million for the purchase of capital assets and $1.0 million in relation to the acquisition of NetHawk. However, we received $22.1 million from the disposal of discontinued operations and $568,000 from the sale of non-core capital assets.
 
Fiscal 2010
 
In fiscal 2010, we disposed (net of acquisitions) of $52.4 million worth of short-term investments but paid $33.0 million for the acquisition of NetHawk and $9.0 million for the purchase of capital assets.
 
Financing activities (including discontinued operations)
 
Cash flows provided by financing activities amounted to $1.6 million in fiscal 2011, compared to $55,000 in 2010 and cash flows used of $26.8 million in 2009.
 
Fiscal 2011
 
In fiscal 2011, our bank loan increased $772,000 and we received $1.5 million from the exercise of stock options, but we repaid $619,000 on our long-term debt.
 
Fiscal 2010
 
In fiscal 2010, we made a repayment of our long-term debt of $274,000 and redeemed share capital for a cash consideration of $14,000. However, we received $343,000 from the exercise of stock options.
 
 
FORWARD EXCHANGE CONTRACTS
 
We utilize forward exchange contracts to manage our foreign currency exposure. Our policy is not to utilize those derivative financial instruments for trading or speculative purposes.
 
Our forward exchange contracts, which are used to hedge anticipated US-dollar-denominated sales, qualify for hedge accounting; therefore, foreign exchange translation gains and losses on these contracts are recognized as an adjustment of the revenues when the corresponding sales are recorded.
 

 
As at August 31, 2011, we held forward exchange contracts to sell US dollars at various forward rates, which are summarized as follows:
 
Expiry dates
 
Contractual
amounts
   
Weighted average contractual
forward rates
 
             
September 2011 to August 2012
  $ 27,500,000       1.0555  
September 2012 to July 2013
    11,400,000       1.0063  
Total
  $ 38,900,000       1.0411  
 
The carrying amount of forward exchange contracts is equal to fair value, which is based on the amount at which they could be settled based on estimated current market rates. The fair value of forward exchange contracts amounted to net gains of $597,000 and $2,278,000 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively. The year-end exchange rate was CA$0.9784 = US$1.00 as at August 31, 2011.
 
 
CONTINGENCY
 
On November 27, 2001, a class action suit was filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York against EXFO, four of the underwriters of our Initial Public Offering and some of its executive officers pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and Rule 10b-5 promulgated thereunder and Sections 11, 12 and 16 of the Securities Act of 1933. This class action alleges that EXFO’s registration statement and prospectus filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 29, 2000, contained material misrepresentations and/or omissions resulting from (i) the underwriters allegedly soliciting and receiving additional, excessive and undisclosed commissions from certain investors in exchange for which they allocated material portions of the shares issued in connection with EXFO’s Initial Public Offering; and (ii) the underwriters allegedly entering into agreements with customers whereby shares issued in connection with EXFO’s Initial Public Offering would be allocated to those customers in exchange for which customers agreed to purchase additional amounts of shares in the after-market at predetermined prices.
 
On April 19, 2002, the plaintiffs filed an amended complaint containing master allegations against all of the defendants in all of the 310 cases included in this class action and also filed an amended complaint containing allegations specific to four of EXFO’s underwriters, EXFO and two of our executive officers. In addition to the allegations mentioned above, the amended complaint alleges that the underwriters (i) used their analysts to manipulate the stock market; and (ii) implemented schemes that allowed issuer insiders to sell their shares rapidly after an initial public offering and benefit from high market prices. As concerns EXFO and our two executive officers in particular, the amended complaint alleges that (i) EXFO’s registration statement was materially false and misleading because it failed to disclose the additional commissions and compensation to be received by underwriters; (ii) the two named executive officers learned of or recklessly disregarded the alleged misconduct of the underwriters; (iii) the two named executive officers had motive and opportunity to engage in alleged wrongful conduct due to personal holdings of EXFO’s stock and the fact that an alleged artificially inflated stock price could be used as currency for acquisitions; and (iv) the two named executive officers, by virtue of their positions with EXFO, controlled the company and the contents of the registration statement and had the ability to prevent its issuance or cause it to be corrected. The plaintiffs in this suit seek an unspecified amount for damages suffered.
 
In July 2002, the issuers filed a motion to dismiss the plaintiffs’ amended complaint and a decision was rendered on February 19, 2003. Only one of the claims against EXFO was dismissed. On October 8, 2002, the claims against our officers were dismissed, without prejudice, pursuant to the terms of Reservation of Rights and Tolling Agreements entered into with the plaintiffs (the “Tolling Agreements”). Subsequent addenda to the Tolling Agreements extended the tolling period through August 27, 2010.
 
In June 2004, an agreement of partial settlement was submitted to the court for preliminary approval. The proposed partial settlement was between the plaintiffs, the issuer defendants in the consolidated actions, the issuer officers and directors named as defendants, and the issuers’ insurance companies. The court granted the preliminary approval motion on February 15, 2005, subject to certain modifications. On August 31, 2005, the court issued a preliminary order further approving the modifications to the settlement and certifying the settlement classes. The court also appointed the notice administrator for the settlement and ordered that notice of the settlement be distributed to all settlement class members by January 15, 2006. The settlement fairness hearing occurred on April 24, 2006, and the court reserved decision at that time.
 
 

While the partial settlement was pending approval, the plaintiffs continued to litigate against the underwriter defendants. The district court directed that the litigation proceed within a number of “focus cases” rather than in all of the 310 cases that have been consolidated. EXFO's case is not one of these focus cases. On October 13, 2004, the district court certified the focus cases as class actions. The underwriter defendants appealed that ruling, and on December 5, 2006, the Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit reversed the district court’s class certification decision.
 
On April 6, 2007, the Second Circuit denied the plaintiffs’ petition for rehearing of that decision and, on May 18, 2007, the Second Circuit denied the plaintiffs’ petition for rehearing en banc. In light of the Second Circuit’s opinion, liaison counsel for all issuer defendants, including EXFO, informed the court that this settlement cannot be approved, because the defined settlement class, like the litigation class, cannot be certified. On June 25, 2007, the district court entered an order terminating the settlement agreement. On August 14, 2007, the plaintiffs filed their second consolidated amended class action complaints against the focus cases and, on September 27, 2007, again moved for class certification. On November 12, 2007, certain defendants in the focus cases moved to dismiss the second consolidated amended class action complaints. On March 26, 2008, the district court denied the motions to dismiss, except as to Section 11 claims raised by those plaintiffs who sold their securities for a price in excess of the initial offering price and those who purchased outside of the previously certified class period. Briefing on the class certification motion was completed in May 2008. That motion was withdrawn without prejudice on October 10, 2008.
 
On April 2, 2009, a stipulation and agreement of settlement between the plaintiffs, issuer defendants and underwriter defendants was submitted to the Court for preliminary approval. The Court granted the plaintiffs’ motion for preliminary approval and preliminarily certified the settlement classes on June 10, 2009. The settlement fairness hearing was held on September 10, 2009. On October 6, 2009, the Court entered an opinion granting final approval to the settlement and directing that the Clerk of the Court close these actions. On August 26, 2010, based on the expiration of the tolling period stated in the Tolling Agreements, the plaintiffs filed a Notice of Termination of Tolling Agreement and Recommencement of Litigation against the two named executive officers. The plaintiffs stated to the Court that they do not intend to take any further action against the named executive officers at this time. Appeals of the opinion granting final approval were filed, all of which were disposed of except the appeals filed by one objector were remanded to the district court to determine standing to appeal. On August 25, 2011, the district court issued an order holding that the final objector had no standing to appeal. The objector has appealed that decision. Given that the district court’s August 25, 2011 judgment remains subject to appeal, the ultimate outcome of the contingency is uncertain. However, based on the settlement approved on October 6, 2009, and the related insurance against such claims, we have determined the impact to our financial position and results of operations as at and for the year ended August 31, 2011 to be immaterial.
 
 
SHARE CAPITAL
 
Share capital
 
As at November 7, 2011, EXFO had 31,643,000 multiple voting shares outstanding, entitling to 10 votes each and 28,781,111 subordinate voting shares outstanding. The multiple voting shares and the subordinate voting shares are unlimited as to number and without par value. In fiscal 2011, 5 million multiple voting shares were converted into 5 million subordinate voting shares.
 
 
OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS
 
As at August 31, 2011, our off-balance sheet arrangements consisted of letters of guarantee amounting to $5.1 million; these letters of guarantee expire at various dates through fiscal 2017. From this amount, we had $0.7 million worth of letters of guarantee for our own selling and purchasing requirements, which were for the most part reserved from one of our lines of credit. The remainder, in the amount of $4.4 million, was used to secure our line of credit in CNY (Chinese currency) of $4 million. An amount of $784,000 was used from this line of credit as at August 31, 2011.
 


VARIABLE INTEREST ENTITY
 
As of August 31, 2011, we did not have interests in any variable interest entities.
 
 
NON-GAAP FINANCIAL MEASURES
 
We provide non-GAAP financial measures (EBITDA*, adjusted EBITDA* and sales, excluding gains/losses on forward exchange contracts and sales of recently acquired businesses, or organic sales) as supplemental information regarding our operational performance. We use these measures for the purposes of evaluating our historical and prospective financial performance, as well as our performance relative to our competitors. These measures also help us to plan and forecast future periods as well as to make operational and strategic decisions. We believe that providing this information to our investors, in addition to the GAAP measures, allows them to see the company’s results through the eyes of management, and to better understand our historical and future financial performance.
 
The presentation of this additional information is not prepared in accordance with GAAP. Therefore, the information may not necessarily be comparable to that of other companies and should be considered as a supplement to, not a substitute for, the corresponding measures calculated in accordance with GAAP.
 
*
EBITDA is defined as net earnings (loss) before interest, income taxes, amortization of property, plant and equipment, amortization of intangible assets and impairment of goodwill. Adjusted EBITDA represents EBITDA excluding the gain from the disposal of discontinued operations.
 
The following tables summarize the reconciliation of EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA to GAAP net earnings (loss) and additional information, in thousands of US dollars:
 
EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA (including discontinued operations)
 
   
Year ended
August 31, 2011
   
Year ended
August 31, 2010
   
Year ended
August 31, 2009
 
                   
GAAP net earnings (loss) for the year
  $ 19,349     $ 6,619     $ (16,585 )
                         
Add (deduct):
                       
                         
Amortization of property, plant and equipment
                       
Continuing operations
    6,772       5,757       4,453  
Discontinued operations
    14       154       154  
Amortization of intangible assets
                       
Continuing operations
    9,183       7,773       5,033  
Discontinued operations
    4       45       34  
Interest and other income (expenses)
                       
Continuing operations
    (511 )     292       (592 )
Discontinued operations
          1       (5 )
Income taxes
                       
Continuing operations
    8,783       5,529       266  
Discontinued operations
    201       1,136       (5 )
Impairment of goodwill (continuing operations)
                21,713  
                         
EBITDA for the year
    43,795       27,306       14,466  
Gain on disposal of discontinued operations
    (13,212 )            
Adjusted EBITDA for the year
  $ 30,583     $ 27,306     $ 14,466  
                         
Adjusted EDITDA in percentage of total sales
    11.3 %     12.0 %     8.4 %
 
 
 
61

 
 
Additional information
 
   
Year ended
August 31, 2011
   
Year ended
August 31, 2010
   
Year ended
August 31, 2009
 
                   
Sales from continued operations
  $ 269,743     $ 202,757     $ 153,082  
Sales from discontinued operations
    1,991       25,359       19,796  
                         
Total sales
  $ 271,734     $ 228,116     $ 172,878  

 
   
Year ended
August 31, 2011
   
Year ended
August 31, 2010
   
Year ended
August 31, 2009
 
                   
Gross margin from continued operations
  $ 169,447     $ 128,856     $ 95,185  
Gross margin from discontinued operations
    989       13,563       10,801  
                         
Total gross margin
  $ 170,436     $ 142,419     $ 105,986  
 


Item 6.  
Directors, Senior Management and Employees
 
 A.  Directors and Senior Management
 
The following table sets forth information about our executive officers, senior managers and Directors as of November 1, 2011.
 
Name and Municipality of Residence
 
Positions with EXFO
PIERRE-PAUL ALLARD
Pleasanton, California
 
Independent Director
JON BRADLEY
Worminghall, United Kingdom
 
Vice-President, Sales — EMEA
STEPHEN BULL
Quebec City, Quebec
 
Vice-President, Research and Development
NORMAND DUROCHER
St-Sauveur, Quebec
 
Vice-President, Human Resources
DARRYL EDWARDS
Weston Under Wetherley, United Kingdom
 
Independent Director
ÉTIENNE GAGNON
Quebec City, Quebec
 
Vice-President, Wireline Division and Corporate Marketing
LUC GAGNON
St-Augustin-de-Desmaures, Quebec
 
Vice-President, Manufacturing Operations and Customer Service
VIVIAN HUDSON
Beaconsfield, Quebec
 
Vice-President, Service Assurance Division
JOHN J. JONES, IV
Hong Kong, China
 
Vice-President, Sales — APAC
GERMAIN LAMONDE
St-Augustin-de-Desmaures, Quebec
 
Chairman of the Board, President and Chief Executive Officer
PIERRE MARCOUILLER
Magog, Quebec
 
Independent Lead Director
GUY MARIER
Lakefield Gore, Quebec
 
Independent Director
MATTI PALOMÄKI
Kauniainen, Finland
 
Vice-President, Wireless Division
PIERRE PLAMONDON
Quebec City, Quebec
 
Vice-President, Finance and Chief Financial Officer
BENOIT RINGUETTE
Boischatel, Quebec
 
General Counsel and Corporate Secretary
SUSAN SPRADLEY
Dallas, Texas
 
Independent Director
DAVID A. THOMPSON
Newton, North Carolina
 
Independent Director
DANA YEARIAN
Lake Forest, Illinois
 
Vice-President, Sales — Americas

The address of each of our executive officers, senior managers and Directors is c/o EXFO Inc., 400 Godin Avenue, Quebec, Quebec, Canada. The following is a brief biography of each of our executive officers, senior managers and Directors.
 
 

Pierre-Paul Allard was appointed a member of our Board of Directors in September 2008 and has been a board member of many other technology companies in Canada and in the US. Today, he is also an active philanthropist for the Institut de Cardiologie de Québec. Mr. Allard is presently Vice-President, Sales and Operations, Global Industries for Cisco Systems Inc., where he has held several management positions over the last 18 years. More recently, he was President and CEO of Cisco Systems Canada.  Currently, Mr. Allard is responsible for all field operations of Cisco’s Global Enterprise Client segment, focusing on new business models, market transition opportunities and increased customer satisfaction. Prior to joining Cisco, he worked for IBM Canada for 12 years. In 2002, Mr. Allard co-chaired the Canadian e-Business Initiative, a private-public partnership aiming to measure the role e-Business plays in increasing productivity levels, job creation and competitive position. In 1998, he was the laureate of the Arista-Sunlife Award, for Top Young Entrepreneur in Large Enterprise, by the Montreal Chamber of Commerce. In 2003, he received the Queen’s Golden Jubilee Medal, which highlights significant contributions to Canada.  In the same year, he was also awarded the prestigious Trudeau Medal from the University of Ottawa’s Telfer School of Management. Pierre-Paul Allard holds a bachelor’s and master’s degree in Business Administration from the University of Ottawa, in Canada.
 
Jon Bradley was appointed Vice-President, Sales, EMEA for EXFO in June 2010. He is responsible for managing telecom sales, both direct and indirect, and for the execution of sales strategies in the international arena. He manages an accomplished and diverse sales and distribution team. As a member of the Strategy and Management Committees, he also develops corporate strategy for EXFO. Prior to his appointment as Vice-President, Sales, EMEA, Dr. Bradley held the positions of Vice-President, International Sales, from 2007-2010, Sales Director for the Europe, Middle East and Africa (EMEA) territory from 2003 to 2007, and Regional Sales Manager from 1999 to 2003. Before joining EXFO in 1999, Dr. Bradley was employed as Sales and Marketing Director by Queensgate Instruments (UK) from 1997 to 1999 and as Sales Engineer by Lambda Photometrics (UK) from September 1993 to September 1997. Jon Bradley holds an honors degree in chemistry, as well as a Ph.D. in Raman spectroscopy from the University of Durham in the United Kingdom.
 
Stephen Bull joined EXFO in 1995 as an Engineering Manager (project management) for the Advanced Optics group. From September 1997 to December 1999, he held the position of Assistant Director of Engineering responsible for all the software development. Mr. Bull was then appointed EXFO's Vice-President of Research and Development in December 1999. Today, he manages a department that includes more than 760 engineers and technicians spread out over three continents and nine locations. He is responsible for EXFO's product development initiatives and manages the Project Management Office and related processes. Prior to joining EXFO, Mr. Bull was General Manager and Managing Director of Space Research Corporation, a military engineering company in Belgium, from June 1986 to March 1990, as well as of Taurus, an IT consulting firm, from 1990 to 1995. He is currently the President of the Institut de développement de produits (an institute dedicated to the advancement of product development practices) and a member of the Product Development Management Association (PDMA). He speaks regularly at conferences on product development. Stephen Bull holds a bachelor's degree in electrical engineering from Université Laval in Quebec City, and is a certified New Product Development Professional from the PDMA.
 
Normand Durocher was appointed Vice-President of Human Resources in April 2004. In addition to managing the company’s human resources team, his main responsibility is to develop and implement a human resources plan that supports EXFO’s business strategy. Mr. Durocher began his career in labor relations in the Cable division of Nortel and then took on several key roles at Nortel Networks and Nordx/CDT, all relating to human resources and operations. Since then, Normand Durocher has accumulated more than 25 years’ experience in operations and human resources management within the telecommunications industry. Prior to joining EXFO, Mr. Durocher ran his own human resources consulting business. Normand Durocher holds a Bachelor of Science from the University of Montreal and also completed the Advanced Human Resources program at Dalhousie University in Halifax, NS, Canada.
 


Darryl Edwards was appointed a member of EXFO’s Board of Directors in September 2011. He brings to EXFO more than 30 years of telecommunications experience gained from a number of senior executive leadership positions; most recently he was the Chief Executive Officer of AIRCOM International, successfully leading the company through to business sale. Mr. Edwards was previously at Nortel Networks for 17 years, where he held various executive officer positions, including President of EMEA and President of Global Sales (Carrier Networks). He also was the Chief Executive Officer for two of Nortel’s key joint ventures, first in the Middle East and later in Germany. Prior to his time at Nortel, Mr. Edwards spent 13 years at GEC-Plessey Telecommunications where he worked in engineering, quality assurance and international sales. Mr. Edwards has held a number of chairs, including Chairman of the Board of Nortel’s interests in Turkey, Nortel Netas, which was listed on the Istanbul Stock Exchange. He also was a member of the Advisory Counsel to the Turkish government between 2004 and 2008, and previously served on the UK Government Broadband Stakeholders Group and the Information Age Partnership. Darryl Edwards holds a Higher National Certificate (Physics) from Birmingham Polytechnic in the UK.
 
Étienne Gagnon was appointed Vice-President, Wireline Division and Corporate Marketing in June 2010. He is responsible for EXFO's wireline business units (Optical, Transport and Datacom, Access) and Corporate Marketing (CTO Office and Marketing-Communications). From May 2003 to May 2007, he was EXFO's Vice-President, Optical Business Unit and Customer Service, and in May 2007, he took on the responsibility of all of EXFO's telecom business units (Optical, Transport and Datacom, Navtel Product Group, Access). Mr. Gagnon began his career as a design engineer for Bombardier/Canadair, where he worked on the Canadian Regional Jet project between 1990 and 1993. Later, he held the position of Business Development Manager for France Telecom in Hungary. In 1994, he joined EXFO's European office as a Regional Sales Manager, and in 1996, he was brought back to Quebec City to head the OSP marketing group. Mr. Gagnon then went on to become the director of EXFO's Outside Plant division in 1998, and remained in that function until 2000, when he joined TeraXion, an optical component manufacturer based in Quebec City, as Vice-President of Sales and Marketing until returning to EXFO in early 2003. Étienne Gagnon holds a bachelor's degree in mechanical engineering from the University of Montreal's School of Engineering, and a master's degree in European business from the École nationale supérieure des télécommunications in France.
 
Luc Gagnon was appointed Vice-President, Manufacturing Operations in May 2003 and, in May 2007, he also took on the vice-presidency of the Customer Service department. He is responsible for ensuring the smooth operation of all manufacturing activities, which include production, purchasing, product engineering, quality assurance, planning, manufacturing engineering, product configuration, transportation and customs, as well as material resources. In addition, he must ensure that there is an ongoing and efficient relation between the manufacturing process and the end customer. Prior to his nomination in 2003, Mr. Gagnon held the position of Production Director since 2000. Before joining EXFO, he had similar roles in several other high-technology companies. He worked for Mendes from 1999 to 2000, for C-MAC from 1997 to 1999, for STERIS from 1993 to 1997 and for MITEL from 1985 to 1993. Luc Gagnon holds a bachelor’s degree in electrical engineering and master’s degree in engineering, both from the Université de Sherbrooke, in Canada.
 
Vivian Hudson was nominated Vice-President for EXFO’s Service Assurance Division in September 2008. Prior to joining EXFO, Ms. Hudson held various general management positions at Nortel, including those of General Manager for the Systems Integration unit: the Microsoft-Nortel Innovative Communications Alliance; the GSM business in France; and the High-Capacity Optical Networks group. Ms. Hudson first began at Nortel in 1990 and worked through the ranks, namely in European Marketing (based in the UK and in France), Optical Product Management, Wireless Operations, as well as Optical and Wireless General Management. Prior to this, she held positions at Bell Canada as a business and services planner, at Canadian Pacific as a telecommunications networking end user, and at DMR as a telecommunications consultant. A recognized global high-tech business leader, Ms. Hudson has also pursued sustainable development activities in the telecommunications area and serves on several boards. Namely, she is a member of the Board of Directors of Nakina Systems Corporation and Shad International. She also holds the ICD.D designation from the Institute of Corporate Directors of Canada. Vivian Hudson holds a Bachelor of Science from Université Laval in Quebec City, and a Master of Business Administration from McGill University in Montreal.
 

 
John Jones was appointed EXFO's Vice-President of Asia-Pacific Sales in April 2010. He is responsible for managing telecom sales, both direct and indirect, and for the execution of sales strategies in the Asian market. As a member of the Strategy and Management Committees, Mr. Jones also develops corporate strategy for EXFO. Mr. Jones brings extensive knowledge and experience of the Asia-Pacific (APAC) telecom industry, having held several executive positions in this region throughout his 20-year career. Before joining EXFO, he namely served as Regional Sales General Manager for Hong-Kong-based Anite Telecoms, Plc., Regional Sales General Manager for JDS Uniphase, President for Nextel International Asia Holdings Limited, and Regional General Manager of Business Operations for Motorola Asia Pacific Limited. In addition, Mr. Jones spent 10 years at BellSouth, where he held various managerial positions in China, Australia, New Zealand and India. Prior to this, he also worked for the Faber-Castell Corporation and the AT&T Corporation, where he began his career. John Jones holds bachelor's degrees in both economics and marketing from Manhattan College in New York, as well as an MBA from the Belk School of Business of the University of North Carolina at Charlotte/Hong-Kong.
 
Germain Lamonde, a company founder, has been President and Chief Executive Officer of EXFO since its inception in 1985. He has also been Chairman of the Board since EXFO went public in 2000. Responsible for the overall management and strategic direction of EXFO, Mr. Lamonde has grown the company from the ground up into a global leader in the wireline and wireless telecommunication test and service assurance industry. Mr. Lamonde has served on the board of directors of several organizations such as the Canadian Institute for Photonic Innovations, the POLE QCA Economic Development Corporation and the National Optics Institute of Canada (INO), to name a few. Germain Lamonde holds a bachelor's degree in physics engineering from the University of Montreal's School of Engineering (École Polytechnique), a master's degree in optics from Université Laval in Quebec City, and is also a graduate of the Ivey Executive Management Program offered by the University of Western Ontario.
 
Pierre Marcouiller has served as our Director since May 2000. Mr. Marcouiller is Chairman of the Board and CEO of Camoplast Solideal, a world leader in the design, manufacturing and distribution of off-road tires, rubber tracks, undercarriage systems and wheels, as well as a North-American leader in under-the-hood plastic components and assemblies for the automotive industry. Prior to joining Camoplast Solideal, Mr. Marcouiller was President and General Manager of Venmar Ventilation Inc. (1988-1996), where he was the controlling shareholder from 1991 to 1996. He is also a Director of Canam Group Inc., an industrial company specialized in the design and fabrication of construction products and solutions in the commercial, industrial, institutional, residential, and bridge and highway infrastructure markets. Mr. Marcouiller also holds directorships in other privately held companies. Pierre Marcouiller holds a bachelor's degree in business administration from Université du Québec à Trois-Rivières and an MBA from Université de Sherbrooke.
 
Guy Marier has served as our Director since January 2004. President of Bell Québec between 1999 and 2003, Guy Marier completed his successful 33-year career at Bell as Executive Vice-President of the Project Management Office, before retiring at the end of 2003. He has been serving as EXFO Director since January 2004. From 1988 to 1990, Mr. Marier headed Bell Canada International's investments and projects in Saudi Arabia and, for the three following years, served as President of Télébec. He then returned to the parent company to hold various senior management positions. Guy Marier holds a Bachelor of Arts from the University of Montreal and a Bachelor of Business Administration from Université du Québec à Montréal.
 
Matti Palomäki was appointed Vice-President of EXFO's Wireless Division in April 2011. In this capacity, he oversees all aspects of EXFO's wireless network testing value proposition, positioning and selling strategy. During more than 20 years at Nokia and Nokia Siemens Networks, Mr. Palomäki held various positions at global product business management and sales management levels. Over the last 17 years, he served mobile operators in global product business management, regional sales management and direct customer management roles. Before joining EXFO, Mr. Palomäki was the Global Head of Packet Core Product Management at Nokia Siemens Networks, leading solution teams for mobile broadband, evolved packet core, policy enforcement and control solutions, as well as product teams for gateways and control elements for 2G, 3G and 4G networks. Prior to this, Mr. Palomäki held positions as General Manager of Nokia's IP gateways global product line, Country Director of the Czech Republic, Account Director in Thailand, and Regional Radio Sales Director for Nokia in Scandinavia and Benelux.  Matti Palomäki holds a Master of Science in Electrical Engineering from the Helsinki University of Technology and a Master of Business Administration from the European University in Paris. When working abroad, Mr. Palomäki served on the Board of the Nordic Chamber of Commerce in Prague.
 
 
 
Pierre Plamondon was appointed Vice-President, Finance and Chief Financial Officer (CFO) of EXFO in January 1996. He is responsible for accounting, financial reporting, legal services, investor relations and information technology services. Prior to joining EXFO, Mr. Plamondon served as Senior Manager for Price Waterhouse, now PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, from September 1981 to December 1995, in Canada and France. Pierre Plamondon holds a bachelor's degree in business administration and a license in accounting, both from Université Laval in Quebec City. Mr. Plamondon has been a member of the Canadian Institute of Chartered Accountants since 1983 and a member of the Board of Directors of SOVAR Inc. (Société de valorisation des applications de la recherche de l'Université Laval) since December 2000. Over the years, he also served on the Board of Directors of several non-profit organizations, and he is currently a Board member for the Fondation de l'Université Laval.
 
Benoit Ringuette has been our in-house Legal Counsel and Corporate Secretary since April 2004. Prior to joining EXFO, Mr. Ringuette practiced mainly in commercial, corporate and securities law from 1998 to 2003 as an associate in the law firms of O’Brien, Flynn Rivard in Quebec City and Desjardins Ducharme Stein Monast in Quebec City. Mr. Ringuette has been a member of the Quebec Bar since 1998. Mr. Ringuette holds a bachelor’s degree in Civil Law and a master’s degree in Business Administration (MBA) from Laval University in Quebec City, Canada.
 
Susan Spradley was appointed to EXFO's Board of Directors in October 2011. She brings to EXFO more than 20 years of experience in the wireless telecommunications industry in which she has held senior executive positions in sales, product line management, operations, services and customer support. Most recently she was Head of the North American Region at Nokia Siemens Networks and also a member of the company's Executive Board. Prior to joining Nokia Siemens Networks, Ms. Spradley held prominent leadership roles at Nortel Networks including President of Global Services and Operations, President of Global Product Line Management and North American Sales, and Vice-President of Customer Service and Operations. She also served as Vice-President of Marketing and Product Development for North America at Siemens Communications. In addition, she previously was a member of the National Security Telecommunications Advisory Committee reporting to the President of the United States. Susan Spradley holds a bachelor's degree in Computer Science from the University of Kansas and completed the Advanced Management Program at Harvard University Business School.
 
David A. Thompson has served as our Director since June 2000. Dr. Thompson most recently served as Vice-President and Director of Hardware & Equipment Technology at Corning Cable Systems, where he held this position from 2001 until retiring from Corning in 2008. Prior to this, he held several technical management roles at Corning Incorporated starting in 1976. Dr. Thompson joined Corning Incorporated in 1976 in glass chemistry research, developing new specialty glasses for television, optical lenses, solar mirrors and optical fibers. He served in several global business management and strategic planning roles for Corning in both R&D and the Telecommunications Division between 1988 and 1999. He was technical director for the creation of optical amplifier and optical components for Corning and in creation of the Samsung-Corning Micro-Optics joint venture. He later, in 1999, was named Vice-President for the Strategic Planning & Innovation Effectiveness on return to the Corning RD&E Division. Dr. Thompson also serves on the engineering advisory group at the University of North Carolina in Charlotte. David A. Thompson holds a Bachelor of Science degree in chemistry from The Ohio State University and a masters and doctorate in inorganic chemistry from the University of Michigan and he attended the MIT Sloan School for technology leaders. He holds over 20 patents and has over two dozen technical publications in the areas of inorganic chemistry, glass technology and telecommunications. He is a member of several professional and honor societies and has chaired numerous technical society groups during his career.
 

 
Dana Yearian was appointed EXFO's Vice-President, Sales, Americas in March 2007. Prior to this appointment, Mr. Yearian held the position of Vice-President, Telecom Sales, North America. He is responsible for managing telecom sales, both direct and indirect, and the execution of sales strategies across North, Central and South America. Mr. Yearian oversees all sales-related functions for the EXFO sales organization throughout this territory, including sales operations, global account management and partner programs. As a member of the Strategy and Management committees, he also helps develop corporate strategy. From 2005 to 2006, Mr. Yearian held senior executive sales positions at Spirent Communications Service Assurance Division. In 2003, Mr. Yearian founded The Katrixx Group, which provided consulting and contracting services to high-technology companies. Before founding his company, Mr. Yearian worked as Vice-President of Sales at Acterna Corp. (from 1991 to 2003), where he led both North American and International sales and support operations. Prior to working for Acterna, Mr. Yearian held various executive positions, namely at Toshiba America, Silicon Sensors (Advanced Photonix, Inc.) and Impell Corporation (ABB Ltd.). Dana Yearian holds a bachelor's degree in electrical engineering from the Illinois Institute of Technology in Chicago, and has completed MBA course work at DePaul University, also in Chicago, Illinois, USA.
 
 Term of Executive Officers
 
Executive officers are appointed annually by the Board of Directors and serve until their successors are appointed and qualified or until earlier resignation or removal.
 
 
 B.  Compensation
 
COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS
 
Compensation Discussion & Analysis
 
This Compensation Discussion & Analysis focuses primarily on: (i) significant elements of the Corporation’s executive compensation program; (ii) principles on which the Corporation makes compensation decisions and determines the amount of each element of executive and director compensation; and (iii) an analysis of the material compensation decisions made by the Human Resources Committee for the financial year ended August 31, 2011.
 
The following is a discussion of the compensation arrangements with the Corporation’s Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”), Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”) and each of the three most highly compensated executive officers whose total compensation was, individually, more than CA$150,000, (the “Named Executive Officers” or “NEOs”). The Corporation’s NEOs for the financial year ended August 31, 2011 were, Mr. Germain Lamonde (CEO), Mr. Pierre Plamondon (CFO), Mr. Jon Bradley, Vice-President, Sales — EMEA, Ms. Vivian Hudson, Vice-President, Service Assurance Division and Mr. Dana Yearian, Vice-President, Sales — Americas.
 
Members of the Human Resources Committee
 
During the financial year ended August 31, 2011, the Human Resources Committee was composed of:
 
·  
Mr. Guy Marier (Chairman)
·  
Mr. Pierre-Paul Allard
·  
Mr. Pierre Marcouiller
·  
Mr. David A. Thompson
·  
Mr. André Tremblay (until January 20, 2011)
 
None of these members were officers or employees, or former officers or employees of the Corporation or its subsidiaries. All of the members of the Human Resources Committee are considered “independent”, as defined in applicable securities legislation. They each have experience in executive compensation either as a chief executive officer of a publicly-traded corporation or as a senior executive officer. The Board of Directors believes that the Human Resources Committee collectively has the knowledge, experience and background required to fulfill its mandate.
 

 
Mandate of the Human Resources Committee
 
The Human Resources Committee of the Board of Directors is responsible for establishing the annual compensation and overseeing the assessment of the performance of all the Corporation’s executive officers, including the President and Chief Executive Officer. This Human Resources Committee also reviews and submits to the Board of Directors the salary structure and the short-term and long-term incentive compensation programs for all employees of the Corporation. The Human Resources Committee also evaluates and makes recommendations to the Board of Directors regarding the compensation of directors, including the number of Deferred Share Units credited to the non-employee directors pursuant to the Deferred Share Unit Plan. The Human Resources Committee’s goal is to develop and monitor executive compensation programs that are consistent with strategic business objectives and shareholders’ interests. Though the Human Resources Committee is responsible for the review and approval of the employees that will receive Restricted Share Units or options to purchase shares of the Corporation, in accordance with policies established by the Board of Directors and the terms of the Long-Term Incentive Plan, these functions may be shared between the Board of Directors and the Human Resources Committee. During the period from September 1, 2010 to August 31, 2011, these functions have been shared by the Board of Directors and the Human Resources Committee but have mainly been performed by the Human Resources Committee.
 
The Human Resources Committee has reviewed and discussed with the CEO and Vice-President, Human Resources of the Corporation, the compensation disclosure in this document, and has recommended to the Board of Directors that the disclosure be included in this Annual Report.
 
From September 1, 2010 to November 1, 2011, the Human Resources Committee held five (5) meetings and at four (4) of those meetings executive compensation was discussed. The Human Resources Committee meetings were attended by all the members of the Human Resources Committee, except Mr. Allard who was absent at one meeting. The following table outlines the main activities of the Human Resources Committee during the last financial year:

Meeting
Main activities of the Human Resources Committee
  October 12, 2010
 
 
 
 
Review and approval of the Short-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2010;
Review of the proposed salary scales and salary increases for the year started September 1, 2010;
Review and approval of the compensation plans of executive officers for the financial year started September 1, 2010 being the Base Salary, the Short-Term Incentive Plan and the stock-based compensation delivered through the Long-Term Incentive Plan;
Review and approval of the stock-based compensation plan for the sales force delivered through the Long-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2010;
Review and approval of the quantum for the stock-based compensation plan for the performing employees delivered through the Long-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2010;
Review and approval of the executive compensation section of the management proxy circular for the financial year ended August 31, 2010 during a Board of Directors meeting;
Review of the succession planning program;
Review of the Management Improvement Performance Program;
Review of the Mobilization / Motivation Plan;
Human Resources Integration Plan following acquisition;
Review of the sales forces achievement and percentage of commissions;
Review of a coaching program for the CEO;
Selection of new Board Members.
  January 12, 2011
 
 
Review of the quarterly payments under the Short-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2010 and being part of the Short-Term Incentive Plan;
Review and approval of the stock-based compensation plan for the performing employees delivered through the Long-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2010;
Review and approval of the CEO objectives;
Review of the Mobilization / Motivation Plan;
Review of the Management Improvement Performance Program;
Review of the sales forces commissions plans;
Review of a coaching program for the CEO;
Selection of new Board Members;
Review of the succession planning program.
 
 

Meeting
Main activities of the Human Resources Committee
  March 31, 2011
 
Review of the quarterly payments under the Short-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2010 and being part of the Short-Term Incentive Plan;
Review and approval of the stock-based compensation delivered through the Long-Term Incentive Plan;
Review of benchmarks for our sales forces;
Review of a coaching program for the CEO;
Selection of new Board Members;
Review of the succession planning program.
  June 28, 2011
 
Review of the quarterly payments under the Short-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2010 and being part of the Short-Term Incentive Plan;
Selection of new Board Members;
Determination by the Members of their respective DSU percentage of their Annual Retainer.
  October 11, 2011
 
 
 
 
Review and approval of the Short-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2011;
Review of the proposed salary scales and salary increases for the year started September 1, 2011;
Review and approval of the compensation plans of executive officers for the financial year started September 1, 2011 being the Base Salary, the Short-Term Incentive Plan and the stock-based compensation delivered through the Long-Term Incentive Plan;
Review and approval of the stock-based compensation plan for the sales force delivered through the Long-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2011;
Review and approval of the quantum for the stock-based compensation plan for the performing employees delivered through the Long-Term Incentive Plan for the financial year started September 1, 2011;
Review and approval of the executive compensation section of the management proxy circular for the financial year ended August 31, 2011 during a Board of Directors meeting;
Review of the succession planning program;
Review of the Mobilization / Motivation Plan;
Review of a coaching program for the CEO;
Review and approval of the CEO objectives;
Review of the 2012 Executive compensation disclosure obligations;
Review of the Management Improvement Performance Program.
 
Compensation Plan Control - Compensation Consultant and Internal Review
 
As a general practice, the Corporation’s relative position in terms of compensation levels is determined every two years through studies performed by independent consulting firms using a selected reference market of comparable companies. The benchmarking activities are further detailed below under the heading – “Benchmarking”.
 
In 2007, the Corporation engaged two human resources consultants, Mercer (Canada) Ltd. (“Mercer”) and Aon Corporation (“Aon”), to advise whether the compensation positioning of the Corporation was still aligned with the comparative market. Further to recommendations from Mercer and Aon, the Corporation decided to gradually align the compensation positioning (for the base salary, short-term and long-term incentives) from the fiftieth percentile to the sixtieth percentile for selected position (the “Target Compensation Positioning”) over the following three (3) years.
 
In 2008, the Corporation engaged Hewitt Associates LLC to conduct a world-wide market analysis for selected international positions. The survey included annual base salary, bonuses and commission plans.
 
In 2009, the Corporation appointed Mercer to review the compensation positioning of the Corporation. Mercer confirmed that the Corporation’s compensation scheme (base salary, short-term compensation, long-term compensation) was still aligned with the comparative market but some adjustments were proposed to be made for certain executive officers. Considering the overall economic situation, the adjustments proposed by Mercer were postponed.
 

 
In 2010, the Corporation engaged Mercer to conduct a study of the Corporation’s executive compensation plans. The study examined the total compensation including the fix components (i.e., base salary, pension, benefits and perquisites) and the variable components (i.e., short-term and long-term incentives). The analysis of Mercer indicated that adjustments were required primarily to base salary levels, long-term incentive plan as well as pension value. Any adjustments were made from a total compensation perspective. Mercer has suggested modifying the compensation philosophy to progressively align the executive compensation toward a total compensation to the fiftieth percentile for expected performance with an opportunity, conditional on performance, to exceed the fiftieth percentile total compensation (“Target Total Compensation”). Further to such recommendations, the Corporation has decided to gradually align over the following three (3) years the compensation positioning according to the Target Total Compensation scheme proposed by Mercer for the compensation plans of the financial year starting September 1, 2010 (“Mercer Three Year Compensation Plan”).
 
In 2011, The Corporation pursued its Mercer Three Year Compensation Plan described above. Therefore, the Corporation did not conduct any study of the Corporation’s executive compensation plans in 2011. The Corporation is planning to conduct such survey in 2012 to adjust, as the case may be, its Mercer Three Year Compensation Plan.
 
In addition, internal pay equity studies are a key factor to complete the compensation review process and indicate where necessary adjustments may be required. During the financial year ended August 31, 2011, this practice continued and certain compensation adjustments were made.
 
The Human Resources Committee has the authority to retain any independent consultants of its choice to advise its members on total executive compensation policy matters, and to determine the fees and the terms and conditions of the engagement of these consultants. The Human Resources Committee is ultimately responsible for its own decisions, which may take into consideration more than the information and recommendations provided by its compensation consultants or management.
 
The fees paid to Mercer for consulting services provided to the Human Resources Committee and to the Corporation during the financial year ended August 31, 2011 were as follows:
 
  Type of Fee
Financial 2011 Fees
Percentage of Financial 2011 Fees
  Fees for Board of Directors and Human Resources Committee mandates
   CA$7,035
  43%
  Fees for other Corporation mandates
   CA$9,245
  57%
  Total
 CA$16,280
 100%
 
Benchmarking
 
The Target Total Compensation of senior executives has been reviewed with guidance and advice from Mercer, using a peer group of companies as reference point for determining a competitive total compensation package. The comparator group included private and publicly-traded companies evolving in high technologies, telecommunications and durable-manufacturing goods industries. The selection was based on a number of factors including comparable size, similar service business and relationship to the telecom and life science industries. For certain executives, we emphasized certain comparative companies more than others in determining total compensation based on the responsibilities of such executives. When drawing comparisons to companies significantly larger than Corporation’s business, in particular those in the manufacturing goods industry, we did not use compensation arrangements of the most senior executive of that comparator but instead looked to the roles and responsibilities of individuals with equivalent business experience.
 
Mercer used three primary comparator groups in matching incumbent’s senior executives to positions of similar responsibility within comparator private and publicly-traded companies:
 

 
(1)  
2009 Mercer Benchmark Database, which contains compensation data for selected Canadian companies with median annual revenues of CA$325 million. The following is a list of the main companies, with a particular emphasis on the High-Technology/Telecommunications and Manufacturing-Durable Goods Industries, servicing industries, revenue categories and geography, used for the purposes of setting 2010 compensation: Arcan Resources Ltd.; Linamar Corporation; Arsenal Energy Inc.; Livingston International; Baytex Energy Trust; Logistec Corporation; Canadian Hydro Developers Inc.; MacDonald, Dettwiler and Associates Corporation – Quebec; Canadian Pacific; Pason Systems Inc.; CE Franklin Ltd.; Precision Drilling Trust; Centerra Gold Inc.; RDM Corporation; Compton Petroleum Corporation; SNC-Lavalin; Computer Modelling Group Ltd.; Softchoice Corp.; Crew Energy Inc.; Stantec Inc.; Enerflex Systems Ltd.; Teck Resources Limited; Labopharm Inc.; TeraGo Networks Inc.; Velan Inc. Mercer can only disclose the identities of the publicly-traded participating organizations due to confidentiality covenants with survey participants;
 
(2)  
2009 US Mercer Benchmark Database (2,771 participants); and
 
(3)  
2009 UK Mercer Benchmark Database (193 participants), which contains compensation data for companies in all industries of all sizes and scopes. Focuses on companies with revenues lower than CA$500 million.
 
For the executives based outside Canada, their total compensation was aligned at the median of the local market. Mercer cannot disclose the identities of participating organizations within a specific revenue range due to confidentiality covenants with survey participants. Local laws forbid the disclosure of company names when a sampling of companies is extracted from a local database.
 
Key Elements and Policies for Compensation of Executive Officers
 
The Corporation’s executive compensation plans are designed to attract, retain and motivate key executives who directly impact the Corporation’s long-term success and the creation of shareholder value. In determining executive compensation, the Human Resources Committee considers the following four principles:
 
·  
Performance-based: Executive compensation levels reflect both the results of the Corporation and individual results based on specific quantitative and qualitative objectives established at the beginning of each financial year in keeping with the Corporation’s long-term strategic objectives.
 
·  
Aligned with shareholder interests: An important portion of incentive compensation for executives is composed of equity awards to ensure that executives are aligned with the principles of sustained long-term shareholder value growth.
 
·  
Market competitive: Compensation of executives is designed to be externally competitive when compared against executives of comparable peer companies, and in consideration of the Corporation’s results.
 
·  
Individually equitable: Compensation levels are also designed to reflect individual factors such as scope of responsibility, experience, and performance against individual measures.
 
Compensation Elements
 
The significant elements of the Corporation’s 2011 executive compensation program were (i) Base Salary, (ii) the Short-Term Incentive Plan, and (iii) the stock-based incentive compensation delivered through the Long-Term Incentive Plan. In addition to the foregoing and as the case may be, the Corporation also offered benefit plans and, if applicable, contributed to a Deferred Profit-Sharing Plan or a 401K Plan, as the case may be. To determine appropriate compensation levels for each compensation component, the Human Resources Committee considered all key elements of the executive compensation program. The Human Resources Committee did not assign specific weightings to any key element of the Corporation’s 2011 executive compensation program.
 


Base Salaries
 
In establishing the base salaries of senior officers, including the President and Chief Executive Officer, the Corporation takes into consideration responsibilities, job descriptions and salaries paid by other similar organizations for positions similar in magnitude, scope and complexity. The Human Resources Committee’s objective is to align executive compensation levels with the Target Compensation Positioning offered within a reference market of comparable companies that are similar in size to the Corporation, with a particular focus on those within the High-Technology/Telecommunications and Manufacturing-Durable Goods Industries. The Human Resources Committee reviews the base salary of each executive officer on an annual basis at the beginning of each financial year and recommends that the Board of Directors approve appropriate adjustments, if required, within the salary range in order to maintain a competitive position within the market place.
 
Short-Term Incentive Compensation
 
The Short-Term Incentive Plan (“STIP”) or the Sales Incentive Plan (“SIP”), as the case may be, provides executive officers with the opportunity to earn annual bonuses based on the Corporation’s financial performance and the achievement of strategic corporate (which apply to all employees) and division objectives established on a yearly basis as well as the achievement of personal objectives. Such strategic corporate objectives also apply to all other employees of the Corporation, except the sales force SIP, in their respective STIP. Target payout levels for NEOs eligible for incentive bonuses in the financial year ended August 31, 2011 were established to be in line with the objective of the Human Resources Committee to align compensation with the Target Compensation Positioning offered in the reference market. As per the STIP table below, the plan’s objectives are aimed to reward six elements: three elements are shareholder oriented (sales, gross margins and EBITDA), two are customer oriented (on time delivery and quality) and one is based on personal objectives. As per the SIP table below, the plan’s objectives are aimed to reward five elements: three elements are shareholder oriented (sales, margins and contribution margins), one is based on personal objectives and one is based on specific incentives.
 
Name & Position
Annual incentive
target as % of
base salary
Business Performance
Individual
Performance
Multiplier (2)
Measure
Weight
Multiplier (1)
  Germain Lamonde, CEO
60%
 
Ÿ Sales
Ÿ EBITDA
Ÿ Gross margin
Ÿ Customer satisfaction (3)
 
Telecom
35%
20%
20%
25%
Total: 100%
0% to 150%
0% to 125%
  Pierre Plamondon, CFO
37.5%
  Vivian Hudson,
  Vice-President, Service
  Assurance Division
32.5%
  Jon Bradley,
  Vice-President, Sales-
  EMEA
66.7%
Ÿ Revenue target (4)
Ÿ Margin target (5)
Ÿ Contribution Margin (6)
Ÿ Personal objectives (7)
Ÿ Specific Incentives (8)
45%
30%
15%
5%
5%
  Dana Yearian,
  Vice-President, Sales-
  Americas
66.7%
         
         
(1)  
For sales, EBITDA and gross margin metrics, NEO begins to be compensated upon attainment of 50% of the target objective and up to the attainment of 150% of the target objective. For customer satisfaction metric, NEO’s compensation is pro-rated from a minimal threshold up to the attainment of 150% of the target objective.
(2)  
The personal objectives of each NEO are based on the position and role he or she has with the Corporation. Such personal objectives are based mostly on the attainment of departmental objectives and the others objectives are based on the attainment of personal management objectives all of which attainments are determined by an evaluation of the individual’s supervisor or the Human Resources Committee, as the case may be.
(3)  
Includes on time delivery and quality.
(4)  
The compensation rate for the attainment of revenue targets (billings) is equal to the total billings potential amount of commission on the total billings quotas defined at the beginning of the financial year. A lower rate is applied for less than 70% of the attainment of the objective. The regular rate is applied from 70% to 100% of the attainment of the objective. An accelerator is applied after 100%.
(5)  
The commission rate for the attainment of the margin targets is equal to the total margins potential amount of incentives on the total margins quotas defined at the beginning of the financial year. This rate is used for all margins up to 100% attainment of the objective and an accelerator is applied after 100% attainment of the objective.
 
 

(6)  
The commission rate for the attainment of the contribution margin targets is equal to the total margins potential amount of incentives on the contribution margins objectives defined at the beginning of the financial year. This rate is used for all margins up to 100% attainment of the objective and an accelerator is applied after 100% attainment of the objective.
(7)  
The compensation for personal objectives is a maximum amount based on the quarterly achievement of the sales bookings target for their specific territory. It is pro-rated between 70% and 100% achievement and no compensation will be attributed to this element if less than 70% of the objective is attained.
(8)  
Additional bonuses are also available, one being based on revenues and integration of recent acquisitions and the other on the implementation of the Corporation development program. Accordingly, a total sales achievement figure target of recent acquisitions and a commission rate are determined at the beginning of the financial year. The commission rate is applied when total sales achievement figure of recent acquisitions reaches 50% of the target. Another portion of these additional bonuses is based on the result of the implementation of an integration plan following an acquisition. The compensation for the attainment of the implementation of an integration plan following an acquisition target is a maximum amount based on the achievement of such target and is pro-rated up to 100% achievement. The Corporation development program implementation target is determined at the beginning of the financial year. The compensation for the attainment of the Corporation development program target is a maximum amount based on the achievement of such target and is pro-rated up to 100% achievement.
 
Long-Term Incentive Compensation
 
·  
Long-Term Incentive Plan
 
The principal component of the long-term incentive compensation offered by the Corporation is made up of the Long-Term Incentive Plan for directors, officers, employees and consultants of the Corporation and its subsidiaries.
 
Introduced in May 2000, amended in October 2004 and effective in January 2005, the Long-Term Incentive Plan (“LTIP”), is designed to provide directors, officers, employees and consultants with an incentive to create value and accordingly ensures that their interests are aligned with those of the Corporation’s shareholders and to further attract, motivate and retain all of its employees, including the NEOs. The LTIP is subject to Human Resources Committee review to ensure maintenance of its market competitiveness. The Board of Directors has full and complete authority to interpret the Plan and to establish the rules and regulations applying to it and to make all other determinations it deems necessary or useful for the administration of the Plan, provided that such interpretations, rules, regulations and determinations are consistent with the rules of all stock exchanges on which the securities of the Corporation are then traded and with all relevant securities legislation.
 
The LTIP provides for the issuance of options to purchase Subordinate Voting Shares and the issuance of Restricted Share Units (“RSUs”) redeemable for actual Subordinate Voting Shares or the equivalent in cash to directors, officers, employees and consultants. The Board of Directors upon recommendation of the Human Resources Committee designates the recipients of options or RSUs and determines the number of Subordinate Voting Shares covered by each option or RSU, the dates of vesting, the expiry date and any other conditions relating to these options or RSUs, in each case in accordance with the applicable legislation of the securities regulatory authorities. During the financial year ended August 31, 2011, target awards for eligible officers under the LTIP were established to be in line with the objective of the Human Resources Committee to align compensation with the Target Compensation Positioning offered in the reference market. Each executive is entitled to receive annually RSUs in accordance with the following policy:
 

Positions
Grant Levels (1)  (% of base salary)
   CEO
70%
   Other NEOs
32.5% - 35%
         
         
(1)  
Actual grant value may differ from the grant level guidelines as the stock price may vary between the time of the grant and its approval.
 


RSU awards are based on the expected impact of the role of the executive officer on the Corporation’s performance and strategic development as well as market benchmarking. The Human Resources Committee undertakes an analysis from time to time to determine the possible payouts from the LTIP under various scenarios and at various levels of share price growth to ensure that the LTIP is aligned with the interests of the Corporation’s shareholders.
 
RSUs are also used to attract and retain top executives, as well as in business acquisitions. For the year ended August 31, 2011, the Corporation determined the number of RSUs granted to each executive officer according to their individual contribution, specifically with respect to the additional responsibilities for the integration of business acquisitions and the maximization of their profitability. As disclosed under the section “Summary Compensation Table” hereof, the NEOs were granted RSUs during the last financial year. The purpose of such grant was intended to focus the executives on developing and successfully implementing the continuing growth strategy of the Corporation and to align the executives with the principles of sustained long-term shareholder value growth. The grant was also considered to contribute to the Corporation’s objective to align the compensation of the executives with the reference market. The Corporation did not take into account the amount and terms of outstanding options or RSUs neither the restrictions on resale of such units, when determining the grants mentioned above.
 
The exercise price of the options is determined by the Board of Directors at the time of granting the options, subject to compliance with the rules of all stock exchanges on which the Subordinate Voting Shares are listed and with all relevant securities legislation. In any event, the exercise price may not be lower than the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (for grants of options prior to January 1, 2009) or the Bank of Canada (for grants of options on or after January 1, 2009) on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars. Any option issued is non-transferable. At August 31, 2011, there were a total of 641,357 options granted to all LTIP participants and outstanding pursuant to the LTIP having a weighted average exercise price of US$6.27 (CA$9.42) per option.
 
The fair value at the time of grant of a RSU is equal to the market value of Subordinate Voting Shares at the time RSUs are granted. The grant date market value is equal to the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (for grants of RSUs prior to January 1, 2009) or the Bank of Canada (for grants of RSUs on or after January 1, 2009) on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars. At the end of financial year ended August 31, 2011, there were a total of 1,551,658 RSUs granted and outstanding pursuant to the LTIP having a weighted average fair value at the time of grant of US$4.58 (CA$4.93) per RSU.
 
The maximum number of Subordinate Voting Shares that are issuable under the Plan shall not exceed 6,306,153 Subordinate Voting Shares, which represents 10.4% of the Corporation’s issued and outstanding voting shares as of November 1, 2011. The maximum number of Subordinate Voting Shares that may be granted to any one individual shall not exceed 5% of the number of outstanding Subordinate Voting Shares, which represents 1,439,225 issued and outstanding Subordinate Voting Shares as of November 1, 2011.
 
Some options granted to directors and employees vest on the first anniversary date of their grant. Some options granted in the financial years ended August 31, 2004 and 2005 vested at a rate of 12.5% six (6) months after the date of grant, 12.5% twelve (12) months after the date of grant and 25% annually thereafter commencing on the second anniversary date of the grant in October 2005. Otherwise all options vest at a rate of 25% annually commencing on the first anniversary date of the grant. All options may be exercised in whole or in part once vested. All of the options that are granted under the Plan must be exercised within a maximum period of ten (10) years following the date of their grant or they will be forfeited.
 
The vesting dates of RSUs are subject to a minimum term of three years and a maximum term of ten years from the award date. The following table presents, for the last five (5) financial years, the RSUs granted and their respective vesting schedule.
 
 
 
75

 

Financial
year ended
Grant Date
RSUs
granted
(#)
Fair Value at the
Time of Grant
(US$/RSU)
Vesting schedule
August 31, 2011
October 19, 2010
30,250
6.03
50% after 3 and 4 years of the grant date.
January 19, 2011
119,900
9.32
April 7, 2011
7,297
8.28
April 18, 2011
8,226
8.64
October 19, 2010
56,361
6.03
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 100% on the third or fourth anniversary of the grant when performance objectives related to revenue, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained.
October 19, 2010
128,348
6.03
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained.
August 31, 2010
October 20, 2009
36,500
3.74
50% after 3 and 4 years of the grant date.
January 19, 2010
130,000
5.13
April 7, 2010
37,900
5.68
April 7, 2010
6,155
5.68
1/3 on the third, fourth and fifth anniversary date of the grant.
July 7, 2010
3,759
5.32
October 20, 2009
174,686
3.74
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained.
April 7, 2010
7,575
5.68
July 7, 2010
18,963
5.32
August 31, 2009
October 22, 2008
71,003
2.36
50% after 3 and 4 years of the grant date.
January 20, 2009
243,700
3.22
April 7, 2009
11,000
3.52
July 8, 2009
3,000
2.99
100% after 3 years of the grant date.
January 20, 2009
5,000
3.22
1/3 on the third, fourth and fifth anniversary date of the grant.
October 22, 2008
216,685
2.36
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained.
October 22, 2008
135,584
2.36
100% after 3 years of the grant if performance is achieved (long-term growth of revenue and profitability). Otherwise 100% vested after 5 years of the grant date.
August 31, 2008
October 23, 2007
29,000
6.28
50% after 3 and 4 years of the grant date.
January 15, 2008
76,200
4.16
April 8, 2008
21,600
6.09
April 22, 2008
185,570
5.82
July 7, 2008
71,310
4.39
October 23, 2007
86,167
6.28
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained.
 
 
 
 
Financial
year ended
Grant Date
RSUs
granted
(#)
Fair Value at the
Time of Grant
(US$/RSU)
Vesting schedule
August 31, 2007
September 29, 2006
1,200
5.83
50% after 3 and 4 years of the grant date.
January 19, 2007
34,250
6.42
January 26, 2007
60,200
7.32
July 5, 2007
2,000
7.14
September 11, 2006
2,000
5.38
1/3 on the third, fourth and fifth anniversary date of the grant.
October 25, 2006
25,000
6.02
January 19, 2007
22,550
6.42
October 25, 2006
71,802
6.02
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained.
 
If any vesting dates fall into any black-out period or any other restrictive period during which the RSU holder is not entitled to trade the Corporation’s Subordinate Voting Shares, the RSUs shall: a) vest on the fifth trading day the RSU holder is entitled to trade after such black-out period or restrictive period or b) if the RSU holder decides, prior to such vesting date, to pay his/her income tax without using any of the Subordinate Voting Shares’ proceeds, then and only then, the vesting date shall remain the one determined on the granting date for such RSUs.
 
Any option granted pursuant to the LTIP will lapse (i) immediately upon the termination of the relationship with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries for a good and sufficient cause for employees or officers or at the date on which an employee or an officer resigns or leaves his employment with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries (or within 30 days if the holder’s employment is terminated for reasons not related to cause); and (ii) 30 days after a director ceases to be a member of the Board of Directors of the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries. In the event of retirement or disability, any option held by an employee lapses 30 days after the date of any such disability or retirement. In the event of death, any option held by the optionee lapses 6 months after the date of death.
 
Any RSU granted pursuant to the LTIP will lapse (i) immediately, where vesting of a unit is subject to the attainment of performance objectives, if such performance objectives have not been attained (or postponed at a further vesting date as determined by the Board of Directors); and (ii) immediately, whether or not subject to attainment of performance objectives, upon the termination of the relationship with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries for a good and sufficient cause for employees or officers or at the date on which an employee or an officer resigns or leaves his employment with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries.
 
Any RSU granted pursuant to the LTIP will vest immediately, to a certain proportion as determined by the Plan, upon the termination of the relationship of an employee or officer with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries (i) for reasons not related to cause; (ii) because of death or permanent disability and (iii) retirement.
 
·  
Restricted Share Unit Grants in Last Financial Year
 
The aggregate number of Restricted Share Units (RSUs) granted during the financial year ended August 31, 2011 was 350,382 having a weighted average fair value at the time of grant of US$7.26 (CA$7.38) per RSU. The fair value at the time of grant of a RSU is equal to the market value of Subordinate Voting Shares at the time RSUs are granted. At August 31, 2011, there were a total of 1,551,658 RSUs granted and outstanding pursuant to the LTIP having a weighted average fair value at the time of grant of US$4.58 (CA$4.93) per RSU.
 
The RSUs may be redeemed for actual Subordinate Voting Shares or the equivalent in cash at the discretion of the Board of Directors of the Corporation on the vesting dates established by the Board of Directors of the Corporation at the time of grant in its sole discretion.
 


Therefore, the value at vesting of a RSU, when converted to Subordinate Voting Shares, is equivalent to the market value of a Subordinate Voting Share at the time the conversion takes place and is taxable as an employment income. The table above shows information regarding RSU grants made under the LTIP during the financial year ended August 31, 2011.
 
During the financial year ended August 31, 2011, the following RSUs were granted to the following NEOs:
 
Name
RSUs
Granted
(#)
Percentage of Total
RSUs Granted to
Employees in
Financial Year (%) (1)
Fair Value
at the Time
of Grant
(US$/RSU)
Grant Date
Vesting schedule (2)
Germain Lamonde
45,089
12.87%
6.03
October 19, 2010
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained. (3)
Pierre Plamondon
13,019
3.72%
6.03
October 19, 2010
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained. (3)
8,857
2.53%
6.03
October 19, 2010
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 100% on the third or fourth anniversary date of the grant when performance objectives related to revenue, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained. (4)
Jon Bradley
8,443
2.41%
6.03
October 19, 2010
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained. (3)
8,857
2.53%
6.03
October 19, 2010
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 100% on the third or fourth anniversary date of the grant when performance objectives related to revenue, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained. (4)
Vivian Hudson
10,252
2.93%
6.03
October 19, 2010
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained. (3)
11,272
3.22%
6.03
October 19, 2010
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 100% on the third or fourth anniversary date of the grant when performance objectives related to revenue as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained. (4)
6,297
1.80%
8.28
April 7, 2011
50% on the third and fourth anniversary date of the grant.
 
 
 
 
Name
RSUs
Granted
(#)
Percentage of Total
RSUs Granted to
Employees in
Financial Year (%) (1)
Fair Value
at the Time
of Grant
(US$/RSU)
Grant Date
Vesting schedule (2)
Dana Yearian
11,609
3.31%
6.03
October 19, 2010
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 1/3 on the third anniversary date of the grant and up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant if performance objectives namely related to long-term growth of revenue and profitability, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained. (3)
8,857
2.53%
6.03
October 19, 2010
100% on the fifth anniversary date of the grant subject to early vesting up to 100% on the third or fourth anniversary date of the grant when performance objectives related to revenue, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation are fully attained. (4)
     
     
(1)  
Such percentage does not include any cancelled RSUs.
(2)  
All RSUs first vesting cannot be earlier than the third anniversary date of their grant.
(3)  
Those RSUs granted in the financial year ended August 31, 2011 vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant but are subject to early vesting on the third and fourth anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the first early vesting is up to 1/3 of the units on the third anniversary date of the grant and the second early vesting is up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant. The early vesting shall be subject to the attainment of performance objectives. Such performance objectives are based on the attainment of a sales growth metric combined with a profitability metric. The sales growth metric is determined according to the Compound Annual Growth Rate (CAGR) of the sales of the Corporation (SALES CAGR). The profitability metric is determined according to the Compound Annual Growth Rate (CAGR) of the Corporation’s net earnings before interest, income taxes, amortization of property, plant and equipment, amortization of intangible assets, impairment of goodwill and extraordinary gain (EBITDA) (EBITDA CAGR). Accordingly, the first early vesting performance objectives will be attained, calculated on a pro-rated basis as follows: i) 100% for a SALES CAGR of 20% or more and 0% for a SALES CAGR of 5% or less for the three-year period ending on August 31, 2013, cumulated with ii) 100% for an EBITDA CAGR of the highest of a) 20% or b) the SALES CAGR for the three-year period ending on August 31, 2013 and 0% for an EBITDA CAGR of 10% or less for the three-year period ending on August 31, 2013. The second early vesting performance objectives will be attained on the same premises as described above but for the four-year period ending on August 31, 2014.
(4)  
Those RSUs granted in the financial year ended August 31, 2011 vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant but are subject to early vesting on the third or fourth anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Corporation. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the first early vesting is up to 100% of the units on the third anniversary date of the grant or, if not attained, the second early vesting is up to 100% of the units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant. The early vesting shall be subject to the attainment of performance objectives. Such performance objectives are based on the attainment of a sales metric in any fiscal year period following the date of the grant.
 
The following table summarizes information about RSUs granted to the members of the Board of Directors and to Management and Corporate Officers of the Corporation and its subsidiaries as at August 31, 2011:
 
 
 
Number of RSUs (#)
% of Issued and
Outstanding RSUs
Weighted Average Fair Value at
the Time of Grant ($US/RSU)
  President and CEO (one individual)
 222,899
 14.37%
 4.31
  Board of Directors (four individuals) (1)
           –
    –
     –
  Management and Corporate Officers (eleven individuals)
 597,127
 38.48%
 4.18
       
       
(1)  
Five individuals from September 1, 2010 until January 20, 2011.
 
Option Grants in Last Financial Year
 
There were no options to purchase the Corporation’s Subordinate Voting Shares granted during the financial year ended August 31, 2011. At August 31, 2011, there were a total of 641,357 Subordinate Voting Shares covered by options granted and outstanding pursuant to the LTIP having a weighted average exercise price of US$6.27 (CA$9.42) per option.
 


The following table summarizes information about stock options granted to the members of the Board of Directors, and to Management and Corporate Officers of the Corporation and its subsidiaries as at August 31, 2011:
 
 
Number of
Options (#)
% of Issued and
Outstanding Options
Weighted Average Exercise
Price ($US/Security)
  President and CEO (one individual)
 149,160
 23.26%
 5.71
  Board of Directors (three individuals)
   44,003
   6.86%
 6.34
  Management and Corporate Officers (four individuals)
   74,494
 11.62%
 6.84
 
·  
Deferred Share Unit Plan
 
Introduced in October 2004 and effective as of January 2005, the Deferred Share Unit Plan is designed to align more closely the interests of the Corporation’s non-employee directors with those of its shareholders.
 
 Under the Deferred Share Unit Plan, non-employee directors may elect to receive up to 100 % of their retainer fees in the form of Deferred Share Units (“DSUs”), each of which has an estimated value determined based on the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (for grants of DSUs prior to January 1, 2009) or the Bank of Canada (for grants of DSUs on or after January 1, 2009) on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars, as required. The value at vesting of a DSU is equivalent to the market value of a Subordinate Voting Share when a DSU is converted to such Subordinate Voting Share. DSUs attract dividends in the form of additional DSUs at the same rate as dividends on Subordinate Voting Share. When a director ceases to be a member of the Board of Directors, the DSUs are either converted and paid in Subordinate Voting Shares purchased on the open market or issued by the Corporation. Such Subordinate Voting Shares issued by the Corporation will be issued from the same pool of Subordinate Voting Shares reserved for issuance pursuant to the LTIP, which is 10.4% of the total issued and outstanding voting shares.
 
·  
Deferred Share Unit Grants in Last Financial Year
 
The aggregate number of Deferred Share Units (“DSUs”) credited to non-employee directors during the financial year ended August 31, 2011 was 12,786. The estimated value at the time of grant of a DSU is determined based on the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (for grants of DSUs prior to January 1, 2009) or the Bank of Canada (for grants of DSUs on or after January 1, 2009) on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars, as required. The value at vesting of a DSU is equivalent to the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares when a DSU is converted to such Subordinate Voting Shares. As at August 31, 2011, there were a total of 110,298 DSUs credited to directors pursuant to the Deferred Share Unit Plan having a weighted average fair value at the time of grant of US$4.94 (CA$5.40).
 
During the financial year ended August 31, 2011, the following DSUs were granted to the non-employee members of the Board of Directors:
 
DSUs #
Weighted Average Fair Value
at the Time of Grant (US$/DSU)
Total of the Fair Value at the Time
of Grant (US$)
Vesting
12,786
7.87
100,688
  At the time director ceases to be a member of the Board
  of Directors of the Corporation
 
 The following table summarizes information about DSUs granted to the non-employee members of the Board of Directors as at November 1, 2011:
 
 
Number of DSUs (#)
% of Issued and
Outstanding DSUs
Total of the Fair Value at
the Time of Grant (US$)
Weighted Average Fair Value
at the Time of Grant (US$/DSU)
Board of Directors (four individuals)
110,298
100%
545,302
4.94
 
 

·  
Number of Subordinate Voting Shares reserved for future issuance
 
During the financial year ended August 31, 2011, 12,786 DSUs and 350,382 RSUs were granted to directors, officers and employees. Such awards were issued from the pool of Subordinate Voting Shares reserved for issuance pursuant to the LTIP and the Deferred Share Unit Plan of which the maximum number of Subordinate Voting Shares issuable shall not exceed 6,306,153, which represents 10.4% of the Corporation’s issued and outstanding voting shares as at November 1, 2011. As at November 1, 2011, the number of Subordinate Voting Shares reserved for future issuance is 2,237,060 representing 3.7% of the Corporation’s issued and outstanding voting shares as at November 1, 2011.
 
·  
Stock Appreciation Rights Plan
 
On August 4, 2001, the Corporation established a Stock Appreciation Rights Plan (“SAR Plan”), as amended on January 12, 2010, for the benefit of certain employees residing in countries where the granting of stock-based compensation under the LTIP is not feasible in the opinion of the Corporation. The Board of Directors has full and complete authority to interpret the SAR Plan and to establish the rules and regulations applying to it and to make all other determinations it deems necessary or useful for the administration of the SAR Plan.
 
Under the SAR Plan, eligible employees are entitled to receive a cash amount equivalent to the difference between the market price of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of exercise or the date of vesting and the exercise price determined on the date of grant. No Subordinate Voting Shares are issuable under the SAR Plan.
 
The Board of Directors has delegated to Management the task of designating the recipients of stock appreciation rights, the date of exercise or vesting, the expiry date and other conditions. Under the terms of the SAR Plan, the exercise price determined on the date of grant of the stock appreciation right is equal to zero if the stock appreciation right is to reflect a RSU under the LTIP or, if the stock appreciation right is to reflect an option under the LTIP, the exercise price determined on the date of grant may not be lower than the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars. Stock appreciation rights are non-transferable.
 
The stock appreciation rights, reflecting an option under the LTIP, vest over a four-year period, with 25% vesting annually commencing on the first anniversary date of the date of grant. However, since October 2007, some stock appreciation rights, representing an option under the LTIP, vest at a rate of 50% annually commencing on the third anniversary date of the grants made in October 2007, October 2008 and October 2009.
 
For stock appreciation rights, reflecting an option under the LTIP, once vested, such right may be exercised between the second and the fifteenth business day following each release of the Corporation’s quarterly financial results and will lapse immediately upon the termination of the relationship with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries for a good and sufficient cause or at the date on which an employee resigns or leaves his employment with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries (or within 30 days if the holder is dismissed without cause). In the event of retirement or disability, any stock appreciation right held by an employee lapses 30 days after the date of any such disability or retirement. In the event of death, any stock appreciation right lapses 6 months after the date of death.
 
The stock appreciation rights, reflecting a RSU under the LTIP, vest at a rate of 50% annually commencing on the third anniversary date of the date of grant of October 2010 and October 2011.
 
The stock appreciation rights, reflecting a RSU under the LTIP, will: i) lapse immediately upon the termination of the relationship with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries for a good and sufficient cause or at the date on which an employee resigns or leaves his employment with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries; and ii) vest immediately, to a certain proportion as determined by the SAR Plan, upon the termination without cause of the relationship of an employee with the Corporation or one of its subsidiaries.
 
All of the stock appreciation rights that are granted under the SAR Plan may be exercised within a maximum period of 10 years following the date of their grant.
 


 The following table summarizes information about SARs exercised during the financial year ended August 31, 2011:
 
Number of SARs exercised
Aggregate Value Realized (US$) (1)
14,750
56,069
   
   
(1)  
The aggregate value realized is equivalent to the market value of the securities underlying the SARs at exercise. This value, as the case maybe, has been converted from Canadian dollars to U.S. dollars based on the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada on the day of exercise.
 
During the financial year ended August 31, 2011, 4,500 SARs were granted to employees. As at November 1, 2011, there were 33,124 SARs outstanding.
 
Benefits and Perquisites
 
All eligible employees of the Corporation, including the NEOs, are eligible to participate in the Corporation’s benefits program, which includes, life insurance, extended health and dental coverage, short and long-term disability coverage, accidental death and dismemberment (AD&D) and emergency travel assistance. Although the majority of costs of the benefits are paid by the Corporation, employees (including the NEOs) are also required to contribute to obtain such benefits.
 
With the exception of car allowances that are provided to the Corporation’s CEO, Vice-President, Sales — Americas and Vice-President, Sales — EMEA, executive officers, including other NEOs, do not receive any perquisites. The value of the perquisites for each of the NEOs, if applicable, is less than $50,000, or 10% of total annual salary and bonus for the financial year and, as such is not included in the table provided under the heading “Summary Compensation Table” and in the table provided under the heading “Termination and Change of Control Benefits”.
 
Deferred Profit-Sharing Plan
 
The Corporation maintains a deferred profit-sharing plan (“DPSP”) for certain eligible Canadian resident employees, including NEOs but excluding the Corporation’s CEO under which the Corporation may elect to contribute an amount equal to 3% (2% prior to January 2011) of an employee’s gross salary, provided that the employee has contributed at least 3% (2% prior to January 2011) of his gross salary to a tax-deferred registered retirement savings plan. Cash contributions, for eligible employees to this plan and expenses for the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, amounted to US$504,000, US$592,000 and US$911,000, respectively. The amounts contributed to the DPSP are invested at the employee’s will in the investment vehicles offered by Standard Life, the Corporation’s fund administrator. Withdrawals of funds from the DPSP account are not permitted. In the event of termination of the employment, if the employee has been a member of the DPSP for more than 2 years, the employee is entitled to receive the funds accumulated in his DPSP account.
 
401K Plan
 
The Corporation maintains a 401K plan for eligible United States resident employees of its subsidiaries. Employees become eligible to participate in the 401K plan on the date they are hired. Under this plan, the company must contribute an amount equal to 3% of an employee’s current compensation. In addition, employees may elect to defer their current compensation up to the lesser of 1% of eligible compensation or the statutorily prescribed annual limit and have the deferral contributed to the 401K plan. The 401K plan permits, but does not require the Corporation to make additional matching contributions to the 401K plan on behalf of the eligible participants, subject to a maximum of 50% of the first 6% of the participant’s current compensation subject to certain legislated maximum contribution limits. The Corporation contributes up to 3% of the participant’s current compensation, subject to certain legislated maximum contribution limits. In the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, the Corporation made aggregate contributions of US$544,000, US$525,000 and US$680,000 respectively, to the 401K plan. Contributions by participants or by the Corporation to the 401K plan and income earned on plan contributions are generally not taxable to the participant until withdrawn and contributions by the Corporation are generally deductible by the Corporation when made. At the direction of each participant, the trustees of the 401K plan invest the assets of the 401K plan in selected investment options. As at August 31, 2011, the Corporation made aggregate contributions of US$3,491,000 to the 401K plan. A participant may have access to the assets of the plan under the following limited circumstances: (i) termination of employment; (ii) permitted withdrawals; and (iii) limited loans.
 
 

2011 Performance and Compensation
 
Compensation for the NEOs is awarded through the Corporation’s executive compensation plan, which aligns compensation with key strategic objectives and individual performance. The Corporation has established a scorecard outlining key performance indicators which is applicable to all employees. These performance indicators focus efforts, communicate priorities and enable performance to be benchmarked. The following table highlights the Corporation’s performance against these indicators in fiscal 2011.
 
2011 Performance Indicators
Corporation’s Performance
    Short-Term Incentive Plan (STIP)
Telecom (% of achievement)
   Financial
      · Sales
      · EBITDA
        · Gross margin
 
   85%
   98%
   65%
   Customer Satisfaction
      · Quality
        · On-time delivery
 
 102%
   61%
Sales Vice-Presidents
· Revenue (billings)
· Margins (quotas)
· Contribution Margins
 
   83%
   95%
   87%
    Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) - RSUs
 
Date of Grant
Vesting Date
% of early vesting achievement (1)
October 23, 2007
October 24, 2011
50%
October 22, 2008
October 24, 2011
96%
October 22, 2008
October 24, 2011
  0%
     
     
(1)  
The vesting schedules are provided in the table under the heading “Long-Term Incentive Plan”.
 
CEO Performance Compensation during Last Three (3) Fiscal Years
 
The following table compares the compensation awarded to Mr. Lamonde in respect of his performance as CEO to the Total Market Capitalization Growth for the last three (3) fiscal years. The compensation includes base salary, short-term incentive payments, as well as long-term incentive payments at grant date pursuant to the LTIP.
 
  Compensation Elements
2011
2010
2009
3-Year Total
 
  Cash
 
  Base Salary
               CA$420,000
                 CA$400,000
              CA$371,000
            CA$1,191,000
 
  Short-term incentive
               CA$216,626
                 CA$257,127
              CA$159,452
               CA$633,205
 
  Equity
 
  Long-term incentive
               CA$280,003 (1)
                 CA$259,698  (1)
              CA$192,499  (1)
               CA$732,200 (1)
 
  Total Direct Compensation
               CA$916,629
                 CA$916,825
              CA$722,951
            CA$2,556,405
 
  Pension Value
                                 –
                                   –
                                 –
                                 –
 
  All Other Compensation
                                 –
                                   –
                                 –
                                 –
 
  Total Compensation
               CA$916,629
                 CA$916,825
              CA$722,951
            CA$2,556,405
 
  Annual Average
                                 –
                                   –
                                 –
               CA$852,135
 
  Total Market Capitalization Growth (CA$ millions)
                            40.8
                             156.2  (2)
                       (106.0)  (2)
                            90.9 (2)
 
  Total Cost as a % of Market Capitalization Growth
                           2.2%
                             0.6%
                                 –
                           2.8%
 
       
       
(1)  
Indicates the dollar amount based on the grant date fair value of the RSUs awarded under the LTIP for the financial year. The grant date fair value is equal to the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (for grants of RSUs prior to January 1, 2009) or the Bank of Canada (for grants of RSUs on or after January 1, 2009) on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars. Grants of RSUs to NEOs are detailed under section “Compensation Discussion & Analysis – Long-Term Incentive Plan”.
(2)  
Includes the redemption of 3,600 and 8,181,093 Subordinate Voting Shares respectively in fiscal 2010 and 2009 under the normal course issuer bid and substantial issuer bid of the Corporation during these years.
 
 

Conclusion
 
By way of application of the Corporation’s executive compensation policy, an important part of executive compensation is linked to corporate performance and long-term value creation. The Human Resources Committee continuously reviews executive compensation programs to ensure that they maintain their competitiveness and continue to focus on the Corporation’s objectives, values and business strategies.
 
Depending on specific circumstances, the Human Resources Committee may also recommend employment terms and conditions that deviate from the policies and the execution by the Corporation or its subsidiaries of employment contracts on a case-by-case basis.
 
Summary Compensation Table
 
The table below shows compensation information during the three most recently completed financial years for the NEOs. This information includes the US dollar value of base salaries, share-based and option-based awards, non-equity incentive plan compensations, pension value and all other compensation, if any, whether paid or deferred.
 
Name and
Principal Position
Financial
Year
Salary (1) (2)
($)
Share-Based
Awards (2) (3)
($)
Option-
based
Awards
($)
Non-equity incentive
plan compensation ($)
Pension
value ($)
All other
compensation (2) (5)
($)
Total
Compensation
($)
Annual
Incentive
plans (2) (4)
Long-term
Incentive
plans
  Germain Lamonde,
  President and Chief
  Executive Officer
2011
      424,500(US)
      420,000(CA)
      283,003(US)
      280,003     (CA)
      218,947(US)
      216,626(CA)
           –
        926,450(US)
        916,629(CA)
2010
      382,922(US)
      400,000(CA)
      248,610(US)
      259,698     (CA)
      246,149(US)
      257,127(CA)
           –
        877,681(US)
        916,825(CA)
2009
      314,887(US)
      371,000(CA)
      163,384(US)
      192,499     (CA)
      135,335(US)
      159,452(CA)
           –
        613,606(US)
        722,951(CA)
  Pierre Plamondon,
  Vice-President,
  Finance and 
  Chief Financial
  Officer
2011
      241,646(US)
      239,085(CA)
      137,305(US)
      135,850      (CA)
        76,569     (US)
        75,757     (CA)
              8,747    (US)
              8,654    (CA)
        464,267(US)
        459,346(CA)
2010
      221,137(US)
      231,000(CA)
        63,182     (US)
        66,000     (CA)
        92,060     (US)
        96,166     (CA)
              5,777    (US)
              6,035    (CA)
        382,156(US)
        399,202(CA)
2009
      186,726(US)
      220,000(CA)
      102,614(US)
      120,900      (CA)
        51,033     (US)
        60,127     (CA)
              5,033    (US)
              5,930    (CA)
        345,406(US)
        406,957(CA)
  Jon Bradley,
  Vice-President,
  Sales — EMEA
2011
      158,312(US)
      156,634(CA)
        98,708     (£)
      108,584(US)
      107,433      (CA)
        69,396     (£)
      103,761(US)
      102,661(CA)
        64,695     (£)
           –
        370,657(US)
        366,728(CA)
        232,799(£)
2010
      151,044(US)
      157,780(CA)
        96,532     (£)
        39,003     (US)
        40,742     (CA)
        24,927     (£)
        96,363     (US)
      100,661(CA)
        61,585     (£)
           –
        286,410(US)
        299,183(CA)
        183,044(£)
2009
      133,799(US)
      157,642(CA)
        86,100     (£)
      105,766(US)
      124,614      (CA)
        68,061     (£)
        65,578     (US)
        77,264     (CA)
        42,200     (£)
           –
        305,143(US)
        359,520(CA)
        196,361(£)
  Vivian Hudson,
  Vice-President,
  Service Assurance
2011
      194,880(US)
      192,814(CA)
      185,630(US)
      183,662      (CA)
        49,274     (US)
        48,752     (CA)
              6,489    (US)
              6,420    (CA)
        436,273(US)
        431,648(CA)
2010
      174,134(US)
      181,900(CA)
        48,822     (US)
        51,000     (CA)
        50,664     (US)
        52,924     (CA)
              4,387    (US)
              4,582    (CA)
        278,007(US)
        290,406(CA)
2009
      140,403(US)
      165,423(CA)
        36,073     (US)
        42,501     (CA)
        33,640     (US)
        39,635     (CA)
              1,458    (US)
              1,718    (CA)
        211,574(US)
        249,277(CA)
  Dana Yearian,
  Vice-President,
  Sales — Americas
2011
      208,000(US)
      205,795(CA)
      123,410(US)
      122,102      (CA)
      217,246(US)
      214,944(CA)
              7,350    (US)
              7,272    (CA)
        556,006(US)
        550,113(CA)
2010
      200,000(US)
      208,920(CA)
        57,001     (US)
        59,544     (CA)
      170,297(US)
      177,892(CA)
              8,502    (US)
              8,881    (CA)
        435,801(US)
        455,237(CA)
2009
      190,000(US)
      223,858(CA)
      114,451(US)
     134,846      (CA)
        97,508     (US)
      114,884(CA)
              6,536    (US)
              7,701    (CA)
        408,495(US)
        481,289(CA)
 
 
 
 
                   
(1)  
Base salary earned in the financial year, regardless when paid.
(2)  
The compensation information for Canadian residents has been converted from Canadian dollars to US dollars based upon an average foreign exchange rate of CA$0.9894 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2011, CA$1.0446 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2010 and CA$1.1782 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2009. The compensation information for UK resident has been converted from British Pounds to US dollars based upon an average foreign exchange rate of £0.6235 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2011, £0.6391 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2010 and £0.6435 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2009 and the conversion from US dollars to Canadian dollars is made as described above.
(3)  
Indicates the dollar amount based on the grant date fair value of the RSUs awarded under the LTIP for the financial year. The grant date fair value is equal to the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (for grants of RSUs prior to January 1, 2009) or the Bank of Canada (for grants of RSUs on or after January 1, 2009) on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars. Grants of RSUs to NEOs are detailed under section “Compensation Discussion & Analysis – Long-Term Incentive Plan”.
(4)  
Indicates the total bonus earned during the financial year whether paid during the financial year or payable on a later date:
 
 
Name
Paid during the
financial year ended
August 31, 2011 (i)
($)
Paid in the first quarter
of the financial year
ending on August 31, 2012 (i)
($)
Total bonus earned during
the financial year
ended August 31, 2011 (i)
($)
 
  Germain Lamonde
                           115,697    (US)
                           114,471    (CA)
                           103,250    (US)
                           102,155    (CA)
                          218,947    (US)
                          216,626    (CA)
 
  Pierre Plamondon
                          42,953    (US)
                          42,497    (CA)
                          33,616    (US)
                          33,260    (CA)
                         76,569    (US)
                         75,757    (CA)
 
  Jon Bradley
                          83,024    (US)
                          82,144    (CA)
                          51,765    (£)
                          20,737    (US)
                          20,517    (CA)
                          12,930    (£)
                          103,761    (US)
                          102,661    (CA)
                         64,695    (£)
 
  Vivian Hudson
                          30,021    (US)
                          29,703    (CA)
                          19,253    (US)
                          19,049    (CA)
                         49,274    (US)
                         48,752    (CA)
 
  Dana Yearian
                           181,639    (US)
                           179,714    (CA)
                          35,607    (US)
                          35,230    (CA)
                          217,246     (US)
                          214,944    (CA)
 
         
   (i) Refer to note 2 above.      
 
(5)  
Indicates the amount contributed by the Corporation during the financial year to the Deferred Profit-Sharing Plan as detailed under section “Compensation Discussion & Analysis – Deferred Profit-Sharing Plan”, 401K Plan as detailed under section “Compensation Discussion & Analysis – 401K Plan”, as applicable, for the benefit of the NEOs. Mr. Lamonde is not eligible to participate in the Deferred Profit Sharing Plan and Mr. Bradley did not participate but received an allocation to be used at his discretion.
 
Incentive Plan Awards
 
The significant terms of all plan-based awards and non-equity incentive plan awards, issued or vested, or under which options have been exercised, during the fiscal year, or outstanding at the end of the financial year are described herein under the section entitled “Compensation Discussion and Analysis – Long-Term Incentive Plan” and “Compensation Discussion and Analysis – Short Term Incentive Compensation”.
 
Outstanding share-based awards and option-based awards
 
The following sets out for each NEO all option and RSU awards outstanding as at August 31, 2011, if any, including those granted before August 31, 2011.
 
Name
Outstanding Option-based Awards (Options)
Outstanding Share-based Awards (RSUs)
Number of securities
underlying
unexercised options
(#)
Option
Exercise
Price
(US$) (1)
Option
expiration date
Value (2) of
unexercised in-
the-money
options (US$) (3)
Number of shares
or units of shares
that have not
vested (#)
Market or payout
value of share-based
awards that have
not vested (US$) (4)
   Germain Lamonde
               70,000
 9.13
   Oct. 10, 2011
                        –
                      222,899
1,491,194
               50,000
 1.58
   Sept. 25, 2012
              255,500
               17,942
 4.51
   Feb. 1, 2015
                39,114
               11,218
 4.76
   Dec. 6, 2015
                21,651
   Pierre Plamondon
               19,000
 9.13
   Oct. 10, 2011
                        –
                        96,331
   644,454
                 5,383
 5.13
   Oct. 26, 2014
                  8,397
                 3,653
 4.76
   Dec. 6, 2015
                  7,050
 
 
 
85

 
 
Name
Outstanding Option-based Awards (Options)
Outstanding Share-based Awards (RSUs)
Number of securities
underlying
unexercised options
(#)
Option
Exercise
Price
(US$) (1)
Option
expiration date
Value (2) of
unexercised in-
the-money
options (US$) (3)
Number of shares
or units of shares
that have not
vested (#)
Market or payout
value of share-based
awards that have
not vested (US$) (4)
   Jon Bradley
                       –
 –
                        –
                        75,398
   504,413
   Vivian Hudson
                       –
 –
                        –
                        55,205
   369,321
   Dana Yearian
                       –
 –
                        –
                        95,834
   641,129
             
             
(1)
Prices noted are the grant date exercise price for each option under each award.
(2)
The unexercised options have not been and may never be exercised and actual gains if any, on exercise will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of exercise. There can be no assurance that these options will be exercised or any gain realized.
(3)
Indicates an aggregate value of “in-the-money” unexercised options held at the financial year ended August 31, 2011. “In-the-money” options are options for which the market value of the underlying securities is higher than the exercise price. The value of unexercised in-the-money options at financial year end is the difference between its exercise or base price and the market value of the underlying Subordinate Voting Share at August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required.
(4)
The value of unvested RSUs at the financial year-end is the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required. The actual gains on vesting will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of vesting. There can be no assurance that these values will be realized.
 
Exercised Option-Based Awards
 
The following table summarizes, for each of the NEOs, the number of stock options, if any, exercised during the financial year ended August 31, 2011 and the aggregate gains realized upon exercise, if any. Gains realized upon exercise are the difference between the market value of the underlying Subordinate Voting Shares on the exercise date and the exercise or base price of the option.
 
Name
Exercised Option-based Awards (Options)
Number of securities underlying
exercised options (#)
Option Exercise Price
(US$)
Option grant date
Gains realized (US$)
   Germain Lamonde
                                        –
                                       –
                                 –
   Pierre Plamondon
20,000
 1.58
September 25, 2002
135,829
   Jon Bradley
                                        –
                                      –
                                 –
   Vivian Hudson
                                        –
                                      –
                                 –
   Dana Yearian
                                        –
                                      –
                                 –
 
Incentive plan awards – value vested or earned during the year
 
The following table summarizes, for each of the NEOs, the value of option-based awards, if any vested during the financial year ended August 31, 2011, the value of share-based awards vested during the financial year ended August 31, 2011, if any, and the value of non-equity incentive plan compensation earned during the financial year ended August 31, 2011, if any.
 
Name
Option-based awards – value
vested during the year (US$) (1)
Share-based awards – value
vested during the year (US$) (2)
Non-equity incentive plan
compensation – Value earned
during the year (US$) (3)
   Germain Lamonde
                                 123,254
                               207,474
   Pierre Plamondon
                                   61,123
                                 77,025
   Jon Bradley
                                     3,588
                               103,761
   Vivian Hudson
                                           –
                                 53,835
   Dana Yearian
                                   21,874
                               217,246
 
 
 
 
       
(1)
Indicates the aggregate dollar value that would have been realized on the vesting date if the options under the option-based awards had been exercised on the vesting date. The value of option-based awards vested during the year at the vesting date is the difference between its exercise or base price and the market value of the underlying Subordinate Voting Share on the date of the vesting. The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on the date of the vesting using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required.
(2)
The aggregate dollar value realized is equivalent to the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares underlying the RSUs at vesting. This value, as the case may be, has been converted from Canadian dollars to US dollars based upon the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada on the day of vesting.
(3)
Includes total non-equity incentive plan compensation earned by each NEO in respect to the financial year ended on August 31, 2011 (as indicated under the “Summary Compensation Table”).
 
Pension plan Benefits
 
The Corporation does not have a defined benefit pension plan. The significant terms of the Deferred Profit-Sharing Plan and the 401K Plan of the Corporation are described herein under the sections entitled “Compensation Discussion and Analysis – Deferred Profit-Sharing Plan” and “Compensation Discussion and Analysis – 401K Plan”. The amounts paid by the Corporation to the NEOs under such plans are detailed in the column entitled “All other compensation” in the “Summary Compensation Table”.
 
Termination and Change of Control Benefits
 
The Corporation has an employment agreement with Mr. Germain Lamonde. The agreement is for an indeterminate period and the compensation is reviewed annually. In the event of the termination of Mr. Lamonde’s employment without cause, Mr. Lamonde will be entitled to severance payments equal to 24 months of the current rate of remuneration (base salary, STIP compensation and benefits) and the immediate vesting of all stock options and RSUs. In addition, in the event that Mr. Lamonde’s employment is terminated following a merger or an acquisition by a third party of substantially all of the Corporation’s assets or of the majority of its share capital, he will be entitled to severance payments equal to 24 months of remuneration (base salary, STIP compensation and benefits) and to the immediate vesting of all stock options and RSUs. If Mr. Lamonde voluntarily resigns he will be entitled to immediate vesting of all stock options and RSUs.
 
The Corporation has an employment agreement with Mr. Pierre Plamondon, the Corporation’s Vice-President, Finance and Chief Financial Officer. The agreement is for an indeterminate period and the compensation is reviewed annually. In the event of termination of Mr. Plamondon’s employment without cause, Mr. Plamondon will be entitled to severance payments equal to 12 months of the current base salary. In addition, in the event Mr. Plamondon’s employment is terminated following a merger or an acquisition by a third party of substantially all of the Corporation’s assets or of the majority of its share capital, he will be entitled to severance payments equal to 18 months of remuneration (base salary, STIP compensation and benefits) and to the immediate vesting of all stock options and RSUs.
 
The Corporation has an employment agreement with Mr. Jon Bradley, the Corporation’s Vice-President, Sales — EMEA. The agreement is for an indeterminate period and the compensation is reviewed annually. In the event of termination of Mr. Bradley’s employment without cause, Mr. Bradley will be entitled to severance payments equal to 2 months of the current base salary per year of service as a Vice-President of the Corporation (a minimum of 4 months of current base salary but in no case exceeding 12 months of the current base salary). In addition, in the event Mr. Bradley’s employment is terminated following a merger or an acquisition by a third party of substantially all of the Corporation’s assets or of the majority of its share capital, he will be entitled to severance payments equal to 2 months of remuneration (base salary, SIP compensation and benefits) per year of service as a Vice-President of the Corporation (a minimum of 6 months of remuneration but in no case exceeding 18 months of remuneration) and to the immediate vesting of all stock options and RSUs.
 


The Corporation has an employment agreement with Ms. Vivian Hudson, the Corporation’s Vice-President, Service Assurance Division. The agreement is for an indeterminate period and the compensation is reviewed annually. In the event of termination of Ms. Hudson’s employment without cause, Ms. Hudson will be entitled to severance payments equal to 2 months of the current base salary per year of service but in no case exceeding 12 months. In addition, in the event Ms. Hudson employment is terminated following a merger or an acquisition by a third party of substantially all of the Corporation’s assets or of the majority of its share capital, she will be entitled to severance payments equal to 2 months of remuneration (base salary, STIP compensation and benefits) per year of service as a Vice-President of the Corporation (a minimum of 6 months of remuneration but in no case exceeding 18 months of remuneration) and to the immediate vesting of all RSUs.
 
The Corporation has an employment agreement with Mr. Dana Yearian, the Corporation’s Vice-President, Sales — Americas. The agreement is for an indeterminate period and the compensation is reviewed annually. In the event of termination of Mr. Yearian’s employment without cause, Mr. Yearian will be entitled to severance payments equal to 2 months of the current base salary per year of service but in no case exceeding 12 months. In addition, in the event Mr. Yearian’s employment is terminated following a merger or an acquisition by a third party of substantially all of the Corporation’s assets or of the majority of its share capital, he will be entitled to severance payments equal to 12 months (for 0-5 years of service) or 18 months of remuneration (base salary, SIP compensation and benefits) (for more than 5 years of services) and to the immediate vesting of all stock options and RSUs.
 
The following table outlines the estimated incremental payments NEOs would be entitled to receive if a termination payment event occurred on August 31, 2011, which includes all payments, payables and benefits that would be given by the Corporation to an NEO upon such termination payment event.
 
Named Executive Officer
Termination Payment Event
Without Cause ($) (1) (2)
Change of Control ($) (2) (3) (4)
Voluntary ($)
   Germain Lamonde
                         3,148,756(US) (5)
                         3,045,566(CA)
                               3,148,756(US)
                               3,045,566(CA)
                               1,807,459(US) (6)
                               1,691,312(CA)
   Pierre Plamondon
                            577,478(US)
                            558,054(CA)
                               1,160,462(US)
                               1,139,134(CA)
                                            –
   Jon Bradley
                            341,029(US)
                            334,983(CA)
                            212,632(£)
                                  674,196(US)
                                  665,387(CA)
                                  421,363(£)
                                            –
   Vivian Hudson
                            182,142(US)
                            179.001(CA)
                                  492,093(US)
                                  484,462(CA)
                                            –
   Dana Yearian
                            487,047(US)
                            478,645(CA)
                               1,208,575(US)
                               1,203,244(CA)
                                            –
       
       
(1)
The aggregate amount disclosed includes an evaluation of the amount that the NEO would have been entitled to should a termination of employment without cause have occurred on August 31, 2011 and includes, as the case may be for each NEO, the base salary that would have been received and total value of RSUs and options that would have vested (with the exception of Mr. Lamonde’s evaluation which is described in note 4 below and includes: the base salary, STIP compensation, and total value of RSUs and options that would have vested). The amount for base salary compensation is calculated according to those amounts provided under the section entitled “Summary Compensation Table” included in this Annual Report. The amount for the total value attached to the vesting of RSUs and options determined pursuant to the LTIP as described in the section entitled “Long-Term Incentive Compensation – Long-Term Incentive Plan” for termination without cause.
(2)
The aggregate amount for Canadian residents has been converted from Canadian dollars to US dollars based upon an average foreign exchange rate of CA$0.9894 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2011. The aggregate amount disclosed for UK resident has been converted from British Pounds to US dollars based upon an average foreign exchange rate of £0.6235 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2011 and the conversion from US dollars to Canadian dollars is made as described above.
(3)
Is considered a “Change of Control” a merger or an acquisition by a third party of substantially all of the Corporation’s assets or of the majority of its share capital.
(4)
The aggregate amount disclosed includes, as the case may be for each NEO, an evaluation of the amount that the NEO would have been entitled to should a termination of employment for Change of Control have occurred on August 31, 2011 and includes, as the case may be, namely, the base salary, STIP or SIP compensation and total value of RSUs and options that would have vested. The amount for base salary and STIP or SIP compensation are calculated according to those amounts provided under the section entitled “Summary Compensation Table” included in this Annual Report, the total value attached to the vesting of RSUs and options is calculated according to those amounts provided in the columns named “Value of unexercised in-the-money options” and “Market or payout value of share-based awards that have not vested” of the table included under the heading entitled – “Outstanding share-based awards and option-based awards”.
 
 

(5)
The aggregate amount disclosed includes an evaluation of the amount that Mr. Lamonde would have been entitled to should a termination of employment without cause have occurred on August 31, 2011 and includes: the base salary, STIP compensation, and total value of RSUs and options that would have vested. The amount for base salary and STIP compensation are calculated according to those amounts provided under the section entitled “Summary Compensation Table” included in this Annual Report; the total value attached to the vesting of RSUs and options are calculated according to those amounts provided in the columns named “Value of unexercised in-the-money options” and “Market or payout value of share-based awards that have not vested” of the table included under the heading entitled – “Outstanding share-based awards and option-based awards”.
(6)
The aggregate amount disclosed includes an evaluation of the amount that Mr. Lamonde would have been entitled to should a voluntary termination of employment have occurred on August 31, 2011 and includes: the total value of RSUs and options that would have vested. The amount for the total value attached to the vesting of RSUs and options are calculated according to those amounts provided in the columns named “Value of unexercised in-the-money options” and “Market or payout value of share-based awards that have not vested” of the table included under the heading entitled – “Outstanding share-based awards and option-based awards”.
 
Compensation of Directors
 
Director Compensation Table
 
In the financial year ended August 31, 2011, each director who was not an employee of the Corporation or any of its subsidiaries received the level of compensation set forth in the following table as annual compensation payable in a combination of cash and Deferred Share Units (“DSUs”) as chosen by the director pursuant to the Deferred Share Unit Plan. The significant terms of the DSU Plan of the Corporation is described herein under the section entitled “Long-Term Incentive Compensation – Deferred Share Unit Plan”.
 
   Annual Retainer for Directors (1)
                        CA$50,000   (2)
                           US$50,536(3)
   Annual Retainer for Lead Director
                       CA$5,000
                             US$5,054(3)
   Annual Retainer for Committee Chairman
                       CA$5,000
                             US$5,054(3)
   Annual Retainer for Committee Members
                       CA$3,000
                             US$3,032(3)
   Fees for all Meetings Attended per day in Person
                       CA$1,000
                             US$1,011(3)
   Fees for all Meetings Attended per day by Telephone
                     CA$500
                                US$505(3)
     
     
(1)  
All the Directors elected to receive 50% of their Annual Retainer in form of DSUs with the exception of Mr. André Tremblay who elected to receive 0% of his Annual Retainer in form of DSUs.
(2)  
The Annual Retainer for Mr. Pierre-Paul Allard and Mr. David A. Thompson is US$50,000 (CA$49,470).
(3)  
The compensation information has been converted from Canadian dollars to US dollars based upon an average foreign exchange rate of CA$0.9894 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2011.
 
In the financial year ended August 31, 2011, the Directors who are not employees of the Corporation earned the following compensation in the form indicated:
 
Name
Fees earned (1)
($)
Share-based
Awards
($)
Option-based
awards
($)
Non-equity
incentive plan
compensation ($)
Pension
Value
($)
All other
Compensation
($)
Total
($)
   Pierre-Paul Allard
             61,623(US)
             60,970(CA)
           61,623(US)
           60,970(CA)
   Pierre Marcouiller
             64,729(US)
             64,062(CA)
           64,729(US)
           64,062(CA)
   Guy Marier
             68,401(US)
             67,675(CA)
           68,401(US)
           67,675(CA)
   David A. Thompson
             61,118(US)
             60,470(CA)
           61,118(US)
           60,470(CA)
   André Tremblay (2)
             25,487(US)
             25,217(CA)
           25,487(US)
           25,217(CA)
   
   
(1)  
The compensation information has been converted from Canadian dollars to US dollars based upon an average foreign exchange rate of CA$0.9894 = US$1.00 for the financial year ended August 31, 2011 except for Mr. Pierre-Paul Allard and Mr. David A. Thompson who are paid in US dollars for the portion of their annual retainer for Directors. The fees are always payable in cash, but executives are provided the opportunity to elect to exchange all or a portion of their Annual Retainer for Directors in DSUs. The following table identifies the portion of the fees earned by the directors that were paid in DSUs and the portion that were paid in cash.
 


 
Name
Fees earned
 
DSUs ($) (i)
Cash ($)
Total ($)
 
   Pierre-Paul Allard (ii)
                          25,000     (US)
                          24,735     (CA)
                           36,623     (US)
                           36,235     (CA)
                        61,623     (US)
                        60,970     (CA)
 
   Pierre Marcouiller (ii)
                          25,268     (US)
                          25,000     (CA)
                           39,461     (US)
                           39,042     (CA)
                        64,729     (US)
                        64,042     (CA)
 
   Guy Marier (ii)
                          25,268     (US)
                          25,000     (CA)
                           43,133     (US)
                           42,675     (CA)
                        68,401     (US)
                        67,675     (CA)
 
   David A. Thompson (ii)
                          25,000     (US)
                          24,735     (CA)
                           36,118     (US)
                           35,735     (CA)
                        61,118     (US)
                        60,470     (CA)
 
   André Tremblay (iii)
                     –     (US)
                     –     (CA)
                           25,487     (US)
                           25,217     (CA)
                        25,487     (US)
                        25,217     (CA)
 
         
(i)  
The estimated value at the time of grant of a DSU is determined based on the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (for grants of DSUs prior to January 1, 2009) or the Bank of Canada (for grants of DSUs on or after January 1, 2009) on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars, as required. The value at vesting of a DSU is equivalent to the market value of a Subordinate Voting Share when a DSU is converted to such Subordinate Voting Share.
(ii)  
Elected to receive 50% of his Annual Retainer for Directors in form of DSUs.
(iii)  
Elected to receive his Annual Retainer for Directors in cash and ceased to be a member of the Board of Directors as at January 20, 2011.
 
(2)  
Mr. Tremblay ceased to be a member of the Board of Directors as at January 20, 2011.
 
Director Incentive Plan Awards
 
The significant terms of all plan-based awards and non-equity-incentive plan awards, issued or vested, or under which options have been exercised, during the year, or outstanding at the end of the financial year are described herein under section entitled “Compensation Discussion and Analysis – Long-Term Incentive Plan”.
 
Outstanding share-based awards and option-based awards
 
The following table sets out for each director of the Corporation all awards outstanding as at August 31, 2011, if any, including awards granted before August 31, 2011.
 
Name
Outstanding Option-based Awards (Options)
Outstanding Share-based Awards (DSUs)
Number of securities
underlying
unexercised options
(#)
Option
Exercise
Price
(US$) (1)
Option
expiration date
Value (2) of
unexercised in-
the-money
options (US$) (3)
Number of shares
or units of shares
that have not
vested (#)
Market or payout
value of share-based
awards that have
not vested (US$) (4)
   Pierre-Paul Allard
                                 –
                                –
                     –
16,270
 108,846
   Pierre Marcouiller
17,966
                            9.13
Oct. 10, 2011
                     –
31,942
 213,692
                          1,037
                          12.69
Dec. 1, 2011
                     –
   Guy Marier
12,500
                            4.65
Mar. 24, 2014
25,500
31,942
 213,692
   David A. Thompson
12,500
                            3.51
Oct. 27, 2013
39,750
30,144
 201,663
   André Tremblay (5)
                                –
                                –
                     –
                        –
                               –
   
   
(1)
Prices noted are the grant date exercise price for each option under each award.
(2)
The unexercised options have not been and may never be exercised and actual gains if any, on exercise will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of exercise. There can be no assurance that these options will be exercised or any gain realized.
(3)
Indicates an aggregate value of “in-the-money” unexercised options held at the financial year ended August 31, 2011. “In-the-money” options are options for which the market value of the underlying securities is higher than the exercise price. The value of unexercised in-the-money options at financial year end is the difference between its exercise or base price and the market value of the underlying Subordinate Voting Share at August 31, 2011 which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required.
 
 

(4)
The value of unvested DSUs at the financial year-end is the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required. The actual gains on vesting will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of vesting. There can be no assurance that these values will be realized.
(5)
Mr. Tremblay ceased to be a member of the Board of Directors as at January 20, 2011.
 
Exercised option-based awards
 
The following table sets out for each director of the Corporation all awards exercised during the financial year ended August 31, 2011, if any.
 
Name
Exercised Option-based Awards (Options)
Number of securities underlying exercised options (#)
Option Exercise Price
(US$)
Option
grant date
Gains realized (US$)
   Pierre-Paul Allard
       –
                                     –
                               –
   Pierre Marcouiller
12,500
 1.58
Sept. 25, 2002
                    117,270
12,500
 3.51
Oct. 27, 2003
                      89,282
 2,479
 5.65
March 1, 2002
                        7,150
   Guy Marier
       –
                                     –
                               –
  David A. Thompson
12,500
 1.58
Sept. 25, 2002
                    123,457
15,334
 9.13
Oct. 10, 2001
                      35,728
   André Tremblay (1)
       –
                                     –
                               –
     
     
(1)  
Mr. Tremblay ceased to be a member of the Board of Directors as at January 20, 2011.
 
In the financial year that ended August 31, 2011, all of the options of directors were exercisable; none of the DSUs of directors vested with the exception of Mr. André Tremblay as detailed below and the directors did not receive any non-equity incentive compensation from the Corporation.
 
The following table summarizes information about DSUs converted and paid in Subordinate Voting Shares when a director ceased to be a member of the Board as at November 1, 2011:
 
Name
Number of DSUs converted
Aggregate Value Realized (US$) (1)
André Tremblay (2)
37,491
371,094
     
     
(1)  
The aggregate value realized is equivalent to the market value of the securities underlying the DSUs at conversion. This value has been converted from Canadian dollars to U.S. dollars based on the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada on the day of conversion.
(2)  
Mr. Tremblay ceased to be a member of the Board of Directors as at January 20, 2011.
 
Securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans
 
The following sets forth the number of Subordinate Voting Shares of the Corporation issued and outstanding as at August 31, 2011 or that may be issued, under the Corporation’s Long Term Incentive plan (“LTIP”) and Deferred Share Unit plan (“DSUP”), both of which were approved by the Corporation’s shareholders.
 
Plan category
Number of securities to be issued
upon exercise of outstanding
options, RSUs and DSUs (#)
(a)
Weighted-average exercise price
of outstanding options, RSUs and
DSUs (US$)
(b)
Number of securities remaining
available for future issuance under
equity compensation plans (excluding
securities reflected in column (a)) (#)
(c)
   LTIP – RSUs
                                         1,551,658
n/a (1)
2,230,170
   LTIP – Options
                                            641,357
6.27
   DSUP – DSUs
                                            110,298
n/a (1)
       
       
(1)
The value of RSUs and DSUs will be equal to the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares of the Corporation on the date of vesting.
 


PERFORMANCE GRAPH
 
The following graph compares the cumulative total shareholder return of EXFO’s Subordinate Voting Shares with the cumulative shareholder return of the S&P/TSX Composite Index for the last five years ended August 31, 2011. It assumes that the initial value of the investment in EXFO’s Subordinate Voting Shares and in the S&P/TSX Composite Index was CA$100 on August 31, 2006. The bar chart, included in the graph below, shows the trend in total compensation paid to our named executive officers of such identified period of which the CEO and CFO are included in every period but the remaining three (3) named executive officers changed form one period to another. For further information on the identity and compensation of those named executive officers, please refer to our previous five (5) Annual Reports and this Annual Report under the summary compensation table.
 
The Corporation’s Stock Performance
(August 31, 2006 to August 31, 2011)
 
 
 
 
August 31,
 
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
   EXFO Subordinate Voting Share
                   100
                   120
                     76
                    56
                  100
                  110
   S&P/TSX Stock Index
                   100
                   112
                   113
                    89
                    98
                  105
   Sum of NEO’s total compensation
      (in millions of CA$)
                 $1.8
                  $2.0
                  $2.1
                 $2.3
                 $2.5
                 $2.7
 
The trends shown by the performance graphs set forth above represent a growth in the total shareholder return from August 31, 2006 to August 31, 2007, followed by a decline in the financial years ended August 31, 2008 and 2009 and followed by an increase in the financial years ended August 31, 2010 and 2011. The performance of the Corporation over the same period is relatively in line with the performance of the Index except for the financial year 2008 and 2009 where the impact of the recession affected the telecom market and the Corporation earlier and more severely than the Index. However, the recovery for the corporation in financial years 2010 and 2011 was much stronger than the Index.
 
Over the same five-year period, the chart clearly depicts that the level of the total compensation received by the named executive officers over the identified period, closely follows our share performance levels during three of the last five financial years. The exceptions in this trend were during financial years ended August 31, 2008 and 2009, this can be explained through the fact that:
 


·  
Our share performance improved from the financial year ended August 31, 2006 to the financial year ended August 31, 2007 and from the financial year ended August 31, 2009 to the financial year ended August 31, 2011, which is aligned with the increase of the total compensation received by the NEOs during such periods reflecting the implementation of the revised Long-Term Incentive Plan in fiscal year 2005.
 
·  
Our share performance weakened in financial years ended August 31, 2008 and 2009 as a result of the significant downturn in the economy; this is similar to other technology sector companies. It should be noted that during these two fiscal years, we delivered EBITDA* of 11.2 % and 8.4 % respectively for 2008 and 2009 while we were expanding our activities, developing new market territories and acquiring new businesses. This expansion significantly increased the complexity of our operations and the organization.
 
·  
The increase in the total compensation received by the named executive officers over the identified five-year period is the result of an initiative to gradually close the compensation gap with respect to market rates pursuant to our three-year plan adopted in 2007 based on Mercer’s and Aon’s recommendations and our plan adopted in 2010 being defined herein as the Mercer Three Year Compensation Plan. In addition, total compensation received by the named executive officers over the identified period roses as a result of the additional roles and responsibilities of such individual due to the increased complexity of our organization and to the addition of new senior members in the named executives with higher compensation.
 
Overall, the total compensation, received by the named executive officers over the identified period, trend is  linked with the increase in our annual revenues from US$128.3 million for the financial year ended August 31, 2006 to US$271.7 million for the financial year ended August 31, 2011, which represents an increase of 112%.
 
Total compensation to NEOs of the Corporation is defined as the aggregate of base salary, short-term compensation, and long-term compensation. Base salary is established at the beginning of each fiscal year, according to recommendations made by the Board of Directors’ Human Resources Committee. Short-term compensation, which varies from one year to the next, is contingent upon the achievement of pre-established objectives measured against corporate and individual targets for a given fiscal year. For more information about short-term compensation, refer to the heading entitled “Short Term Incentive Compensation”. Long-term compensation, which is provided in the form of Restricted Share Units (“RSUs”), vests over a three- to five-year period, depending on the achievement of pre-established corporate goals. For more information about long-term compensation, refer to the heading entitled “Long Term Incentive Plan”.
 
Consequently, base salary and short-term compensation do not necessarily track the market value of our share price. Long-term compensation, however, is directly aligned with share-price performance, since the market value of RSUs is equal to the market value of our shares on any vesting day. Accordingly, the market value of our share price will affect the planned value of NEOs’ total compensation, thereby partially aligning their experience with that of shareholders.
 
*
EBITDA is defined as net earnings (loss) before interest, income taxes, amortization of property, plant and equipment, amortization of intangible assets, impairment of goodwill and extraordinary gain.
 



 Indemnification of Directors and Executive Officers and Limitation of Liability
 
Our by-laws require us, subject to the limitations provided by law, to indemnify our present or former Directors and officers or any persons who act or acted at our request as Directors or officers of a body corporate for all costs, losses, charges and expenses that arose or may arise by reason of their status as Directors or officers of us or such body corporate. A policy of Directors’ and officers’ liability insurance is maintained by us, which insures our Directors and officers and those of our subsidiaries against liability incurred by, arising from or against them for certain of their acts, errors or omissions. Accordingly, we maintain insurance protection against liability incurred by its officers and directors as well as those of its subsidiaries in the performance of their duties. The entire premium, amounting to US$158,000 from September 30, 2011 to September 30, 2012, is paid by the Corporation. The aggregate limit of liability in respect of any and all claims is US$10 million per year, subject to a deductible of US$250,000. A separate excess director and officer liability policy (Chubb Executive Elite) with aggregate limit of US$5 million provides broad form side A coverage, featuring difference-in-conditions (DIC) drop-down coverage that fills in potential coverage gaps that may exist under restrictive or unresponsive underlying insurance. This specific policy provides coverage for personal directors and officers liability if the organization fails or refuses to indemnify, or is financially unable to do so, or is prevented by law from indemnifying and will also respond if the primary D&O policy limit is consumed.
 
 
 C.  Board Practices
 
 Board of Directors
 
Our Directors are elected at the annual meeting of shareholders for one-year terms and serve until their successors are elected or appointed, unless they resign or are removed earlier. Our articles of incorporation provide for a Board of Directors of a minimum of three (3) and a maximum of twelve (12) Directors. Our Board of Directors presently consists of seven Directors. Under the Canada Business Corporations Act, twenty-five percent of the Directors and of the members of any committee of the Board of Directors must be resident Canadians. We have no arrangements with any of our Directors providing for the payment of benefits upon their termination of service as Director except for the vesting of their respective Deferred Share Units as detailed above.
 
The following charts and notes set out the name of each of the individuals proposed to be nominated at the Annual Meeting of shareholders for election as a director of the Corporation. Included in these charts is information relating to the directors’ committee memberships, meeting attendance, period of service as a director, principal directorships with other organizations and equity ownership (or over which each of them exercised control or direction) in the Corporation.

 
 
 
   GERMAIN LAMONDE
 
 
    
 
St-Augustin-de-Desmaures, Quebec, Canada
 
Director since
September 1985
 
Not Independent (Management)
 
Principal Occupation: Chairman of the Board of Directors, President and Chief Executive Officer, EXFO Inc.
 
 
Germain Lamonde, a company founder, has been President and Chief Executive Officer of EXFO since its inception in 1985. He has also been Chairman of the Board since EXFO went public in 2000. Responsible for the overall management and strategic direction of EXFO, Mr. Lamonde has grown the company from the ground up into a global leader in the wireline and wireless telecommunication test and service assurance industry. Mr. Lamonde has served on the board of directors of several organizations such as the Canadian Institute for Photonic Innovations, the POLE QCA Economic Development Corporation and the National Optics Institute of Canada (INO), to name a few. Germain Lamonde holds a bachelor's degree in physics engineering from the University of Montreal's School of Engineering (École Polytechnique), a master's degree in optics from Université Laval in Quebec City, and is also a graduate of the Ivey Executive Management Program offered by the University of Western Ontario.
   Board/Committee Membership
Attendance (1)
   Principal Board Memberships
   Chairman of the Board of Directors
8/8
100%
   –
Securities Held
As at
Subordinate
Voting Shares(#)
Multiple Voting
Shares(#)
RSUs(#)
Total Shares (2)
and RSUs(#)
Total Market Value (3)
of Shares (2)and RSUs
(US$)
   August 31, 2011
4,043,348 (4)
31,643,000 (5)
222,899
35,909,247
240,232,862
Options Held as at August 31, 2011
Date Granted
Number(#)
Exercise Price (US$)
Total Unexercised(#)
Value of Options
Unexercised (US$) (6)
   October 10, 2001
   September 25, 2002
   February 1, 2005
   December 6, 2005
                 70,000
                 50,000
                 17,942
                 11,218
                               9.13
                               1.58
                               4.51
                               4.76
                  70,000
                  50,000
                  17,942
                  11,218
                                          –
                                255,500
                                  39,113
                                  21,651
   Total
   
                149,160
                                316,264
         
         
(1)  
From September 1, 2010 until November 1, 2011, Mr. Lamonde attended 7 meetings in person and 1 meeting by telephone.
(2)  
Includes both Subordinate Voting Shares and Multiple Voting Shares.
(3)  
The value of unvested RSUs at the financial year-end is the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares and Multiple Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required. The actual gains on vesting of RSUs will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of vesting. There can be no assurance that these values will be realized.
(4)  
Mr. Lamonde exercises control over 4,000,000 of Subordinate Voting Shares through G. Lamonde Investissements Financiers inc., a company controlled by Mr. Lamonde.
(5)  
Mr. Lamonde exercises control over this number of Multiple Voting Shares through G. Lamonde Investissements Financiers inc., a company controlled by Mr. Lamonde and through Fiducie Germain Lamonde, a family trust for the benefit of Mr. Lamonde’s family.
(6)  
Indicates an aggregate value of “in-the-money” unexercised options held at the financial year ended August 31, 2011. “In-the-money” options are options for which the market value of the underlying securities is higher than the exercise price. The value of unexercised in-the-money options at financial year end is the difference between its exercise or base price and the market value of the underlying Subordinate Voting Share as at August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required.

 
 

 
   PIERRE-PAUL ALLARD
 
 
 
Pleasanton, California, USA
 
Director since
September 2008
 
Independent
 
Principal Occupation:
Vice-President, Sales and Operations, Global Industries for Cisco Systems Inc. (1)
 
Pierre-Paul Allard was appointed a member of our Board of Directors in September 2008 and has been a board member of many other technology companies in Canada and in the US. Today, he is also an active philanthropist for l’Institut de Cardiologie de Québec. Mr. Allard is presently Vice-President, Sales and Operations, Global Industries for Cisco Systems Inc., where he has held several senior management positions over the last 18 years. More recently, Mr. Allard was President and CEO of Cisco Systems Canada.  Currently, he is responsible for all field operations of Cisco’s Global Enterprise Client segment, focusing on new business models, market transition opportunities and increased customer satisfaction. Prior to joining Cisco, Mr. Allard worked for  IBM Canada  for 12 years. In 2002, Mr. Allard  co-chaired the Canadian e-Business Initiative, a private-public partnership aiming to measure the role e-Business plays in increasing productivity levels, job creation and competitive position. In 1998, he was the laureate of the Arista-Sunlife Award, for Top Young Entrepreneur in Large Enterprise, by the Montreal Chamber of Commerce. In 2003, he received the Queen’s Golden Jubilee Medal, which highlights significant contributions to Canada.  In the same year, he was also awarded the prestigious Trudeau Medal from the University of Ottawa, Tefler School of Management. Pierre-Paul Allard holds a bachelor’s and masters’ degree in Business Administration from the University of Ottawa, in Canada.
 
   Board/Committee Membership
Attendance (2)
   Principal Board Memberships
   Board of Directors
   Audit Committee
   Human Resources Committee
   Independent Board of Directors
8/8
4/5
5/5
6/7
100%
80%
100%
86%
   –
Securities Held
As at
Subordinate
Voting Shares(#)
DSUs(#)
Total Shares
and DSUs(#)
Total Market Value (3)
of Shares (4) and DSUs
(US$)
   August 31, 2011
8,000
16,270
24,270
162,366
Options Held as at August 31, 2011
Date Granted
Number(#)
Exercise Price (US$)
Total Unexercised(#)
Value of Options
Unexercised (US$)
           
           
(1)  
Cisco Systems Inc. is a leading network equipment manufacturer in the global telecommunications industry.
(2)  
From September 1, 2010 until November 1, 2011, Mr. Allard attended 6 meetings in person and 2 meetings by telephone.
(3)  
The value of unvested DSUs at the financial year-end is the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required. The actual gains on vesting of DSUs will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of vesting. There can be no assurance that these values will be realized.
(4)  
Refers to Subordinate Voting Shares.
 
 
 
 
 
   DARRYL EDWARDS
 
 
 
 
 
Weston Under Wetherley
Warwickshire
United Kingdom
 
Director since
September 2011
 
Independent
 
Principal Occupation:
Executive Consultant
 
 
Darryl Edwards was appointed a member of our Board of Directors in September 2011. He brings to EXFO more than 30 years of telecommunications experience gained from a number of senior executive leadership positions; from 2009 to 2011, he was the Chief Executive Officer of AIRCOM International, successfully leading the company through to business sale. Mr. Edwards was previously at Nortel Networks for 17 years, where he held various executive officer positions, including President of EMEA Sales from 2006 to 2009 and in 2009 President of Global Sales (Carrier Networks). He also was the Chief Executive Officer for two of Nortel’s key joint ventures, first in the Middle East and later in Germany. Prior to his time at Nortel, Mr. Edwards spent 13 years at GEC-Plessey Telecommunications where he worked in engineering, quality assurance and international sales. Mr. Edwards has held a number of chairs, including Chairman of the Board of Nortel’s interests in Turkey, Nortel Netas, which was listed on the Istanbul Stock Exchange. He also was a member of the Advisory Counsel to the Turkish government between 2004 and 2008, and previously served on the UK Government Broadband Stakeholders Group and the Information Age Partnership. Darryl Edwards holds a Higher National Certificate (Physics) from Birmingham Polytechnic in the UK.
 
 
   Board/Committee Membership
Attendance (1)
   Principal Board Memberships
 
   Board of Directors
   Audit Committee
   Human Resources Committee
   Independent Board of Directors
2/2
1/1
1/1
2/2
100%
100%
100%
100%
   Aircom International (Africa) Pty Ltd.
 
 
Securities Held
 
As at
Subordinate
Voting Shares (#)
DSUs (#)
Total Shares
and DSUs (#)
Total Market Value (2)
of Shares (3) and DSUs
(US$)
 
   August 31, 2011
 
Options Held as at August 31, 2011
 
Date Granted
Number (#)
Exercise Price (US$)
Total Unexercised (#)
Value of Options
Unexercised (US$)
 
   –
 
         
         
(1)  
Mr. Edwards joined our Board of Directors in September 2011. From September 1, 2011 until November 1, 2011, Mr. Edward attended 2 meetings in person.
(2)  
The value of unvested DSUs at the financial year-end is the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required. The actual gains on vesting of DSUs will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of vesting. There can be no assurance that these values will be realized.
(3)  
Refers to Subordinate Voting Shares.

 

 
 
   PIERRE MARCOUILLER
 
 
 
 
Magog, Quebec, Canada
 
Director since May 2000
Lead Director since
January 2011
 
Independent
 
Principal Occupation:
Chairman of the Board and
Chief Executive Officer,
Camoplast  Solideal Inc. (1)
 
Pierre Marcouiller has served as our Director since May 2000. Mr. Marcouiller is Chairman of the Board and CEO of Camoplast Solideal Inc. a world leader in the design, manufacturing and distribution of off-road tires, rubber tracks, undercarriage systems and wheels and a NA leader in under-the-hood plastic components and assemblies for the automotive industry. Prior to joining Camoplast, Mr. Marcouiller was President and General Manager of Venmar Ventilation Inc. (1988-1996), where he was the controlling shareholder from 1991 to 1996. Mr. Marcouiller is also a Director of Canam Group Inc., an industrial company specialized in the design and fabrication of construction products and solutions in the commercial, industrial, institutional, residential, and bridge and highway infrastructures markets. Mr. Marcouiller also holds directorships in other privately held companies. Pierre Marcouiller holds a bachelor’s degree in business administration from the Université du Québec à Trois-Rivières and an MBA from the Université de Sherbrooke.
 
   Board/Committee Membership
Attendance (2)
   Principal Board Memberships
   Board of Directors
   Audit Committee
   Human Resources Committee
   Independent Board of Directors
7/8
5/5
5/5
7/7
 88%
100%
100%
100%
   Canam Group Inc.
Securities Held
As at
Subordinate
Voting Shares(#)
DSUs(#)
Total Shares
and DSUs(#)
Total Market Value (3)
of Shares (4) and DSUs
(US$)
   August 31, 2011
5,000
31,942
36,942
247,142
Options Held as at August 31, 2011
Date Granted
Number(#)
Exercise Price (US$)
Total Unexercised(#)
Value of Options
Unexercised (US$) (5)
   October 10, 2001
   December 1, 2001
                     17,966
                       1,037
                                9.13
                              12.69
                        17,966
                          1,037
                               –
                               –
   Total
   
                        19,003
                               –
           
           
(1)  
Camoplast Solideal is a world leader in the design, manufacturing and distribution of off-road tires, rubber tracks, undercarriage systems, wheels, body dressing parts, under-the-hood plastic components and assemblies, molded skis, engine covers, thermal and air induction systems for the construction, agricultural, industrial, powersports, defense and automotive markets (industries).
(2)  
From September 1, 2010 until November 1, 2011, Mr. Marcouiller attended 7 meetings in person and no meeting by telephone.
(3)  
The value of unvested DSUs at the financial year-end is the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required. The actual gains on vesting of DSUs will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of vesting. There can be no assurance that these values will be realized.
(4)  
Refers to Subordinate Voting Shares.
(5)  
Indicates an aggregate value of “in-the-money” unexercised options held at the financial year ended August 31, 2011. “In-the-money” options are options for which the market value of the underlying securities is higher than the exercise price. The value of unexercised in-the-money options at financial year end is the difference between its exercise or base price and the market value of the underlying Subordinate Voting Share at August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required.
 
 
 

 
   GUY MARIER
 
 
 
 
Lakefield Gore, Quebec, Canada
 
Director since January 2004
Lead Director from January 2007 to January 2011
 
Independent
 
Principal Occupation:
Executive Consultant
 
 
Guy Marier has served as our Director since January 2004. Formerly President of Bell Québec (1999 to 2003), Mr. Marier completed his successful 33-year career at Bell (1) as Executive Vice-President of the Project Management Office, before retiring at the end of 2003. From 1988 to 1990, Mr. Marier headed Bell Canada International’s investments and projects in Saudi Arabia and, for the three following years, served as President of Télébec. He then returned to the parent company to hold various senior management positions. Guy Marier holds a Bachelor of Arts from the University of Montreal and a Bachelor of Business Administration from the Université du Québec à Montréal.
 
   Board/Committee Membership
Attendance (2)
   Principal Board Memberships
 
   Board of Directors
   Audit Committee
   Human Resources Committee
   Independent Board of Directors
8/8
5/5
5/5
7/7
100%
100%
100%
100%
   –
 
Securities Held
 
As at
Subordinate
Voting Shares (#)
DSUs (#)
Total Shares
and DSUs (#)
Total Market Value (3)
of Shares (4) and DSUs
(US$)
 
   August 31, 2011
1,000
31,942
32,942
220,382
 
Options Held as at August 31, 2011
 
Date Granted
Number (#)
Exercise Price (US$)
Total Unexercised (#)
Value of Options
Unexercised (US$) (5)
 
   March 24, 2004
12,500
4.65
12,500
25,500
 
         
         
(1)  
Bell is Canada's largest communications company, providing consumers with solutions to all their communications needs, including telephone services, wireless communications, high-speed Internet, digital television and voice over IP. Bell also offers integrated information and communications technology services to businesses and governments.
(2)  
From September 1, 2010 until November 1, 2011, Mr. Marier attended 7 meetings in person and 1 meeting by telephone.
(3)  
The value of unvested DSUs at the financial year-end is the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required. The actual gains on vesting of DSUs will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of vesting. There can be no assurance that these values will be realized.
(4)  
Refers to Subordinate Voting Shares.
(5)  
Indicates an aggregate value of “in-the-money” unexercised options held at the financial year ended August 31, 2011. “In-the-money” options are options for which the market value of the underlying securities is higher than the exercise price. The value of unexercised in-the-money options at financial year end is the difference between its exercise or base price and the market value of the underlying Subordinate Voting Share at August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required.
 
 
 
 
   SUSAN LOUISE SPRADLEY
 
 
 
 
 
Dallas, Texas
USA
 
Director since
October 2011
 
Independent
 
Principal Occupation:
Executive Consultant
 
 
Susan Louise Spradley was appointed a member of our Board of Directors in October 2011. She brings to EXFO more than 20 years of experience in the wireless telecommunications industry in which she has held senior executive positions in sales, product line management, operations, services and customer support. From 2007 to 2011, she was Head of the North American Region at Nokia Siemens Networks and also a member of the company’s Executive Board. Prior to joining Nokia Siemens Networks, from 1997 to 2005, Ms. Spradley held prominent leadership roles at Nortel Networks including President of Global Services and Operations, President of Global Product Line Management and North American Sales, and Vice-President of Customer Service and Operations. She also served as Vice-President of Marketing and Product Development for North America at Siemens Communications. In addition, she previously was a member of the National Security Telecommunications Advisory Committee reporting to the President of the United States. Susan Spradley holds a bachelor’s degree in Computer Science from the University of Kansas and completed the Advanced Management Program at Harvard University Business School.
 
 
   Board/Committee Membership
Attendance (1)
   Principal Board Memberships
 
   Board of Directors
   Audit Committee
   Human Resources Committee
   Independent Board of Directors
1/1
1/1
1/1
1/1
100%
100%
100%
100%
   Museum of Nature and Science, Dallas, Texas
   Tango Networks
 
 
Securities Held
 
As at
Subordinate
Voting Shares (#)
DSUs (#)
Total Shares
and DSUs (#)
Total Market Value (2)
of Shares (3) and DSUs
(US$)
 
   August 31, 2011
 
Options Held as at August 31, 2011
 
Date Granted
Number (#)
Exercise Price (US$)
Total Unexercised (#)
Value of Options
Unexercised (US$)
 
   –
 
         
         
(1)  
Ms. Spradley joined our Board of Directors in October 2011. From October 1, 2011 until November 1, 2011, Ms. Spradley attended 1 meeting in person.
(2)  
The value of unvested DSUs at the financial year-end is the market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on August 31, 2011, which was US$6.69 (CA$6.55). The market value of the Subordinate Voting Shares was calculated by using the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and on the NASDAQ National Market on August 31, 2011 using the noon buying rate of the Bank of Canada to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars as required. The actual gains on vesting of DSUs will depend on the value of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the date of vesting. There can be no assurance that these values will be realized.
(3)  
Refers to Subordinate Voting Shares.

 

The information as to Subordinate Voting Shares and Multiple Voting Shares beneficially owned or over which the above-named individuals exercise control or direction is not within the direct knowledge of the Corporation and has been furnished by the respective individuals. The information as to the Principal Board Memberships is also not within the direct knowledge of the Corporation and has been furnished by the respective individuals.
 
With the exception of Mr. Darryl Edwards and Ms. Susan Spradley (as disclosed below), none of the individuals who are proposed to be nominated at the Meeting for election as a director of the Corporation:
 
(a)
is, as at the date hereof, or has been, within 10 years before the date hereof, a director, chief executive officer or chief financial officer of any company that (i) was subject to an order that was issued while such individual was acting in the capacity as director, chief executive officer or chief financial officer, or (ii) was subject to an order that was issued after such individual ceased to be a director, chief executive officer or chief financial officer and which resulted from an event that occurred while that person was acting in the capacity as director, chief executive officer or chief financial officer;
 
(b)
is, as at the date hereof, or has been within 10 years before the date hereof, a director or executive officer of any company that, while such individual was acting in that capacity, or within a year of that individual ceasing to act in that capacity, became bankrupt, made a proposal under any legislation relating to bankruptcy or insolvency or was subject to or instituted any proceedings, arrangement or compromise with creditors or had a receiver, receiver manager or trustee appointed to hold its assets;
 
(c)
has, within the 10 years before the date hereof, become bankrupt, made a proposal under any legislation relating to bankruptcy or insolvency, or become subject to or instituted any proceedings, arrangement or compromise with creditors, or had a receiver, receiver manager or trustee appointed to hold his assets; or
 
(d)  
has been subject to (i) any penalties or sanctions imposed by a court relating to securities legislation or by a securities regulatory authority or has entered into a settlement agreement with a securities regulatory authority, or (ii) any other penalties or sanctions imposed by a court or regulatory body that would likely be considered important to a reasonable security holder in deciding whether to vote for such individual.
 
Mr. Darryl Edwards acted as an executive officer of Nortel Networks Corporation ("Nortel") and its affiliates from 2001 to 2009, most recently acting as President of Global Carrier Sales of Nortel in 2009 and as President, EMEA sales of Nortel from 2006 to 2009. Ms. Susan Spradley acted as an executive officer of Nortel and its affiliates from 1997 to 2005, most recently acting as President of Global Services and Operations of Nortel from 2004 to 2005. Nortel and certain of its affiliates filed for bankruptcy protection in a number of jurisdictions in January 2009.
 
During the fiscal year ended August 31, 2010 and as at November 1, 2011, the Board met a total of eight (8) times. Each member attended all meetings except Mr. Pierre Marcouiller and Mr. André Tremblay who were absent one time.
 
Committees of the Board of Directors
 
Our Board of Directors has established an audit committee, a human resources committee and a disclosure committee.
 


Our audit committee will recommend a firm to be appointed as independent auditors to audit financial statements and to perform services related to the audit, review the scope and results of the audit with the independent auditors, review with management and the independent auditors our annual operating results and consider the adequacy of the internal accounting procedures and the effect of the procedures relating to the auditors’ independence. Further to changes to NASDAQ corporate governance rules and Securities and Exchange rules flowing from the adoption of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, our audit committee charter is being revised every financial year to ensure that we comply with all new requirements. Accordingly, in March 2005, the Board updated and adopted an Audit Committee Charter. A copy of this Audit Committee Charter has been filed as Exhibit 11.5 to our fiscal year 2011 Annual Report on Form 20-F and is also readily available from EXFO’s website at www.EXFO.com. The audit committee revised such Charter in October 2011 but no amendment was required. As at November 1, 2011, the audit committee is composed of six independent Directors: Pierre-Paul Allard, Darryl Edwards, Pierre Marcouiller, Guy Marier, Susan Louise Spradley and David A. Thompson. The chairperson of the audit committee is Guy Marier.
 
During the fiscal year ended August 31, 2011and as at November 1, 2011, the Audit Committee met a total of five (5) times. Each member attended all meetings except Mr. Pierre-Paul Allard who was absent one time.
 
Our human resources committee will evaluate, review and supervise our procedures with regards to human resources and will assess the performance of our executive officers and the chief executive officer. This committee will also review annually the remuneration of the Directors and will recommend to the Board of Directors general remuneration policies regarding salaries, bonuses and other forms of remuneration for our Directors, executive officers and employees as a whole. Finally, the human resources committee will review our organizational structure annually and the development and maintenance of a succession plan. Accordingly, in March 2005, the Board updated and adopted a Human Resources Committee Charter which integrates the Compensation Committee Charter and the Nominating and Governance Committee Charter. A copy of this Human Resources Committee Charter has been filed as Exhibit 11.6 to our fiscal year 2010 Annual Report on Form 20-F and is also readily available from EXFO’s website at www.EXFO.com. As at November 1, 2011, the human resources committee is composed of six (6) independent Directors: Pierre-Paul Allard, Darryl Edwards, Pierre Marcouiller, Guy Marier, Susan Louise Spradley and David A. Thompson. The chairperson of the Human Resources Committee is Mr. Guy Marier.
 
During the fiscal year ended August 31, 2011 and as at November 1, 2011, the Human Resources committee met a total of five (5) times and all members attended all meetings.
 
The disclosure committee is responsible for overseeing our disclosure practices. This committee consists of the chief executive officer, the chief financial officer, the manager of investor relations, the manager of financial reporting and accounting as well as our general counsel and corporate secretary.
 
Furthermore, our independent Directors hold regularly scheduled meetings at which non-independent directors and members of management are not in attendance. The independent Directors hold as many meetings, as needed, annually and any Director may request such meeting at any time. During the fiscal year ended August 31, 2010 and as at November 1, 2011, seven (7) meetings of independent Directors without management occurred and all members attended all meetings except Mr. Pierre-Paul Allard and Mr. André Tremblay who were absent one time. In June 2011, an Independent Members Committee Charter was adopted. A copy of this Independent Members Committee Charter has been filed as Exhibit 11.9 to our fiscal year 2011 Annual Report on Form 20-F.
 


REPORT ON CORPORATE GOVERNANCE PRACTICES
 
 Corporate Governance Developments in Canada
 
In January 2004,  the Canadian  Securities  Administrators  (the “CSA”) adopted Multilateral Instrument 52-110—Audit Committees, which was amended as of January 1, 2011 (“MI 52-110”). MI 52-110 sets forth certain requirements regarding Audit Committee composition and responsibilities, as well as reporting obligations with respect to audit-related matters. The disclosure of the MI 52-110 requirements is included in this Annual Report under Exhibit 11.5 (Audit Committee Charter), Items 6.A (Directors and Senior Management) and 16.C (Audit Committee Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures and Principal Accountant Fees and Services) available as described below. For the composition of the Audit committee, refer to the table provided under heading “Nominees for Election as Directors and their Beneficial Ownership of Voting Securities”.
 
Effective June 30, 2005, the CSA also adopted National Instrument 58-101—Disclosure of Corporate Governance Practices (“NI 58-101”) and National Policy 58-201—Effective Corporate Governance (“NP 58-201” and, together with MI 52-110, the “CSA Corporate Governance Standards”). NP 58-201 provides guidance to Canadian issuers with respect to corporate governance practices, while NI 58-101 requires issuers to make certain disclosures regarding their governance practices. The CSA Corporate Governance Standards, particularly NI 58-101 and NP 58-201, have replaced the former guidelines of the Toronto Stock Exchange that had, prior to the coming into force of the CSA Corporate Governance Standards, served as the primary source of codified recommendations in respect of corporate governance practices in Canada.
 
 Corporate Governance Practices
 
In accordance with NI 58-101, we are required to disclose information with respect to our system of corporate governance. Over the past few years, we have undertaken a comprehensive review of our corporate governance practices in order to best comply with and, whenever practicable, exceed the CSA Standards.
 
We adopted in March 2005 and are updating on a regular basis a number of charters and policies, including an Audit Committee Charter; a Board of Directors Corporate Governance Guidelines, a Code of Ethics for our Principal Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers, a Disclosure Guidelines, an Ethics and Business Conduct Policy, a Human Resources Committee Charter, a Securities Trading Policy and a Statement on Reporting Ethical Violations (Whistle Blower). We adopted in October 2006 a policy regarding Hiring Employees and Former Employees of Independent Auditor. We adopted in June 2011 an Independent Members Committee Charter. We also adopted in October 2011 a majority voting policy for the election of our Directors. We are also implementing best practices such as, Best Practice regarding the Granting date of Stock Incentive Compensation and the establishment of Guidelines regarding the filing and disclosure of material contracts. We refer to our Board of Directors and Committee Charters as our “Corporate Governance Rules”.
 
We are of the view that adopting and implementing good corporate governance practices is a cornerstone of our corporate and management practices and policies and that our existing corporate governance practices already meet the prevailing corporate governance standards. We further believe that the measures we have adopted with respect to corporate governance comply substantially with the CSA Standards.
 
We encourage our shareholders to consult our Corporate Governance Rules and Ethics and Business Conduct Policy available on our website at www.EXFO.com and also available in print to any shareholder who requests copies by contacting our Corporate Secretary.
 
We are dedicated to updating our corporate governance practices on an ongoing basis in order to respond to the evolution of best practices. We and our Board of Directors are of the view that our corporate governance practices, as summarized in the Exhibit 11.7 filed to this Annual Report, are in substantial compliance with the CSA Corporate Governance Standards.
 

 
 D.  Employees
 
We have fostered a corporate culture where growth and change are strongly encouraged. In fact, employees are constantly evolving with the rapid pace of technology to meet new challenges and realities. We believe that we possess a good cross-section of experience and youth to handle these inevitable changes in the industry.
 
As of November 1, 2011, we had a total of 1,752 employees, up from a total of 1,656 on November 1, 2010. We have 759 employees in Canada, primarily based in Quebec, and 993 employees based outside of Canada. 818 are involved in research and development, 365 in manufacturing, 309 in sales and marketing, 128 in general administrative positions and 132 in communications and customer support. We have agreements with almost all of our employees covering confidentiality and non-competition. Only our 126 manufacturing employees based in Quebec City plants are represented by a collective bargaining agreement through “Syndicat des employé(e)s d’EXFO”. We have never experienced a work stoppage. We believe that relations with our employees and bargaining unit are good.
 
 
 E.  Share Ownership
 
The following table presents information regarding the ownership of Subordinate Voting Shares, Exercisable “in-the-money” and “out-the-money” options and the beneficial ownership of our share capital as at November 1, 2011 by our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, our Directors, our three other most highly compensated executive officers, our other executive officers as a group, all of our Directors and executive officers as a group.
 
Each multiple voting share is convertible at the option of the holder into one subordinate voting share. Holders of our subordinate voting shares are entitled to one (1) vote per share and holders of our multiple voting shares are entitled to ten (10) votes per share.
 
Name
Subordinate Voting
Shares Owned
Currently Exercisable Options Owned
as at November 1, 2011
Total Subordinate
Voting Shares
Beneficially Owned (3)
Multiple Voting
Shares Beneficially
Owned (3)
Total Percentage
of Voting Power
In-the-money (1)
Out-the-money (2)
Number
Percent
Number
Percent
Number
Percent
Number
Percent
Number
Percent
Percent
   Germain Lamonde
       4,090,588   (4)
14.21
79,160
17.54
*
4,169,748
14.45
       31,643,000   (5)
100
92.85
   Pierre Plamondon
            59,889   (6)
*
3,653
*
5,383
1.19
68,925
*
                      –
*
   Pierre-Paul Allard
            8,000
*
*
*
8,000
*
                      –
*
   Darryl Edwards
        –
*
*
*
*
                      –
*
   Pierre Marcouiller
            5,000
*
*
1,037
*
6,037
*
                      –
*
   Guy Marier
            1,000
*
*
12,500
2.77
13,500
*
                      –
*
   Susan Spradley
        –
*
*
*
*
                      –
*
   David A. Thompson
            2,100
*
12,500
2.77
*
14,600
*
                      –
*
   Jon Bradley
        –
*
*
1,000
*
1,000
*
                      –
*
   Vivian Hudson
        –
*
*
*
*
                      –
*
   Dana Yearian
            3,137
*
*
*
3,137
*
                      –
*
   Other executive
   officers as a group
           
            54,113
 
*
 
17,228
 
3.82
 
3,230
 
*
 
74,571
 
*
 
                      –
 
 
*
   All of our Directors
   and executive
   officers as a group
 
 
       4,223,827
 
 
14.67
 
 
112,541
 
 
24.94
 
 
23,150
 
 
5.13
 
 
4,359,518
 
 
15,07
 
 
       31,643,000
 
 
100
 
 
92.89
                       
                       
*
Less than 1%.
(1)
“In-the-money” options are options for which the market value of the underlying securities is higher than the exercise price at which such securities may be bought from the Corporation. As at November 1, 2011 the market value of a Subordinate Voting Share was US$5.87 or CA$6.04, as applicable.
(2)
“Out-the-money” options are options for which the market value of the underlying securities is lower than the price of which such securities may be bought from the Corporation.
 
 
 
104

 
 
(3)
Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the SEC and generally includes voting or investment power with respect to securities. Options that are currently exercisable or exercisable within sixty (60) days as at November 1, 2011 (including options that have an exercise price above the market price) are deemed to be outstanding and to be beneficially owned by the person holding such options for the purpose of computing the percentage ownership of such person, but are not treated as outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage ownership of any other person. Accordingly, DSUs and RSUs are not included.
(4)
The number of shares held by Germain Lamonde includes 4,000,000 subordinate voting shares held of record by G. Lamonde Investissements financiers inc.
(5)
The number of shares held by Germain Lamonde includes 1,900,000 multiple voting shares held of record by Fiducie Germain Lamonde and 29,743,000 multiple voting shares held of record by G. Lamonde Investissements Financiers inc.
(6)
The number of shares held by Pierre Plamondon includes 6,874 subordinate voting shares held of record by Fiducie Pierre Plamondon.
 
The following table presents information regarding stock options held as of November 1, 2011 by our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, our Directors, our three other most highly compensated executive officers and our other executive officers as a group.
 
Name
Securities Under Options
Granted (1) (#)
Exercise Price (2)
(US$/Security)
Expiration Date
   Germain Lamonde
50,000
17,942
11,218
$1.58
$4.51
$4.76
September 25, 2012
February 1, 2015
December 6, 2015
   Pierre Plamondon
5,383
3,653
$5.13
$4.76
October 26, 2014
December 6, 2015
   Pierre-Paul Allard
   Darryl Edwards
   Pierre Marcouiller
1,037
$12.69
December 1, 2011
   Guy Marier
12,500
$4.65
March 24, 2014
   Susan Spradley
   David A. Thompson
12,500
$3.51
October 27, 2013
   Jon Bradley
1,000
$12.22
January 3, 2012
   Vivian Hudson
   Dana Yearian
   Other Executive Officers as a group
15,000
3,230
2,228
$1.58
$5.13
$4.76
September 25, 2012
October 26, 2014
December 6, 2015
       
       
(1)
Underlying securities: subordinate voting shares
(2)
The exercise price of options granted is determined based on the highest of the closing prices of the subordinate voting shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars, as required.
 
The following table presents information regarding Deferred Share Units and Restricted Share Units held by our Chief Executive Officer, our Chief Financial Officer, our Directors, our three other most highly compensated executive officers, our other executive officers as a group, all of our Directors and executive officers as a group, as at November 1, 2011.
 
Name
DSUs
RSUs
Number
Percentage
Estimated Average Value at the time of grant US$/DSU (1)
Number
Percentage
Fair Value at the
time of grant
US$/RSU (2)
   Germain Lamonde
           –
                20,115(3)
1.30%
6.28
 
           –
                44,374(4)
2.86%
2.36
 
           –
                66,081(5)
4.26%
3.74
 
           –
                45,089(6)
2.91%
6.03
 
           –
                53,261(7)
3.43%
5.43
   Pierre Plamondon
           –
                 6,481      (3)
0.42%
6.28
 
           –
                14,039(4)
0.91%
2.36
 
           –
                20,339(8)
1.31%
2.36
 
           –
                16,794(5)
1.08%
3.74
 
           –
                13,019(6)
0.84%
6.03
 
           –
                 8,857      (9)
0.57%
6.03
 
           –
                17,325(7)
1.12%
5.43
 
 
 
105

 
 
Name
DSUs
RSUs
Number
Percentage
Estimated Average Value at the time of grant US$/DSU (1)
Number
Percentage
Fair Value at the
time of grant
US$/RSU (2)
   Pierre-Paul Allard
            16,270    (10)
14.7%
4.61
             –
 –
   Darryl Edwards
          –
             –
 –
   Pierre Marcouiller
            31,942    (10)
29.0%
5.02
             –
 –
   Guy Marier
            31,942    (10)
29.0%
5.02
             –
 –
   Susan Spradley
          –
             –
 –
   David A. Thompson
            30,144    (10)
27.3%
4.97
             –
 –
   Jon Bradley
          –
                 4,117      (3)
0.27%
6.28
 
          –
                11,443(4)
0.74%
2.36
 
          –
                25,416(8)
1.64%
2.36
 
          –
                10,367(5)
0.67%
3.74
 
          –
                 8,443      (6)
0.54%
6.03
 
          –
                 8,857      (9)
0.57%
6.03
 
          –
                11,255(7)
0.73%
5.43
   Vivian Hudson
          –
                 9,798      (4)
0.63%
2.36
 
          –
                12,977(5)
0.84%
3.74
 
          –
                10,252(6)
0.66%
6.03
 
          –
                11,272(9)
0.73%
6.03
 
          –
                 6,297      (11)
0.41%
8.28
 
          –
                13,972(7)
0.90%
5.43
   Dana Yearian
          –
                 4,859      (3)
0.31%
6.28
 
          –
                15,690(4)
1.01%
2.36
 
          –
                25,424(8)
1.64%
2.36
 
          –
                15,241(5)
0.98%
3.74
 
          –
                11,609(6)
0.75%
6.03
 
          –
                 8,857      (9)
0.57%
6.03
 
          –
                15,322(7)
0.99%
5.43
   Other executive officers as a group
          –
                14,292(3)
0.92%
6.28
          –
               875      (12)
0.06%
4.16
          –
                33,031(4)
2.13%
2.36
 
          –
                54,236(8)
3.50%
2.36
 
          –
                 5,000      (13)
0.32%
3.22
 
         –
                39,302(5)
2.53%
3.74
 
         –
                 3,200      (14)
0.21%
5.13
 
         –
                 3,759      (15)
0.24%
5.32
 
         –
                 9,565      (16)
0.62%
5.32
 
         –
                39,936(6)
2.58%
6.03
 
         –
                17,713(9)
1.14%
6.03
 
         –
                 2,300      (17)
0.15%
9.32
 
         –
                 8,226      (11)
0.53%
8.64
 
         –
                52,516(7)
3.39%
5.43
   All of the directors and executive
   officers as a group
          –
                49,864(3)
3.22%
6.28
          –
               875      (12)
0.06%
4.16
          –
              128,375(4)
8.28%
2.36
 
          –
              125,415(8)
8.09%
2.36
 
          –
                 5,000      (13)
0.32%
3.22
 
         –
              160,762(5)
10.37%
3.74
 
         –
                 3,200      (14)
0.21%
5.13
 
         –
                 3,759      (15)
0.24%
5.32
 
          –
                 9,565      (16)
0.62%
5.32
 
          –
              128,348(6)
8.28%
6.03
 
          –
                55,556(9)
3.58%
6.03
 
          –
                 2,300      (17)
0.15%
9.32
 
          –
                 6,297      (11)
0.41%
5.68
 
          –
                 8,226      (11)
0.53%
8.64
 
          –
              163,651(7)
10.55%
5.43
   Total
          110,298
100%
4.94
            3851,193
54.89%
4.40
             
             
(1)  
The estimated average value at the time of grant of a DSU is the average of the estimated value at the time of grant of a DSU which is determined based on the highest of the closing prices of the Subordinate Voting Shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange and the NASDAQ National Market on the last trading day preceding the grant date, using the noon buying rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of New York (for grants of DSUs prior to January 1, 2009) or the Bank of Canada (for grants of DSUs on or after January 1, 2009) on the grant date to convert the NASDAQ National Market closing price to Canadian dollars, as required. The value at vesting of a DSU is equivalent to the market value of a Subordinate Voting Share when a DSU is converted to such Subordinate Voting Share.
(2)  
The fair value at the time of grant of a RSU is equal to the market value of Subordinate Voting Shares at the time RSUs are granted.
 
 

(3)  
Those RSUs will vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant in October 2007 but are subject to early vesting on the third and fourth anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives as determined by the Board of Directors. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the first early vesting is up to 1/3 of the units on the third anniversary date of the grant and the second early vesting is up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant.
(4)  
Those RSUs will vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant in October 2008 but are subject to early vesting on the third and fourth anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives as determined by the Board of Directors. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the first early vesting is up to 1/3 of the units on the third anniversary date of the grant and the second early vesting is up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant.
(5)  
Those RSUs will vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant in October 2009 but are subject to early vesting on the third and fourth anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives as determined by the Board of Directors. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the first early vesting is up to 1/3 of the units on the third anniversary date of the grant and the second early vesting is up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant.
(6)  
Those RSUs will vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant in October 2010 but are subject to early vesting on the third and fourth anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives as determined by the Board of Directors. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the first early vesting is up to 1/3 of the units on the third anniversary date of the grant and the second early vesting is up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant.
(7)  
Those RSUs will vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant in October 2011 but are subject to early vesting on the third and fourth anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives as determined by the Board of Directors. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the first early vesting is up to 1/3 of the units on the third anniversary date of the grant and the second early vesting is up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant.
(8)  
Those RSUs will vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant in October 2008 but are subject to early vesting on the third anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives as determined by the Board of Directors. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the early vesting is up to 100% of the units on the third anniversary date of the grant.
(9)  
Those RSUs will vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant in October 2010 but are subject to early vesting on the third or fourth anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives as determined by the Board of Directors. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the early vesting is up to 100% of the units on the third or fourth anniversary date of the grant.
(10)  
Those DSUs will vest at the time Director ceases to be a member of the Board of the Corporation.
(11)  
Those RSUs will vest at a rate of 1/2 annually commencing on the third anniversary date of the grant in April 2011.
(12)  
Those RSUs will vest at a rate of 1/2 annually commencing on the third anniversary date of the grant in January 2008.
(13)  
Those RSUs will vest at a rate of 1/2 annually commencing on the third anniversary date of the grant in January 2009.
(14)  
Those RSUs will vest at a rate of 1/2 annually commencing on the third anniversary date of the grant in January 2010.
(15)  
Those RSUs will vest at a rate of 1/3 annually commencing on the third anniversary date of the grant in July 2010.
(16)  
Those RSUs will vest on the fifth anniversary date of the grant in July 2010 but are subject to early vesting on the third and fourth anniversary date of the grant on the attainment of performance objectives as determined by the Board of Directors. Accordingly, subject to the attainment of performance objectives, the first early vesting is up to 1/3 of the units on the third anniversary date of the grant and the second early vesting is up to 50% of the remaining units on the fourth anniversary date of the grant.
(17)  
Those RSUs will vest at a rate of 1/2 annually commencing on the third anniversary date of the grant in January 2011.
 
 
Escrowed Securities
 
To our knowledge as at November 1, 2011, none of the equity securities of the Company were held in escrow.
 
 
 
Item 7.  
Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions
 
 A.  Major Shareholders
 
The following table presents information regarding the beneficial ownership of our share capital as at November 1, 2011 by persons or groups of affiliated persons known by us to own more than 5% of our voting shares.
 
   
Multiple Voting Shares
Beneficially Owned (1)
   
Subordinate Voting Shares
Beneficially Owned (1)
   
Total Percentage of Voting Power
 
                   
Name
 
Number
   
Percent
   
Number
   
Percent
   
Percent
 
                               
Germain Lamonde (2)
    31,643,000       100 %     4,090,588       14.21 %     92.85 %
Fiducie Germain Lamonde (3)
    1,900,000       6 %                 5.50 %
G. Lamonde Investissements Financiers inc. (4)
    29,743,000       94 %     4,000,000       13.90 %     86.16 %
EdgePoint Investment Group, Inc.
                2,891,500       10.05 %     *  
Brown Investment Advisory, Inc.
                1,558,333       5.41 %     *  
       
       
*
Less than 1%
(1)
Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the SEC and generally includes voting or investment power with respect to securities. Options that are currently exercisable within 60 days of November 1, 2011 (including options that have an exercise price above the market price) are deemed to be outstanding and to be beneficially owned by the person holding such options for the purpose of computing the percentage ownership of such person, but are not treated as outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage ownership of any other person.
(2)  
The number of shares held by Germain Lamonde includes 1,900,000 multiple voting shares held of record by Fiducie Germain Lamonde, 29,743,000 multiple voting shares held of record by G. Lamonde Investissements Financiers inc. and 4,000,000 subordinate voting shares held of record by G. Lamonde Investissements Financiers inc.
(3)  
Fiducie Germain Lamonde is a family trust for the benefit of Mr. Lamonde and members of his family.
(4)  
G. Lamonde Investissements Financiers inc. is a company controlled by Mr. Lamonde.
 
Each multiple voting share is convertible at the option of the holder into one subordinate voting share. Holders of our subordinate voting shares are entitled to one vote per share and holders of our multiple voting shares are entitled to ten votes per share.
 
During the last three years, Mr. Lamonde and his related companies have maintained majority ownership of EXFO. Mr. Lamonde converted five million multiple voting shares into subordinate voting shares in fiscal 2011 and sold one million of those subordinate voting shares on the open market.  (Only subordinate voting shares can be traded on open market). EdgePoint Investment Group has been EXFO’s second-largest shareholder during the last two years, holding more than 10% of the company’s subordinate voting shares. Brown Investment Advisory purchased more than 1.6 million (5%) of EXFO’s subordinate voting shares in fiscal 2011 to become the company’s third-largest shareholder, while Empire Financial Group and Renaissance Technologies LLC no longer hold more than 5% of EXFO’s subordinate voting shares.
 
As at November 14, 2011, 28,781,111 subordinate voting shares were outstanding. Approximately 98.2% (28,252,910) of our subordinate voting shares were held in bearer form and the remainder (528,201 subordinate voting shares) was held by 218 record holders. As at November 14, 2011, we believe approximately 61.22% of our outstanding subordinate voting shares were held in the United States.
 

 
 B.  Related Party Transactions
 
 Indebtedness of Directors, Executive Officers and Employees
 
As of September 1, 2011 until the date of this Annual Report, none of our directors, executive officers, associates or affiliates had any material interest in any transaction with us or in any proposed transaction which has materially affected or could materially affect us.
 
 
 C.  Interests of Experts and Counsel
 
Not applicable.
 

 
Item 8.  
Financial Information
 
 A.  Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information
 
See Item 18, “Financial Statements” for certain other information required by this item.
 
Valuation and qualifying accounts are as follows (in thousands of US dollars):
 
Valuation allowance on future income tax assets
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Balance – Beginning of year
  $ 21,277     $ 15,458     $ 14,393  
Change charged to earnings
    5,049       3,185       777  
Change in tax rates
                366  
Business combination/disposal
    6,823       3,065        
Foreign currency translation adjustment
    1,367       (431 )     (78 )
                         
Balance – End of year
  $ 34,516     $ 21,277     $ 15,458  
 
Export Sales
 
Export and domestic sales in thousands of US dollars and as a percentage of sales are as follows:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                                     
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                                     
Export Sales
  $ 238,757       89 %   $ 184,479       91 %   $ 135,751       89 %
Domestic Sales
    30,986       11       18,278       9       17,331       11  
                                                 
    $ 269,743       100 %   $ 202,757       100 %   $ 153,082       100 %
 
Legal Proceedings
 
On November 27, 2001, a class action suit was filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York against the company, four of the underwriters of its Initial Public Offering and some of its executive officers pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and Rule 10b-5 promulgated thereunder and Sections 11, 12 and 16 of the Securities Act of 1933. This class action alleges that the company’s registration statement and prospectus filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 29, 2000, contained material misrepresentations and/or omissions resulting from (i) the underwriters allegedly soliciting and receiving additional, excessive and undisclosed commissions from certain investors in exchange for which they allocated material portions of the shares issued in connection with the company’s Initial Public Offering; and (ii) the underwriters allegedly entering into agreements with customers whereby shares issued in connection with the company’s Initial Public Offering would be allocated to those customers in exchange for which customers agreed to purchase additional amounts of shares in the after-market at predetermined prices.
 

 
On April 19, 2002, the plaintiffs filed an amended complaint containing master allegations against all of the defendants in all of the 310 cases included in this class action and also filed an amended complaint containing allegations specific to four of the company’s underwriters, the company and two of its executive officers. In addition to the allegations mentioned above, the amended complaint alleges that the underwriters (i) used their analysts to manipulate the stock market; and (ii) implemented schemes that allowed issuer insiders to sell their shares rapidly after an initial public offering and benefit from high market prices. As concerns the company and its two executive officers in particular, the amended complaint alleges that (i) the company’s registration statement was materially false and misleading because it failed to disclose the additional commissions and compensation to be received by underwriters; (ii) the two named executive officers learned of or recklessly disregarded the alleged misconduct of the underwriters; (iii) the two named executive officers had motive and opportunity to engage in alleged wrongful conduct due to personal holdings of the company’s stock and the fact that an alleged artificially inflated stock price could be used as currency for acquisitions; and (iv) the two named executive officers, by virtue of their positions with the company, controlled the company and the contents of the registration statement and had the ability to prevent its issuance or cause it to be corrected. The plaintiffs in this suit seek an unspecified amount for damages suffered.
 
In July 2002, the issuers filed a motion to dismiss the plaintiffs’ amended complaint and a decision was rendered on February 19, 2003. Only one of the claims against the company was dismissed. On October 8, 2002, the claims against its officers were dismissed, without prejudice, pursuant to the terms of Reservation of Rights and Tolling Agreements entered into with the plaintiffs (the “Tolling Agreements”). Subsequent addenda to the Tolling Agreements extended the tolling period through August 27, 2010.
 
In June 2004, an agreement of partial settlement was submitted to the court for preliminary approval. The proposed partial settlement was between the plaintiffs, the issuer defendants in the consolidated actions, the issuer officers and directors named as defendants, and the issuers’ insurance companies. The court granted the preliminary approval motion on February 15, 2005, subject to certain modifications. On August 31, 2005, the court issued a preliminary order further approving the modifications to the settlement and certifying the settlement classes. The court also appointed the notice administrator for the settlement and ordered that notice of the settlement be distributed to all settlement class members by January 15, 2006. The settlement fairness hearing occurred on April 24, 2006, and the court reserved decision at that time.
 
While the partial settlement was pending approval, the plaintiffs continued to litigate against the underwriter defendants. The district court directed that the litigation proceed within a number of “focus cases” rather than in all of the 310 cases that have been consolidated. The company's case is not one of these focus cases. On October 13, 2004, the district court certified the focus cases as class actions. The underwriter defendants appealed that ruling, and on December 5, 2006, the Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit reversed the district court’s class certification decision.
 
On April 6, 2007, the Second Circuit denied the plaintiffs’ petition for rehearing of that decision and, on May 18, 2007, the Second Circuit denied the plaintiffs’ petition for rehearing en banc. In light of the Second Circuit’s opinion, liaison counsel for all issuer defendants, including the company, informed the court that this settlement cannot be approved, because the defined settlement class, like the litigation class, cannot be certified. On June 25, 2007, the district court entered an order terminating the settlement agreement. On August 14, 2007, the plaintiffs filed their second consolidated amended class action complaints against the focus cases and, on September 27, 2007, again moved for class certification. On November 12, 2007, certain defendants in the focus cases moved to dismiss the second consolidated amended class action complaints. On March 26, 2008, the district court denied the motions to dismiss, except as to Section 11 claims raised by those plaintiffs who sold their securities for a price in excess of the initial offering price and those who purchased outside of the previously certified class period. Briefing on the class certification motion was completed in May 2008. That motion was withdrawn without prejudice on October 10, 2008.
 

 
On April 2, 2009, a stipulation and agreement of settlement between the plaintiffs, issuer defendants and underwriter defendants was submitted to the Court for preliminary approval. The Court granted the plaintiffs’ motion for preliminary approval and preliminarily certified the settlement classes on June 10, 2009. The settlement fairness hearing was held on September 10, 2009. On October 6, 2009, the Court entered an opinion granting final approval to the settlement and directing that the Clerk of the Court close these actions. On August 26, 2010, based on the expiration of the tolling period stated in the Tolling Agreements, the plaintiffs filed a Notice of Termination of Tolling Agreement and Recommencement of Litigation against the two named executive officers. The plaintiffs stated to the Court that they do not intend to take any further action against the named executive officers at this time. Appeals of the opinion granting final approval were filed, all of which were disposed of except the appeals filed by one objector were remanded to the district court to determine standing to appeal. On August 25, 2011, the district court issued an order holding that the final objector had no standing to appeal.  The objector has appealed that decision.  Given that the district court’s August 25, 2011 remains subject to appeal, the ultimate outcome of the contingency is uncertain. However, based on the settlement approved on October 6, 2009, and the related insurance against such claims, management has determined the impact to its financial position and results of operations as at and for the year ended August 31, 2011 to be immaterial.
 
There are no other legal or arbitration proceedings pending or threatened of which we are aware which may have or have had a significant effect on our financial position.
 
Dividend Policy
 
We do not currently anticipate paying dividends for at least the next three years. Our current intention is to reinvest any earnings in our business long-term growth. Any future determination by us to pay dividends will be at the discretion of our Board of Directors and in accordance with the terms and conditions of any outstanding indebtedness and will depend on our financial condition, results of operations, capital requirements and such other functions as our Board of Directors considers relevant.
 
 
 B.  Significant changes
 
No significant changes occurred since the date of our annual consolidated financial statements.
 

 
Item 9.  
The Offer and Listing
 
Not Applicable, except for Item 9A (4) and Item 9C.
 
 A.  Offer and Listing Details
 
   
NASDAQ (US$)
   
TSX (CA$)
 
   
High
   
Low
   
High
   
Low
 
                         
September 1, 2006 to August 31, 2007
    7.57       4.89       8.85       5.55  
September 1, 2007 to August 31, 2008
    7.28       3.92       7.35       3.97  
September 1, 2008 to August 31, 2009
    4.73       2.13       5.16       2.50  
September 1, 2009 to August 31, 2010
    6.59       2.81       6.70       3.10  
September 1, 2010 to August 31, 2011
    12.96       5.28       12.56       5.50  
                                 
2010 1st Quarter
    3.85       2.81       4.13       3.10  
2010 2nd Quarter
    6.00       3.65       6.25       3.82  
2010 3rd Quarter
    6.59       4.79       6.70       5.12  
2010 4th Quarter
    5.99       4.95       6.15       5.25  
                                 
2011 1st Quarter
    6.35       5.28       6.44       5.50  
2011 2nd Quarter
    11.90       6.19       11.83       6.31  
2011 3rd Quarter
    12.96       7.89       12.56       7.61  
2011 4th Quarter
    9.47       5.90       9.27       5.85  
                                 
2011 May
    10.10       8.42       9.66       8.50  
2011 June
    9.47       7.44       9.27       7.22  
2011 July
    8.18       7.26       7.89       6.94  
2011 August
    7.67       5.90       7.52       5.85  
2011 September
    8.23       6.13       8.24       6.40  
2011 October
    6.21       5.42       6.18       5.51  
2011 November
    6.27       5.60       6.34       5.72  
(until November 14)
                               
 
 
 C.  Markets
 
Our subordinate voting shares have been quoted on the NASDAQ National Market under the symbol EXFO and listed on The Toronto Stock Exchange under the symbol EXF since our initial public offering on June 29, 2000. Prior to that time, there was no public market for our subordinate voting shares. The table above sets forth, for the periods indicated, the high and low closing sales prices per subordinate voting share as reported on the NASDAQ National Market and the Toronto Stock Exchange.
 
On November 14, 2011, the last reported sale price for our subordinate voting shares on the NASDAQ National Market was US$5.89 per share and the last reported sale price for our subordinate voting shares on the Toronto Stock Exchange was CA$6.10 per share.
 
 
 
Item 10.  
Additional Information
 
 A.  Share Capital
 
Not Applicable
 
 
 B.  Memorandum and Articles of Association
 
Our Amended Articles of Incorporation and By-laws are incorporated by reference to our registration statement on Form F-1 dated June 9, 2000 (File No. 333-38956) and amendments to our Articles by reference to Exhibit 1.4 to our fiscal year 2009 Annual Report on Form 20-F and Exhibit 1.5 to our fiscal year 2010 Annual Report on Form 20-F.
 
 
 C.  Material Contracts
 
Except as otherwise disclosed in this Annual Report and our consolidated financial statements and notes included elsewhere in this Annual Report, we have no other material contracts.
 
 
 D.  Exchange Controls
 
Subject to the following paragraph, there is no law or governmental decree or regulation in Canada that restricts the export or import of capital, or affects the remittance of dividends, interest or other payments to non-resident holders of our subordinate voting shares, other than withholding tax requirements.
 
There is no limitation imposed by Canadian law or by our articles of incorporation or our other charter documents on the right of a non-resident to hold or vote subordinate voting shares, other than as provided by the Investment Canada Act, the North American Free Trade Agreement Implementation Act (Canada) and the World Trade Organization Agreement Implementation Act. The Investment Canada Act requires notification and, in certain cases, advance review and approval by the Government of Canada of an investment to establish a new Canadian business by a non-Canadian or of the acquisition by a “non-Canadian” of “control” of a “Canadian business”, all as defined in the Investment Canada Act. Generally, the threshold for review will be higher in monetary terms for a member of the World Trade Organization or North American Free Trade Agreement.
 
 
 E.  Taxation
 
United States Taxation
 
The information set forth below under the caption “United States Taxation” is a summary of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of subordinate voting shares by a U.S. Holder, as defined below. These discussions are not a complete analysis or listing of all of the possible tax consequences of such transactions and do not address all tax considerations that may be relevant to particular holders in light of their personal circumstances or to persons that are subject to special tax rules. In particular, the information set forth under the caption “United States Taxation” deals only with U.S. Holders that hold subordinate voting shares as capital assets within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), and who do not at any time own individually, nor are treated as owning, 10% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of our stock entitled to vote. In addition, this description of U.S. tax consequences does not address the tax treatment of special classes of U.S. Holders, such as financial institutions, regulated investment companies, traders in securities who elect to mark-to-market their securities, tax-exempt entities, insurance companies, partnerships, persons holding subordinate voting shares as part of a hedging, integrated or conversion transaction or as part of a “straddle,” U.S. expatriates, persons subject to the alternative minimum tax, persons who acquired their subordinate voting shares through the exercise or cancellation of employee stock options or otherwise as compensation for services, dealers or traders in securities or currencies and holders whose “functional currency” is not the U.S. dollar. This summary does not address U.S. estate and gift tax consequences or tax consequences under any state and local tax laws or non-U.S. tax laws.
 


As used in this section, the term “U.S. Holder” means a beneficial owner of subordinate voting shares that is for U.S. federal income tax purposes:
 
 
(a)
an individual citizen or resident of the United States;
 
 
(b)
a corporation created or organized under the laws of the United States or any state thereof and the District of Columbia;
 
 
(c)
an estate the income of which is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source;
 
 
(d)
a trust if (1) a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over its administration and one or more U.S. persons as described in Section 7701 (a) (30) of the Code have authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust or (2) the trust has a valid election in effect under applicable U.S. Treasury regulations to be treated as a U.S. person; or
 
 
(e)
any other person whose worldwide income or gain is otherwise subject to U.S. federal income taxation on a net income basis.
 
If a partnership or other flow-through entity holds subordinate voting shares, the U.S. federal income tax treatment of a partner will generally depend upon the status of the partner or other owner and upon the activities of the partnership or other flow-through entity.  If you are a partner of a partnership holding subordinate voting shares, you should consult your tax advisor.
 
Holders of subordinate voting shares who are not U.S. Holders, sometimes referred to as “Non-U.S. Holders”, should also consult their own tax advisors, particularly as to the applicability of any tax treaty.
 
The following discussion is based upon:
 
·  
the Code;
·  
U.S. judicial decisions;
·  
administrative pronouncements;
·  
existing and proposed Treasury regulations; and
·  
the Canada – U.S. Income Tax Treaty.
 
Any of the above is subject to change, possibly with retroactive effect, so as to result in U.S. federal income tax consequences different from those discussed below. We have not requested, and will not request, a ruling from the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) with respect to any of the U.S. federal income tax consequences described below, and as a result, there can be no assurance that the IRS will not disagree with or challenge any of the conclusions we have reached and described here.
 
The following discussion is for general information only and is not intended to be, nor should it be construed to be, legal or tax advice to any holder of subordinate voting shares and no opinion or representation with respect to the U.S. federal income tax consequences to any holder is made.  Holders of subordinate voting shares are urged to consult their tax advisors as to the particular consequences to them under U.S. federal, state, local and applicable non-U.S. tax laws of the acquisition, ownership and disposition of subordinate voting shares.
 


 Dividends
 
Subject to the discussion of passive foreign investment companies below, the gross amount of any distribution paid by us to a U.S. Holder will generally be subject to U.S. federal income tax as foreign source dividend income to the extent paid out of our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles. Such income will be includable in the gross income of a U.S. Holder on the day received by the U.S. Holder.  The amount of any distribution of property other than cash will be the fair market value of such property on the date of the distribution. In the case of a taxable corporate U.S. Holder, such dividends will be taxable as ordinary income and will not be eligible for the corporate dividends received deduction, which is generally allowed to U.S. corporate shareholders on dividends received from a domestic corporation. In the case of a non-corporate U.S. Holder, including individuals, such dividends should generally be eligible for a maximum tax rate of 15% for dividends received before January 1, 2013, provided such holder holds the subordinate voting shares for at least 60 days and certain other conditions are satisfied, including, as we believe to be the case, that we are not a “passive foreign investment company”. For dividends received after December 31, 2012, the tax rate will be 39.6%, subject to possible legislative change. To the extent that an amount received by a U.S. Holder exceeds such holder’s allocable share of our current and accumulated earnings and profits, such excess will be applied first to reduce such U.S. Holder’s tax basis in his subordinate voting shares, thereby increasing the amount of gain or decreasing the amount of loss recognized on a subsequent disposition of the subordinate voting shares. Then, to the extent such distribution exceeds such U.S. Holder’s tax basis, it will be treated as capital gain. We do not currently maintain calculations of our earnings and profits for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
 
The gross amount of distributions paid in Canadian dollars, or any successor or other foreign currency, will be included in the income of such U.S. Holder in a U.S. dollar amount calculated by reference to the spot exchange rate in effect on the day the distributions are paid regardless of whether the payment is in fact converted into U.S. dollars.  If the Canadian dollars, or any successor or other foreign currency, are converted into U.S. dollars on the date of the payment, the U.S. Holder should not be required to recognize any foreign currency gain or loss with respect to the receipt of Canadian dollars as distributions. The U.S. Holder will have a basis in any Canadian dollars or other foreign currency distributed equal to their U.S. dollar value on the payment date.  If, instead, the Canadian dollars are converted at a later date, any currency gains or losses resulting from the conversion of the Canadian dollars will be treated as U.S. source ordinary income or loss. U.S. Holders are urged to consult their own tax advisors concerning the U.S. tax consequences of acquiring, holding and disposing of Canadian dollars.
 
A U.S. Holder may be entitled to deduct, or claim a foreign tax credit for, Canadian taxes that are withheld on dividends received by the U.S. Holder, subject to applicable limitations in the Code. The limitation on foreign taxes eligible for credit is calculated separately with respect to specific classes of income. For this purpose, such dividends should generally constitute foreign source “passive category income” or, in the case of certain U.S. Holders, “general category income”. The rules governing the foreign tax credit are complex, and additional limitations on the credit apply to individuals receiving dividends from non-U.S. corporations if the dividends are eligible for the 15% maximum tax rate on dividends described above.  U.S. Holders are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the availability of the foreign tax credit under their particular circumstances.
 
A Non-U.S. Holder of subordinate voting shares generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax on dividends received on subordinate voting shares unless such income is effectively connected with the conduct by such Non-U.S. Holder of a trade or business in the United States.
 


Sale or Exchange
 
A U.S. Holder’s initial tax basis in the subordinate voting shares will generally be cost to the holder. A U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in the subordinate voting shares will generally be the same as cost, but may differ for various reasons including the receipt by such holder of a distribution that was not made up wholly of earnings and profits as described above under the heading “Dividends.” Subject to the discussion of passive foreign investment companies below, gain or loss realized by a U.S. Holder on the sale or other disposition of subordinate voting shares will be subject to U.S. federal income taxation as capital gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference (if any) between the U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis (determined in U.S. dollars) in the subordinate voting shares and the U.S. dollar value of the amount realized on the disposition of such subordinate voting shares. Capital gains of non-corporate U.S. Holders, including individuals, derived with respect to a sale, exchange or other disposition prior to January 1, 2013 of subordinate voting shares held for more than one year are subject to a maximum federal income tax rate of 15%, and 20% thereafter, subject to possible legislative change. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations. In the case of a non-corporate U.S. Holder, the federal tax rate applicable to capital gains will depend upon:
 
·  
the holder’s holding period for the subordinate voting shares, with a preferential rate available for subordinate voting shares held for more than one year; and
·  
the holder’s marginal tax rate for ordinary income.
 
Any gain realized will generally be treated as U.S. source gain, and loss realized by a U.S. Holder generally also will be treated as from sources within the United States.
 
The ability of a U.S. Holder to utilize foreign taxes as a credit to offset U.S. taxes is subject to complex limitations and conditions. The consequences of the separate limitation calculation will depend upon the nature and sources of each U.S. Holder’s income and the deductions allocable thereto. Alternatively, a U.S. Holder may elect to claim all foreign taxes paid as an itemized deduction in lieu of claiming a foreign tax credit. A deduction does not reduce U.S. tax on a dollar-for-dollar basis like a tax credit, but the availability of the deduction is not subject to the same conditions and limitations applicable to foreign tax credits.
 
If a U.S. Holder receives any foreign currency on the sale of subordinate voting shares, such U.S. Holder may recognize ordinary income or loss as a result of currency fluctuations between the date of the sale of subordinate voting shares and the date the sale proceeds are converted into U.S. dollars.
 
A Non-U.S. Holder of subordinate voting shares generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax on any gain realized on the sale or exchange of such subordinate voting shares unless:
 
·  
such gain is effectively connected with the conduct by such Non-U.S. Holder of a trade or business in the United States; or
·  
in the case of any gain realized by an individual Non-U.S. Holder, such Non-U.S. Holder is present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of such sale and certain other conditions are met.
 
 Passive Foreign Investment Company
 
We believe that our subordinate voting shares should not currently be treated as stock of a passive foreign investment company for United States federal income tax purposes, but this conclusion is a factual determination made annually and thus may be subject to change based on future operations as well as the composition and valuation of our assets. In particular, a significant portion of our gross assets is comprised of cash and short-term investments, which the PFIC rules treat as passive without regard to the purpose for which we hold those assets. If the proportion of these passive assets were to increase relative to the fair market value of our other assets, we may be treated as a passive foreign investment company. In general, we will be a passive foreign investment company with respect to a U.S. Holder if, for any taxable year in which the U.S. Holder holds our subordinate voting shares, either:
 


·  
at least 75% of our gross income for the taxable year is passive income; or
·  
at least 50% of the average value of our assets is attributable to assets that produce or are held for the production of passive income.
 
For this purpose, passive income includes, among other things, income such as:
 
·  
dividends;
·  
interest;
·  
rents or royalties, other than certain rents or royalties derived from the active conduct of trade or business;
·  
annuities; and
·  
gains from assets that produce passive income.
 
If a non-U.S. corporation owns at least 25% by value of the stock of another corporation, the non-U.S. corporation is treated for purposes of the passive foreign investment company tests as owning its proportionate share of the assets of the other corporation and as receiving directly its proportionate share of the other corporation’s income.
 
If we are treated as a passive foreign investment company, a U.S. Holder that did not make a qualified electing fund election, if available, or a mark-to-market election, as described below, would be subject to special rules with respect to:
 
·  
any gain realized on the sale or other disposition of subordinate voting shares; and
·  
any “excess distribution” by us to the U.S. Holder.
 
Generally, “excess distributions” are any distributions to the U.S. Holder in respect of the subordinate voting shares during a single taxable year that are greater than 125% of the average annual distributions received by the U.S. Holder in respect of the subordinate voting shares during the three preceding taxable years or, if shorter, the U.S. Holder’s holding period for the subordinate voting shares.
 
Under the passive foreign investment company rules,
 
·  
the gain or excess distribution would be allocated ratably over the U.S. Holder’s holding period for the subordinate voting shares;
·  
the amount allocated to the taxable year in which the gain or excess distribution was realized and to taxable years prior to the first year in which we were classified as a PFIC would be taxable as ordinary income; and
·  
the amount allocated to each other prior year would be subject to tax as ordinary income at the highest tax rate in effect for that year, and the interest charge generally applicable to underpayments of tax would be imposed in respect of the tax attributable to each such year.
 
A U.S. Holder owning actually or constructively “marketable stock” of a passive foreign investment company may be able to avoid the imposition of the passive foreign investment company tax rules described above by making a mark-to-market election. Generally, pursuant to this election, a U.S. Holder would include in ordinary income or, subject to the following sentence, loss, for each taxable year during which such stock is held, an amount equal to the difference as of the close of the taxable year between the fair market value of its stock and its adjusted tax basis in such stock.  Any mark-to-market loss is treated as an ordinary deduction, but only to the extent of the ordinary income that the U.S. Holder has included pursuant to the election in prior taxable years.  The electing U.S. Holder’s basis in its stock would be adjusted to reflect any of these income or loss amounts.  Holders desiring to make the mark-to-market election should consult their tax advisors with respect to the application and effect of making such election.
 


In the case of a U.S. Holder who does not make a mark-to-market election, the special passive foreign investment company tax rules described above will not apply to such U.S. Holder if the U.S. Holder makes an election to have us treated as a qualified electing fund and we provide certain required information to holders. For a U.S. Holder to make a qualified electing fund election, we would have to satisfy certain reporting requirements. We have not determined whether we will undertake the necessary measures to be able to satisfy such requirements in the event that we were treated as a passive foreign investment company.
 
A U.S. Holder that makes a qualified electing fund election will be currently taxable on its pro rata share of our ordinary earnings and net capital gain, at ordinary income and capital gains rates, respectively, for each of our taxable years, regardless of whether or not distributions were received. The U.S. Holder’s basis in the subordinate voting shares will be increased to reflect taxed but undistributed income. Distributions of income that had previously been taxed will result in a corresponding reduction of basis in the subordinate voting shares and will not be taxed again as a distribution to the U.S. Holder. U.S. Holders desiring to make a qualified electing fund election should consult their tax advisors with respect to the advisability of making such election.
 
 United States Backup Withholding and Information Reporting
 
A U.S. Holder will generally be subject to information reporting with respect to dividends paid on, or proceeds of the sale or other disposition of, our subordinate voting shares that are paid within the United States or through some U.S. related financial intermediaries to U.S. Holders, unless the U.S. Holder is a corporation or comes within certain other categories of exempt recipients. A U.S. Holder that is not an exempt recipient will generally be subject to backup withholding with respect to the proceeds from the sale or the disposition of, or with respect to dividends on, subordinate voting shares unless the U.S. Holder timely provides a taxpayer identification number and complies with the other applicable requirements of the backup withholding rules. A U.S Holder who fails to provide a correct taxpayer identification number may be subject to penalties imposed by the United States Internal Revenue Service.
 
Non-U.S. Holders will generally be subject to information reporting and possible backup withholding with respect to the proceeds of the sale or other disposition of subordinate voting shares effected within the United States, unless the holder certifies to its foreign status or otherwise establishes an exemption and the broker does not have actual knowledge or reason to know that the holder is a U.S. Holder.  Payments of dividends on or proceeds from the sale of subordinate voting shares within the United States by a payor within the United States to a non-exempt U.S. or Non-U.S. Holder will be subject to backup withholding if such holder fails to provide appropriate certification. In the case of such payments by a payor within the United States to a foreign partnership other than a foreign partnership that qualifies as a “withholding foreign partnership” within the meaning of such Treasury regulations, the partners of such partnership will be required to provide the certification discussed above in order to establish an exemption from backup withholding tax and information reporting requirements.
 
Backup withholding is not an additional tax.  Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules will be allowed as a refund or credit against a holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS.
 
 Canadian Federal Income Tax Considerations
 
The following is a summary of the material Canadian federal income tax considerations generally applicable to a U.S. person who holds subordinate voting shares and who, for the purposes of the Income Tax Act (Canada) (the “ITA”), and the Canada-United States Income Tax Convention (1980) (the “Convention”), as applicable and at all relevant times:
 
·  
is resident in the United States and not resident in Canada,
·  
holds the subordinate voting shares as capital property,
·  
does not have a “permanent establishment” or “fixed base” in Canada, as defined in the Convention; and
·  
deals at arm’s length with us. Special rules, which are not discussed below, may apply to “financial institutions”, as defined in the ITA, and to non-resident insurers carrying on an insurance business in Canada and elsewhere.
 
 

This discussion is based on the current provisions of the ITA and the Convention and on the regulations promulgated under the ITA, all specific proposals to amend the ITA or the regulations promulgated under the ITA announced by or on behalf of the Canadian Minister of Finance prior to the date of this Annual Report and the current published administrative practices of the Canada Revenue Agency. It does not otherwise take into account or anticipate any changes in law or administrative practice nor any income tax laws or considerations of any province or territory of Canada or any jurisdiction other than Canada, which may differ from the Canadian federal income tax consequences described in this document.
 
Under the ITA and the Convention, dividends paid or credited, or deemed to be paid or credited, on the subordinate voting shares to a U.S. person who owns less than 10% of the voting shares will be subject to Canadian withholding tax at the rate of 15% of the gross amount of those dividends or deemed dividends. If a U.S. person is a corporation and owns 10% or more of the voting shares, the rate is reduced from 15% to 5%. Subject to specified limitations, a U.S. person may be entitled to credit against U.S. federal income tax liability for the amount of tax withheld by Canada.
 
Under the Convention, dividends paid to specified religious, scientific, charitable and similar tax exempt organizations and specified organizations that are resident and exempt from tax in the United States and that have complied with specified administrative procedures are exempt from this Canadian withholding tax.
 
A capital gain realized by a U.S. person on a disposition or deemed disposition of the subordinate voting shares will not be subject to tax under the ITA unless the subordinate voting shares constitute taxable Canadian property within the meaning of the ITA at the time of the disposition or deemed disposition. In general, the subordinate voting shares will not be “taxable Canadian property” to a U.S. person if they are listed on a prescribed stock exchange, which includes The Toronto Stock Exchange, unless, at any time within the five-year period immediately preceding the disposition, the U.S. person, persons with whom the U.S. person did not deal at arm’s length, or the U.S. person together with those persons, owned or had an interest in or a right to acquire more than 25% of any class or series of our shares.
 
If the subordinate voting shares are taxable Canadian property to a U.S. person, any capital gain realized on a disposition or deemed disposition of those subordinate voting shares will generally be exempt from tax by virtue of the Convention if the value of the subordinate voting shares at the time of the disposition or deemed disposition is not derived principally from real property, as defined by the Convention, situated in Canada. The determination as to whether Canadian tax would be applicable on a disposition or deemed disposition of the subordinate voting shares must be made at the time of the disposition or deemed disposition.
 
Holders of subordinate voting shares are urged to consult their own tax advisors to determine the particular tax consequences to them, including the application and effect of any state, local or foreign income and other tax laws, of the acquisition, ownership and disposition of subordinate voting shares.
 
 
F.  Dividends and Paying Agents
 
Not Applicable.
 
 
 G.  Statement by Experts
 
Not Applicable.
 

 
 H.  Documents on Display
 
Any statement in this Annual Report about any of our contracts or other documents is not necessarily complete. If the contract or document is filed as an exhibit to the registration statement, the contract or document is deemed to modify the description contained in this Annual Report. You must review the exhibits themselves for a complete description of the contract or document.
 
You may review a copy of our filings with the SEC, including exhibits and schedules filed with it, at the SEC’s public reference facilities at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549 and at the regional offices of the SEC located at 233 Broadway, New York, New York 10279 and at the Northwestern Atrium Center, 500 West Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661. You may also obtain copies of such materials from the Public Reference Section of the SEC, 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549, at prescribed rates. You may call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the public reference rooms. The SEC maintains a Web site (http://www.sec.gov) that contains reports, proxy and information statements and other information regarding registrants that file electronically with the SEC.
 
You may read and copy any reports, statements or other information that we file with the SEC at the addresses indicated above and you may also access them electronically at the Web site set forth above. These SEC filings are also available to the public from commercial document retrieval services.
 
We are required to file reports and other information with the SEC under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Reports and other information filed by us with the SEC may be inspected and copied at the SEC’s public reference facilities described above. As a foreign private issuer, we are exempt from the rules under the Exchange Act prescribing the furnishing and content of proxy statements and our officers, directors and principal shareholders are exempt from the reporting and short-swing profit recovery provisions contained in Section 16 of the Exchange Act. Under the Exchange Act, as a foreign private issuer, we are not required to publish financial statements as frequently or as promptly as United States companies.
 
 
 I.  Subsidiary Information
 
See Item 4.C. of this Annual Report.
 

 
Item 11.  
Qualitative and Quantitative Disclosures about Market Risk
 
 Market Risk
 
 Currency Risk
 
Our principal measurement currency is the Canadian dollar. In addition, we have adopted the US dollar as our reporting currency. We are exposed to currency risk due to our export sales of products manufactured in Canada, China and Finland, the majority of which are denominated in US dollars and euros. This risk is partially hedged by certain operating expenses denominated in US dollars and euros, the purchase of raw materials in US dollars and forward exchange contracts. The decrease in the strength of the US dollar, compared to the Canadian dollar, over the last couple of years caused our operating expenses to increase as some of these expenses are denominated in Canadian dollars. Any decrease in the value of the US dollar compared to the Canadian dollar and the euro in the upcoming months will negatively affect our results of operations.
 
We enter into forward exchange contracts to manage the risk of exchange rate fluctuations between the Canadian and the US dollar on cash flows related to anticipated future revenue streams denominated in US dollars. We do not enter into forward exchange contracts for trading or speculative purposes. Forward exchange contracts, which are designated as cash flow hedging instruments, qualify for hedge accounting.
 
The following table summarizes the forward exchange contracts in effect as at August 31, 2011, classified by expected transaction dates, none of which exceed two fiscal  years, as well as the notional amounts of such contracts (in thousands of US dollars) along with the weighted average contractual forward rates under such contracts. The notional amounts of such contracts are used to calculate the contractual payments to be made under these contracts.
 
   
Years ending August 31,
 
             
   
2012
   
2013
 
             
Forward exchange contracts to sell US dollars in exchange for Canadian dollars
           
Contractual amounts                                                                                        
  $ 27,500     $ 11,400  
Weighted average contractual forward rates                                                                                        
    1.0555       1.0063  
 
Fair Value
 
The carrying amount of forward exchange contracts is equal to fair value, which is based on the amount at which they could be settled based on estimated current market rates. The fair value of forward exchange contracts amounted to net gains of $597,000 and $2.3 million as at August 31, 2010 and 2011 respectively.
 


The following table summarizes significant financial assets and liabilities that are subject to currency risk as at August 31, 2010 and 2011:
 
   
As at August 31,
 
                         
   
2011
   
2010
 
                         
   
Carrying/
nominal
amount
(in thousands
of US dollars)
   
Carrying/
nominal
amount
(in thousands
of euros)
   
Carrying/
nominal
amount
(in thousands
of US dollars)
   
Carrying/
nominal
amount
(in thousands
of euros)
 
                         
Financial assets
                       
Cash
  $ 10,553     1,502     $ 6,947     1,287  
Accounts receivable
    25,040       4,332       30,218       3,860  
      35,593       5,834       37,165       5,147  
Financial liabilities
                               
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
    8,706       37       8,932       438  
Forward exchange contracts (nominal amount)
    5,400             5,900        
      14,106       37       14,832       438  
Net exposure
  $ 21,487     5,797     $ 22,333     4,709  
 
The value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar was CA$1.0665 = US$1.00 and CA$0.9784 = US$1.00 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011 respectively.
 
The value of the Canadian dollar compared to the euro was CA$1.3515 = €1.00 and CA$1.4094 = €1.00 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011 respectively.
 
The following sensitivity analysis summarizes the effect that a change in the value of the Canadian dollar (compared to the US dollar and euro) on financial assets and liabilities denominated in US dollars and euros, would have on net earnings, net earnings per diluted share and comprehensive income, based on the foreign exchange rates as at August 31, 2010 and 2011:
 
·  
An increase (decrease) of 10% in the period-end value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar would decrease (increase) net earnings by $2.1 million, or $0.03 per diluted share, and $1.9 million, or $0.03 per diluted share, as at August 31, 2010 and 2011 respectively.
 
·  
An increase (decrease) of 10% in the period-end value of the Canadian dollar compared to the euro would decrease (increase) net earnings by $621,000, or $0.01 per diluted share, and $831,000, or $0.01 per diluted share, as at August 31, 20010 and 2011 respectively.
 
·  
An increase (decrease) of 10% in the period-end value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar would increase (decrease) comprehensive income by $3.2 million and $2.4 million as at August 31, 2010 and 2011 respectively.
 
The impact of the change in the value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar and the euro on these financial assets and liabilities is recorded in the foreign exchange gain or loss line item in the consolidated statements of earnings, except for outstanding forward contracts, which impact is recorded in other comprehensive income. The change in the value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar and the euro also impacts our balances of income tax and tax credits recoverable or payable and future income tax assets and liabilities related to integrated foreign subsidiaries; this may result in additional and significant foreign exchange gain or loss. However, these assets and liabilities are not considered financial instruments and are excluded from the sensitivity analysis above. The foreign exchange rate fluctuations also flow through the statements of earnings line items, as a significant portion of our operating expenses is denominated in Canadian dollars and euros, and we report our results in US dollars; that effect is not reflected in the sensitivity analysis above.
 


Interest rate risk
 
We  are  exposed  to  interest  rate  risks  through  our  short-term  investments,  our bank loan and our long-term debt.
 
Short-term investments
 
Short-term investments consist of the following (in thousands of US dollars):
 
   
As at August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Commercial paper denominated in Canadian dollars, bearing interest at annual rates of 1.0% to 1.3% in 2011 and 0.6% to 0.9% in 2010, maturing between September and November 2011 in fiscal 2011, and in September and October 2010 in fiscal 2010
  $ 31,765     $ 6,383  
Bankers acceptance denominated in Canadian dollars, bearing interest at annual rates of 1.0% to 1.2% in fiscal 2011 and 0.8% in 2010, maturing in September and November 2011 in fiscal 2011, and September 2010 in fiscal 2010
    15,326       3,996  
    $ 47,091     $ 10,379  
 
The fair value of our short-term investments based on market value amounted to $10.4 million and $47.1 million as at August 31, 2010 and 2011 respectively.
 
Due to their short-term maturity of usually three months or less, our short-term investments are not subject to significant fair value interest rate risk. Accordingly, change in fair value has been nominal to the degree that amortized cost has historically approximated the fair value. Any change in fair value of our short-term investments, all of which are classified as available for sale, is recorded in other comprehensive income.
 
Bank loan
 
As at August 31, 2011, our bank loan, in the amount of $784,000, bears interest at 7.2%. The fair value of the bank loan approximates its carrying value due to its short-term maturity.
 
Long-term debt
 
As at August 31, 2011, our long-term debt, in the amount of $1.6 million, bears interest at an annual rate of 2.95% and matures in December 2013. The fair value of the long-term debt approximates its carrying value due to its relatively short-term maturity.
 
Other financial instruments
 
Cash, accounts receivable and accounts payable and accrued liabilities are non-interest-bearing financial assets and liabilities. Accounts receivable and accounts payable are financial instruments whose carrying value approximates their fair value due to their short-term maturity.
 
Credit risk
 
Financial instruments that potentially subject us to credit risk consist primarily of cash, short-term investments, accounts receivable and forward exchange contracts (with a positive fair value). As at August 31, 2011, our short-term investments consist of debt instruments issued by twelve (nine as at August 31, 2010) high-credit quality corporations and trusts. None of these debt instruments are expected to be affected by a significant liquidity risk. Our cash and forward exchange contracts are held with or issued by high-credit quality financial institutions; therefore, we consider the risk of non-performance on these instruments to be limited.
 

 
Generally, we do not require collateral or other security from our customers for trade accounts receivable; however, credit is extended to customers following an evaluation of creditworthiness. In addition, we perform ongoing credit reviews of all our customers and establish an allowance for doubtful accounts receivable when accounts are determined to be uncollectible. Allowance for doubtful accounts amounted to $1.2 million and $1.2 million as at August 31, 2010 and 2011 respectively. Bad debt expense amounted to $967,000, $24,000 and $91,000 for the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011 respectively.
 
In fiscal 2010 and 2011, no customer represented more than 10% of our sales. In fiscal 2009, one customer represented more than 10% of our sales with 13.1% ($20.0 million).
 
The following table summarizes the age of trade accounts receivable (in thousands of US dollars):
 
   
As at August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Current
  $ 33,149     $ 38,663  
Past due, 0 to 30 days
    7,299       6,787  
Past due, 31 to 60 days
    2,590       1,991  
Past due, more than 60 days, less allowance for doubtful accounts of $1,243 and $1,245 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011 respectively.
    2,113       2,749  
Total accounts receivable
  $ 45,151     $ 50,190  
 
Liquidity risk
 
Liquidity risk is defined as the potential that we cannot meet our obligations as they become due.
 
The following tables summarize the contractual maturity of our financial liabilities (in thousands of US dollars):
 
   
As at August 31, 2011
 
                   
   
0-12
months
   
13-24
months
   
25-36
months
 
                   
Bank loan
  $ 784     $     $  
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
    30,319              
Long-term debt
    645       645       323  
Other liabilities
          201        
Forward exchange contracts
                       
Outflow
    27,500       11,400        
Inflow
    (29,668 )     (11,725 )      
Total
  $ 29,580     $ 521     $ 323  
 
 
   
As at August 31, 2010
 
                         
   
0-12
months
   
13-24
months
   
25-36
months
   
Over 36
months
 
                         
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
  $ 29,711     $     $     $  
Long-term debt
    568       568       568       283  
Other liabilities
          295              
Forward exchange contracts
                               
Outflow
    29,500       20,400       1,500        
Inflow
    (30,141 )     (20,662 )     (1,508 )      
Total
  $ 29,638     $ 601     $ 560     $ 283  
 
 
 
As at August 31, 2011, we had $69.9 million in cash and short-term investments and $45.2 million in accounts receivable. In addition to these financial assets, we have unused available lines of credit totaling $15.5 million for working capital and other general corporate purposes, including potential acquisitions and our share repurchase program as well as unused lines of credit of $16.5 million for foreign currency exposure related to our forward exchange contracts.
 
 
Item 12.  
Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities
 
Not Applicable.
 
 
PART II.                      
 
Item 13.  
Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies
 
Not Applicable.
 
 
Item 14.  
Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds
              
Not Applicable.
 
 
Item 15.  
Controls and Procedures
         
(a) Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
 
Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, we have evaluated the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures as at the end of the period covered by this Annual Report. Based on that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that these disclosure controls and procedures are effective as at August 31, 2011.
 
(b) Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
 
EXFO’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. EXFO’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in Canada.1
 
EXFO’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of EXFO; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in Canada, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of EXFO; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of EXFO’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.


 
1
Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in Canada (“Canadian GAAP”) and significant differences in measurement and disclosure from generally accepted accounting principles in United States (“U.S. GAAP”) are set out in note 22 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report.
 

 
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
 
Management conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of EXFO’s internal control over financial reporting based on the criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based on this evaluation, management concluded that EXFO’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as at August 31, 2011.
 
Our independent registered public accounting firm, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, audited the consolidated financial statements contained in this Annual Report and has issued an attestation report on management’s assessment of EXFO’s internal control over financial reporting.
 
(c) Attestation Report of the Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
Our independent registered public accounting firm, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, audited the effectiveness of EXFO’s internal control over financial reporting as at August 31, 2011, as stated in its attestation report, which is included  on pages F-1, F-2 and F-3 of this Annual Report on Form 20-F.
 
(d) Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
 
There were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting during the period covered by this Annual Report that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
 
 
 
 
Item 16.  
[Reserved]
 
 
Item 16A.  
Audit Committee Financial Expert
 
Our Board of Directors has determined that Mr. Guy Marier, chairman of our Audit Committee, is an Audit Committee financial expert. Mr. Marier is independent of management, in accordance with the CSA Standards as described in Item 6C – Board Practices of this Annual Report. For a description of Mr. Marier’s education and experience, please refer to Item 6A. The other members of the Audit Committee are Mr. Pierre-Paul Allard, Mr. Darryl Edwards, Mr. Pierre Marcouiller, Ms. Susan Louise Spradley and Mr. David A. Thompson, all of whom are independent. For a description of their respective education and experience, please also refer to Item 6A.
 
 
Item 16B.  
Code of Ethics
 
In 2003, we adopted a code of ethics that applies to our chief executive officer, our chief financial officer and our manager of financial reporting and accounting. A copy of this code of ethics has been filed as exhibit 11.1 to this Annual Report on Form 20-F. In March 2005, the Board updated and adopted the following policies:
 
·  
Code of Ethics for our Principal Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers;
·  
Board of Directors Corporate Governance Guidelines;
·  
Ethics and Business Conduct Policy;
·  
Statement of Reporting Ethical Violations (Whistle Blower).
 
A copy of those policies has been filed respectively as exhibits 11.1 through 11.4 inclusively to our fiscal year 2011 Annual Report on Form 20-F. All these policies are also readily available on our website at www.EXFO.com. Accordingly, we believe that our corporate governance practices are in alignment to current regulatory requirements. We will provide without charge to each person, on the written or oral request of such person, a copy of our code of ethics. Requests for such copies should be directed to us at the following address: 400 Godin Avenue, Quebec, Quebec, G1M 2K2, Canada, Attention: Corporate Secretary, telephone number (418) 683-0211.
 
 
Item 16C.  
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
 
Audit Fees
 
During the financial years ended August 31, 2010 and August 31, 2011, our principal accountant, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, billed us aggregate amounts of $539,000 and $334,000 respectively for the audit of our annual consolidated financial statements and services in connection with statutory and regulatory filings.
 
Audit-Related Fees
 
During the financial years ended August 31, 2010 and August 31, 2011, our principal accountant, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, billed us aggregate amounts of $146,000 and $86,000 respectively for audit-related fees namely for the quarterly review of interim consolidated financial statements and the IFRS convergence project.
 
Tax Fees
 
During the financial years ended August 31, 2010 and August 31, 2011, our principal accountant, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, billed us aggregate amounts of $188,000 and $112,000, respectively for services related to tax compliance, tax advice and tax planning.
 


All Other Fees
 
During the financial year ended August 31, 2010, our principal accountant, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, billed us aggregate amount of $25,000, for due-diligence-related work for the acquisition of NetHawk Oyj. No other fees were billed in fiscal 2011.
 
Audit Committee Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures
 
On September 25, 2002, our Audit Committee adopted a policy requiring prior approval by the Audit Committee of the annual audit plan which has been integrated in the Audit Committee Charter (refer to Item 6C for further details on the Audit Committee Charter). In the event any adjustments to audit plan may be required during the course of a financial year, such adjustments shall be approved by the chairman of the Audit Committee, acting alone, and shall be reported to the full Audit Committee at its next meeting.
 
In the case of non-audit services (excluding tax matters), the policy provides that proposals shall be submitted to the chairman of the Audit Committee and our chief financial officer at the same time and the chairman of the Audit Committee will be responsible for approval of such proposal, subject to any modifications that he may require. The chairman will make a report to the full Audit Committee at its next meeting.
 
As concerns tax services to be provided by our principal accountant, our policy provides that the principal accountant will present to the Audit Committee for pre-approval, on or before the beginning of each financial year, an engagement for tax matters that are foreseeable for the upcoming year and the Audit Committee shall be responsible for pre-approval thereof, subject to any modifications it may make to such proposals. In the event tax services are required that were not pre-approved by the Audit Committee, the procedure set forth in the previous paragraph will apply.
 
During the financial year ended on August 31, 2011, 100% of tax fees were approved by the Audit Committee pursuant to this policy. During the financial year ended on August 31, 2011, only full-time permanent employees of our principal accountant, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, performed work to audit our financial statements.
 
 
Item 16D.  
Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees
 
Not Applicable.
 
 
Item 16E.  
Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers
 
Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
On November 5, 2010, we announced the approval of the renewal of the share repurchase program effective from November 10, 2010 to November 9, 2011, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market of up to 2,012,562 subordinate voting shares (“2010 NCIB”). On November 7, 2011, we announced the approval of the renewal of the share repurchase program effective from November 10, 2011 and provided to expire on November 9, 2012, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market of up to 575,690 subordinate voting shares (“2011 NCIB”). As of the date of this filing, the 2011 NCIB is still in effect.
 
Since September 1, 2010 and until November 9, 2011, we spent approximately US$203,521 (including fees) to repurchase 34,946 subordinate voting shares.
 
 
 
129

 
 
Period
(a) Total Number
of Shares (or
Units) Purchased
(#)
(b) Average Price Paid
per Share (or Units)
(c) Total Number of Shares
(or Units) Purchased as Part
of Publicly Announced
Plans or Programs
(#)
(d) Maximum Number of
Shares (or Units) that May
Yet Be Purchased Under
the Plans or Programs
(#)
NASDAQ
(US$)
TSX
(CA$)
From Oct. 1 2011
21,664
5.62
21,664
1,990,898
To Oct. 1, 2011
From Nov. 1 2011
13,282
5.91
13,282
1,977,616
To Nov. 9, 2011
Total
34,946
 
34,946
 
 
 
Item 16F.  
Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant
 
Not Applicable.
 
 
Item 16G.  
Corporate Governance
 
The Corporation’s corporate governance practices do not differ significantly from the practices followed by United States domestic companies listed on the NASDAQ National Market. A copy of the Corporation’s Corporate Governance Policies are included as Exhibits 11.1 to 11.9 to this Annual Report on Form 20-F.
 
 
PART III.                    
 
Item 17.  
Financial Statements
 
Not Applicable.
 
 
Item 18.  
Financial Statements
 
See pages F-4 to F-43.
 
 
 
Item 19.  
Exhibits
 
Number
Exhibit
1.1
Amended Articles of Incorporation of EXFO (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
1.2
Amended By-laws of EXFO (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1.2 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form-20F dated January 15, 2003, File No. 000-30895).
1.3
Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of EXFO (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1.3 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2001, File No. 000-30895).
1.4
Certificate of Amendment, Canada Business Corporations Act (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 25, 2009, File No. 000-30895).
1.5
Certificate of Amendment (Change of Name), Canada Business Corporations Act (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1.5 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 24, 2010, File No. 000-30895).
2.1
Form of Subordinate Voting Share Certificate (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
2.2
Form of Registration Rights Agreement between EXFO and Germain Lamonde dated July 6, 2000 ) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
3.1
Form of Trust Agreement among EXFO, Germain Lamonde, GEXFO Investissements Technologiques inc., Fiducie Germain Lamonde and G. Lamonde Investissements Financiers inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2  of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.1
Agreement of Merger and Plan of Reorganization, dated as of November 4, 2000, by and among EXFO, EXFO Sub, Inc., EXFO Burleigh Instruments, Inc., Robert G. Klimasewski, William G. May, Jr., David J. Farrell and William S. Gornall (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2001, File No. 000-30895).
4.2
Amendment No. 1 to Agreement of Merger and Plan of Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2000, by and among EXFO, EXFO Sub, Inc., EXFO Burleigh Instruments, Inc., Robert G. Klimasewski, William G. May, Jr., David J. Farrell and William S. Gornall (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2001, File No. 000-30895).
4.3
Agreement of Merger, dated as of August 20, 2001, by and among EXFO, Buyer Sub, and Avantas Networks Corporation and Shareholders of Avantas Networks corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2002, File No. 000-30895).
4.4
Amendment No. 1 dated as of November 1, 2002 to Agreement of Merger, dated as of August 20, 2001, by and among EXFO, 3905268 Canada Inc., Avantas Networks Corporation and Shareholders of Avantas Networks (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2002, File No. 000-30895).
4.5
Offer to purchase shares of Nortech Fibronic Inc., dated February 6, 2000 among EXFO, Claude Adrien Noel, 9086-9314 Québec inc., Michel Bédard, Christine Bergeron and Société en Commandite Capidem Québec Enr. and Certificate of Closing, dated February 7, 2000 among the same parties (including summary in English) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.6
Share Purchase Agreement, dated as of March 5, 2001, among EXFO Electro-Optical Engineering, Inc., John Kennedy, Glenn Harvey and EFOS Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-3 filed on July 13, 2001, File No. 333-65122).
4.7
Amendment Number One, dated as of March 15, 2001, to Share Purchase Agreement, dated as of March 5, 2001, among EXFO Electro-Optical Engineering, Inc., John Kennedy, Glenn Harvey and EFOS Corporation. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-3 filed on July 13, 2001, File No. 333-65122).
4.8
Share Purchase Agreement, dated as of November 2, 2001 between JDS Uniphase Inc. and 3905268 Canada Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.8 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2002, File No. 000-30895).
4.9
Intellectual Property Assignment and Sale Agreement between EFOS Inc., EXFO Electro-Optical Engineering, Inc., John Kennedy, Glenn Harvey and EFOS Corporation. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-3 filed on July 13, 2001, File No. 333-65122).
 
 
 
 
Number
Exhibit
4.10
Offer to acquire a building, dated February 23, 2000, between EXFO and Groupe Mirabau inc. and as accepted by Groupe Mirabau inc. on February 24, 2000 (including summary in English) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.11
Lease Agreement, dated December 1, 1996, between EXFO and GEXFO Investissements Technologiques inc., as assigned to 9080-9823 Québec inc. on September 1, 1999 (including summary in English) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.12
Lease Agreement, dated March 1, 1996, between EXFO and GEXFO Investissements Technologiques inc., as assigned to 9080-9823 Québec inc. on September 1, 1999 (including summary in English) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.13
Lease renewal of the existing leases between 9080-9823 Québec inc. and EXFO, dated November 30, 2001(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.13 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2002, File No. 000-30895).
4.14
Loan Agreement between EXFO and GEXFO Investissements Technologiques inc., dated May 11, 1993, as assigned to 9080-9823 Québec inc. on September 1, 1999 (including summary in English)  (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.15
Resolution of the Board of Directors of EXFO, dated September 1, 1999, authorizing EXFO to acquire GEXFO Distribution Internationale inc. from GEXFO Investissements Technologiques inc. (including summary in English) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.16
Form of Promissory Note of EXFO issued to GEXFO Investissements Technologiques inc. dated June 27, 2000 )  (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.17
Term Loan Offer, dated March 28, 2000, among EXFO and National Bank of Canada as accepted by EXFO on April 3, 2000 (including summary in English) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.18
Employment Agreement of Germain Lamonde dated May 29, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.19
Employment Agreement of Bruce Bonini dated as of September 1, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.24 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2002, File No. 000-30895).
4.20
Employment Agreement of Juan-Felipe Gonzalez dated as of September 1, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.25 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2002, File No. 000-30895).
4.21
Employment Agreement of David J. Farrell dated as of December 20, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.26 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2002, File No. 000-30895).
4.22
Deferred Profit Sharing Plan, dated September 1, 1998 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.23
Stock Option Plan, dated May 25, 2000 (incorporated by Reference to Exhibit 10.7 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.24
Share Plan, dated April 3, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.25
Directors’ Compensation Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.17 of EXFO’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed on June 9, 2000, File No. 333-38956).
4.26
Restricted Stock Award Plan, dated December 20, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.21 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 18, 2001, File No. 000-30895).
4.27
Asset Purchase Agreement by and Among EXFO Electro-Optical Engineering Inc., EXFO Gnubi Products Group Inc., gnubi communications, L.P., gnubi communications General Partner, LLC, gnubi communications Limited Partner, LLC, gnubi communications, Inc., Voting Trust created by The Irrevocable Voting Trust Agreement Among Carol Abraham Bolton, Paul Abraham and James Ray Stevens, James Ray Stevens and Daniel J. Ernst dated September 5, 2002 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.30 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 15, 2003, File No. 000-30895).
 
 
 
 
Number
Exhibit
4.28
EXFO Protocol Inc. Executive Employment Agreement with Sami Yazdi signed November 2, 2001 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.28 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 15, 2003, File No. 000-30895).
4.29
Second Amending Agreement to the Employment Agreement of Bruce Bonini dated as of September 1, 2002, (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.29 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 15, 2004, File No. 000-30895).
4.30
Severance and General Release Agreement with Bruce Bonini dated August 8, 2003, (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.30 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 15, 2004, File No. 000-30895).
4.31
Separation Agreement and General Release with Sami Yazdi dated April 1, 2003, (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.31 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 15, 2004, File No. 000-30895).
4.32
Executive Employment Agreement of James Stevens dated as of October 4, 2003, (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.32 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 15, 2004, File No. 000-30895).
4.33
Termination Terms for John Holloran Jr. dated May 28, 2003, (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.33 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 15, 2004, File No. 000-30895).
4.34
Employment Agreement of Pierre Plamondon dated as of September 1, 2002, (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.34 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated January 15, 2004, File No. 000-30895).
4.35
Long-Term Incentive Plan, dated May 25, 2000, amended in October 2004 and effective January 12, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.35 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 29, 2005, File No. 000-30895).
4.36
Deferred Share Unit Plan, effective January 12, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.36 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 29, 2005, File No. 000-30895).
4.37
Asset Purchase Agreement by and Among EXFO Electro-Optical Engineering Inc., Consultronics Limited., Andre Rekai, Consultronics Europe Limited, Consultronics Development Kft. and Consultronics Inc. dated January 5, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.37 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 23, 2006, File No. 000-30895).
4.38
Share Repurchase Program by Way of Normal Course Issuer Bid dated November 6, 2007 (incorporated by reference to EXFO’s report on Form 6-K dated November 6, 2007, file No. 000-30895).
4.39
Share Purchase Agreement by and Among EXFO Electro-Optical Engineering Inc., Navtel Communications Inc. and Vengrowth Investment Fund, BDC Capital Inc. and others, dated March 26, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.38 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 26, 2008, File No. 000-30895).
4.40
Agreement and Plan of Merger by and among Gexfo Distribution Internationale Inc., EXFO Service Assurance Inc. and Brix Networks, Inc. and Charles River Ventures, LLC dated April 2, 2008 (incorporated by reference to EXFO’s Material Change Report on Form 6-K dated May 2, 2008, File No. 000-30895).
4.41
Issuer Tender Offer, Letter of Transmittal and Notice of Guaranteed Delivery dated November 10, 2008 (incorporated by reference as Exhibits (a) (1) (i), (a) (1) (ii) and (a) (1) (iii) to EXFO’s Schedule TO dated November 10, 2008, File No. 000-30895).
4.42
Renewal of EXFO’s Share Repurchase Program by Way of Normal Course Issuer Bid dated November 6, 2008 (incorporated by reference to EXFO’s report on Form 6-K dated November 6, 2008, file No. 000-30895).
4.43
Final results of Issuer Bid Tender Offer, dated December 18, 2009 (incorporated by reference to EXFO’s Material Change Report on Form 6-K dated December 19, 2008, file No. 000-30895).
4.44
Share Transfer Agreement by and among GEXFO Distribution Internationale Inc. and AWS Holding AB (PicoSolve AB) and Patent Transfer Agreement by and among EXFO Electro-Optical Engineering Inc. and Starta Eget Boxen 11629 AB dated February 5, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.44 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 25, 2009, File No. 000-30895).
4.45
Renewal of EXFO’s Share Repurchase Program by Way of Normal Course Issuer Bid dated November 10, 2009 (incorporated by reference to EXFO’s report on Form 6-K dated November 6, 2009, file No. 000-30895).
4.46
Share Purchase Agreement by and among EXFO Finland Oy and NetHawk Oyj’s majority shareholders dated March 12, 2010 (incorporated by reference to EXFO’s Material Change Report on Form 6-K dated March 19, 2010, File No. 000-30895).
4.47
Share Purchase Agreement by and among EXFO Inc. and Photonic Acquisition Inc. dated October 1, 2010 (incorporated by reference to EXFO’s Material Change Report on Form 6-K dated October 8, 2010, File No. 000-30895).
 
 
 
 
Number
Exhibit
4.48
Renewal of EXFO’s Share Repurchase Program by Way of Normal Course Issuer Bid dated November 5, 2010 (incorporated by reference to EXFO’s report on Form 6-K dated November 5, 2010, file No. 000-30895).
4.49
Renewal of EXFO’s Share Repurchase Program by Way of Normal Course Issuer Bid dated November 7, 2011 (incorporated by reference to EXFO’s report on Form 6-K dated November 7, 2011, file No. 000-30895).
8.1
Subsidiaries of EXFO (list included in Item 4C of this Annual Report).
11.1
Code of Ethics for our Principal Executive Officer and Senior Financial Officers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 11.1 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 24, 2010, File No. 000-30895).
11.2
Board of Directors Corporate Governance Guidelines (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 11.2 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 24, 2010, File No. 000-30895).
11.3
Ethics and Business Conduct Policy (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 11.3 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 24, 2010, File No. 000-30895).
11.4
Statement of Reporting Ethical Violations (Whistle Blower) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 11.4 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 24, 2010, File No. 000-30895).
11.5
Audit Committee Charter.
11.6
Human Resources Committee Charter (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 11.6 of EXFO’s Annual Report on Form 20-F dated November 24, 2010, File No. 000-30895).
11.7
Corporate Governance Practices.
11.8
Majority Voting Policy.
11.9
Independent Members Committee Charter.
12.1
Certification of the Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
12.2
Certification of the Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
13.1
Certification of the Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
13.2
Certification of the Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 

SIGNATURES

 
The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this Annual Report on its behalf.


EXFO INC.




By:           /s/ Germain Lamonde
Name:      Germain Lamonde
Title:        Chairman of the Board, President
 and Chief Executive Officer

Date:       November 23, 2011

 

Exhibit 12.1
Certification pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

I, Germain Lamonde, certify that:
 
1.  
I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 20-F of EXFO Inc. ("EXFO");
 
2.  
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
 
3.  
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of EXFO as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
 
4.  
EXFO's other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for EXFO and have:
 
a.  
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to EXFO, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
 
b.  
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
 
c.  
Evaluated the effectiveness of EXFO's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
 
d.  
Disclosed in this report any change in EXFO's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the Annual Report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, EXFO's internal control over financial reporting; and
 
5.  
EXFO's other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to EXFO's auditors and the audit committee of EXFO's board of directors:
 
a.  
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect EXFO's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
 
b.  
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in EXFO’s internal control over financial reporting.
 
Date: November 23, 2011


/s/ Germain Lamonde
Germain Lamonde
Chairman of the Board,
President and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 

Exhibit 12.2
Certification pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

Pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of section 1350, chapter 63 of title 18, United States Code), the undersigned officer of EXFO Inc., hereby certifies, that:

1.  
The Annual Report of Form 20-F for the year ended August 31, 2011 of EXFO fully complies with the requirements of section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

2.  
The information contained in this Annual Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of EXFO.


Date:  November 23, 2011
 


/s/  Germain Lamonde
Germain Lamonde
Chairman of the Board,
President and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)

The foregoing certification is being furnished solely pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of section 1350, chapter 63 of title 18, United States Code) and is not being filed as part of the Report or as separate disclosure document.



Exhibit 13.1
Certification pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

I, Pierre Plamondon, certify that:
 
1.  
I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 20-F of EXFO Inc. ("EXFO");
 
2.  
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
 
3.  
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of EXFO as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
 
4.  
EXFO's other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for EXFO and have:
 
a.  
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to EXFO, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
 
b.  
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
 
c.  
Evaluated the effectiveness of EXFO's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
 
d.  
Disclosed in this report any change in EXFO's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the Annual Report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, EXFO's internal control over financial reporting; and
 
5.  
EXFO's other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to EXFO's auditors and the audit committee of EXFO's board of directors:
 
a.  
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect EXFO's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
 
b.  
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in EXFO's internal control over financial reporting.
 
Date: November 23, 2011


/s/ Pierre Plamondon
Pierre Plamondon, CA
Vice-President Finance
and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)
 

 

Exhibit 13.2
Certification pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

Pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of section 1350, chapter 63 of title 18, United States Code), the undersigned officer of EXFO Inc., hereby certifies, that:

1.  
The Annual Report of Form 20-F for the year ended August 31, 2011 of EXFO fully complies with the requirements of section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

2.  
The information contained in this Annual Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of EXFO.


Date:  November 23, 2011



/s/ Pierre Plamondon
Pierre Plamondon, CA
Vice-President Finance
and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)

The foregoing certification is being furnished solely pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (subsections (a) and (b) of section 1350, chapter 63 of title 18, United States Code) and is not being filed as part of the Report or as separate disclosure document.
 
 

 












Independent Auditor's Report
 
To the Shareholders of
EXFO Inc.
 
 
We have completed integrated audits of EXFO Inc. and its subsidiaries' 2011, 2010 and 2009 consolidated financial statements and their internal control over financial reporting as at August 31, 2011. Our opinions, based on our audits, are presented below.
 
Report on the consolidated financial statements
We have audited the accompanying consolidated financial statements of EXFO Inc. and its subsidiaries, which comprise the consolidated balance sheets as at August 31, 2011 and August 31, 2010, and the consolidated statement of accumulated other comprehensive income for each of the two years in the period ended August 31, 2011, and the consolidated statements of earnings, comprehensive income (loss), retained earnings and contributed surplus and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended August 31, 2011, and the related notes, which comprise a summary of significant accounting policies and other explanatory information. We have also audited the consolidated financial statement schedule, Valuation and Qualifying Accounts in Item 8.A. of this Annual Report on Form 20-F.
 
Management's responsibility for the consolidated financial statements
Management is responsible for the preparation and fair presentation of these consolidated financial statements in accordance with Canadian generally accepted accounting principles and of the consolidated financial statement schedule and for such internal control as management determines is necessary to enable the preparation of consolidated financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.
 
Auditor's responsibility
Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements and consolidated financial statement schedule based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with Canadian generally accepted auditing standards and the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform an audit to obtain reasonable assurance whether the consolidated financial statements are free from material misstatement. Canadian generally accepted auditing standards also require that we comply with ethical requirements



 
 
 
 
 
F-1










An audit involves performing procedures to obtain audit evidence, on a test basis, about the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. The procedures selected depend on the auditor's judgment, including the assessment of the risks of material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to fraud or error. In making those risk assessments, the auditor considers internal control relevant to the company's preparation and fair presentation of the consolidated financial statements in order to design audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances. An audit also includes evaluating the appropriateness of accounting principles and policies used and the reasonableness of accounting estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements.

We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained in our audits is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our audit opinion on the consolidated financial statements and the consolidated financial statement schedule.

Opinion
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of EXFO Inc. and its subsidiaries as at August 31, 2011 and August 31, 2010 and the results of their operations and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended August 31, 2011 in accordance with Canadian generally accepted accounting principles. Furthermore, in our opinion, the consolidated financial statement schedule, Valuation and Qualifying Accounts, in Item 8.A. of this Annual Report on Form 20-F presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein when read in conjunction with the related consolidated financial statements.

Report on internal control over financial reporting
We have also audited EXFO Inc. and its subsidiaries' internal control over financial reporting as at August 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework, issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

Management's responsibility for internal control over financial reporting
Management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management's Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting, appearing in Item 15 on page 126 of this Annual Report on Form 20-F.

Auditor's responsibility
Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the company's internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We conducted our audit of internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.



 
 
 
 
 
F-2

 








An audit of internal control over financial reporting includes obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control, based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we consider necessary in the circumstances.

We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion on the company's internal control over financial reporting.

Definition of internal control over financial reporting
A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Inherent limitations
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Opinion
In our opinion, EXFO Inc. and its subsidiaries maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as at August 31, 2011 based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework, issued by COSO.


/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP 1


Quebec City, Quebec, Canada
October 11, 2011, except Note 16 (e) which is as of November 7, 2011









1 Chartered accountant auditor permit No. 18144

 
 
 
F-3

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Consolidated Balance Sheets
 
(in thousands of US dollars)
 
   
As at August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
Assets
           
             
Current assets
           
Cash
  $ 22,771     $ 21,440  
Short-term investments (note 7)
    47,091       10,379  
Accounts receivable (note 7)
               
Trade
    45,151       50,190  
Other
    6,329       5,217  
Income taxes and tax credits recoverable
    5,414       2,604  
Inventories (note 8)
    52,754       40,328  
Prepaid expenses
    3,237       2,816  
Future income taxes (note 19)
    6,130       6,191  
Current assets held for sale (note 4)
          3,991  
                 
      188,877       143,156  
                 
Tax credits recoverable
    36,627       29,397  
Forward exchange contracts (note 7)
    149        
Property, plant and equipment (note 9)
    30,566       23,455  
Intangible assets (note 10)
    22,901       27,947  
Goodwill (notes 3, 5 and 10)
    30,942       29,355  
Future income taxes (note 19)
    11,024       12,884  
Long-term assets held for sale (note 4)
          7,308  
                 
    $ 321,086     $ 273,502  
Liabilities
               
                 
Current liabilities
               
Bank loan
  $ 784     $  
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities (note 12)
    32,137       30,870  
Income taxes payable
    876       426  
Current portion of long-term debt (note 13)
    645       568  
Deferred revenue
    10,590       10,354  
Current liabilities related to assets held for sale (note 4)
          2,531  
                 
      45,032       44,749  
                 
Deferred revenue
    5,704       5,775  
Long-term debt (note 13)
    968       1,419  
Other liabilities
    723       603  
Future income taxes (note 19)
    4,913        
Long-term liabilities related to assets held for sale (note 4)
          537  
                 
      57,340       53,083  
Commitments (note 14)
               
Contingency (note 15)
               
                 
Shareholders’ equity
               
Share capital (note 16)
    110,341       106,126  
Contributed surplus
    18,017       18,563  
Retained earnings
    69,877       50,528  
Accumulated other comprehensive income
    65,511       45,202  
                 
      263,746       220,419  
                 
    $ 321,086     $ 273,502  
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
 
 On behalf of the Board
 
 
 /s/ Germain Lamonde  /s/ Guy Marier
 GERMAIN LAMONDE  GUY MARIER
 Chairman, President and CEO  Chairman, Audit Committee
 
 
 
F-4


 
EXFO Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Earnings
 
(in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data)
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Sales (note 21)
  $ 269,743     $ 202,757     $ 153,082  
                         
Cost of sales (1,2) (note 8)
    100,296       73,901       57,897  
                         
Gross margin
    169,447       128,856       95,185  
                         
Operating expenses
                       
Selling and administrative (1)
    87,062       66,612       58,067  
Net research and development (1) (note 18)
    47,927       37,847       27,213  
Amortization of property, plant and equipment
    6,772       5,757       4,453  
Amortization of intangible assets
    9,183       7,773       5,033  
Restructuring charges (note 5)
                963  
Impairment of goodwill (note 5)
                21,713  
Total operating expenses
    150,944       117,989       117,442  
                         
Earnings (loss) from operations
    18,503       10,867       (22,257 )
                         
Interest and other income (expenses)
    511       (292 )     592  
Foreign exchange gain (loss)
    (3,808 )     (1,496 )     1,074  
                         
Earnings (loss) before income taxes (note 19)
    15,206       9,079       (20,591 )
                         
Income taxes (note 19)
    8,783       5,529       266  
                         
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations
    6,423       3,550       (20,857 )
                         
Net earnings from discontinued operations (note 4)
    12,926       3,069       4,272  
                         
Net earnings (loss) for the year
  $ 19,349     $ 6,619     $ (16,585 )
                         
Basic net earnings (loss) from continuing operations per share
  $ 0.11     $ 0.06     $ (0.34 )
                         
Diluted net earnings (loss) from continuing operations per share
  $ 0.10     $ 0.06     $ (0.34 )
                         
Basic net earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.32     $ 0.11     $ (0.27 )
                         
Diluted net earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.31     $ 0.11     $ (0.27 )
                         
Basic weighted average number of shares outstanding (000’s)
    60,000       59,479       61,845  
                         
Diluted weighted average number of shares outstanding (000’s) (note 20)
    61,488       60,616       61,845  
                         
(1)   Stock-based compensation costs included in:
                       
Cost of sales
  $ 224     $ 138     $ 133  
Selling and administrative
  $ 1,281     $ 1,042     $ 782  
Net research and development
  $ 487     $ 470     $ 383  
Net earnings from discontinued operations
  $ 264     $ 136     $ 111  
                         
(2)   The cost of sales is exclusive of amortization, shown separately.
 


 
 
EXFO Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)
and Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income
 
(in thousands of US dollars)
 
Comprehensive income (loss)
     
       
   
Years ended August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Net earnings (loss) for the year
  $ 19,349     $ 6,619     $ (16,585 )
Foreign currency translation adjustment
    19,399       3,728       (10,671 )
Changes in unrealized losses on short-term investments
    2             22  
Unrealized gains (losses) on forward exchange contracts
    3,413       940       (1,467 )
Reclassification of realized (gains) losses on forward exchange contracts in net earnings (loss)
    (2,191 )     (1,022 )     3,167  
Future income tax effect of the above items
    (314 )     24       (528 )
                         
Comprehensive income (loss)
  $ 39,658     $ 10,289     $ (26,062 )



Accumulated other comprehensive income
     
       
   
Years ended August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Foreign currency translation adjustment
           
Cumulative effect of prior years
  $ 44,186     $ 40,458  
Current year
    19,399       3,728  
                 
      63,585       44,186  
Unrealized gains on forward exchange contracts
               
Cumulative effect of prior years
    1,018       1,076  
Current year, net of realized gains and future income taxes
    908       (58 )
                 
      1,926       1,018  
                 
Unrealized losses on short-term investments
               
Cumulative effect of prior years
    (2 )     (2 )
Current year
    2        
                 
            (2 )
                 
Accumulated other comprehensive income
  $ 65,511     $ 45,202  

Total retained earnings and accumulated other comprehensive income amounted to $95,730 and $135,388 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
 
 
F-6

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Retained Earnings and Contributed Surplus
 
(in thousands of US dollars)
 
Retained earnings
                 
                   
   
Years ended August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Balance – Beginning of year
  $ 50,528     $ 43,909     $ 60,494  
                         
Add (deduct)
                       
Net earnings (loss) for the year
    19,349       6,619       (16,585 )
                         
Balance – End of year
  $ 69,877     $ 50,528     $ 43,909  



Contributed surplus
                 
                   
   
Years ended August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Balance – Beginning of year
  $ 18,563     $ 17,758     $ 5,226  
                         
Add (deduct)
                       
Stock-based compensation costs
    2,217       1,756       1,407  
Reclassification of stock-based compensation costs to share capital upon exercise of stock awards (note 16)
    (2,763 )     (954 )     (540 )
Discount on redemption of share capital (note 16)
          3       11,665  
                         
Balance – End of year
  $ 18,017     $ 18,563     $ 17,758  

 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
 
(in thousands of US dollars)
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Cash flows from operating activities
                 
Net earnings (loss) for the year
  $ 19,349     $ 6,619     $ (16,585 )
Add (deduct) items not affecting cash
                       
Change in discount on short-term investments
    (42 )     19       597  
Stock-based compensation costs
    2,256       1,786       1,409  
Amortization
    15,973       13,729       9,674  
Deferred revenue
    (1,262 )     3,672       1,706  
Gain on disposal of discontinued operations (note 4)
    (13,212 )            
(Gain) loss on disposal of capital assets
    (568 )           237  
Impairment of goodwill (note 5)
                21,713  
Future income taxes
    7,032       5,787       (300 )
Change in unrealized foreign exchange gain/loss
    2,130       471       (1,955 )
      31,656       32,083       16,496  
Change in non-cash operating items
                       
Accounts receivable
    10,066       (22,522 )     9,654  
Income taxes and tax credits
    (6,714 )     (4,073 )     (3,391 )
Inventories
    (8,751 )     (9,302 )     2,624  
Prepaid expenses
    (232 )     105       (350 )
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
    (2,775 )     5,168       (2,409 )
Other liabilities
    60       308        
      23,310       1,767       22,624  
Cash flows from investing activities
                       
Additions to short-term investments
    (516,674 )     (233,388 )     (438,460 )
Proceeds from disposal and maturity of short-term investments
    481,945       285,805       456,612  
Additions to capital assets
    (12,164 )     (8,966 )     (6,945 )
Proceeds from disposal of capital assets
    568              
Net proceeds from disposal of discontinued operations (note 4)
    22,063              
Business combinations, net of cash acquired (note 3)
    (1,049 )     (33,042 )     (2,414 )
      (25,311 )     10,409       8,793  
Cash flows from financing activities
                       
Bank loan
    772              
Repayment of long-term debt
    (619 )     (274 )      
Redemption of share capital
          (14 )     (26,871 )
Exercise of stock options
    1,452       343       56  
      1,605       55       (26,815 )
                         
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash
    1,058       (733 )     95  
                         
Change in cash
    662       11,498       4,697  
Cash – Beginning of year
    22,109       10,611       5,914  
Cash – End of year
  $ 22,771     $ 22,109     $ 10,611  
                         
Supplementary information
                       
Interest paid
  $ 159     $ 34     $ 23  
Income taxes paid
  $ 1,878     $ 796     $ 86  
                         
Cash related to:
                       
Continuing operations
  $ 22,771     $ 21,440     $ 9,777  
Discontinued operations (note 4)
          669       834  
    $ 22,771     $ 22,109     $ 10,611  

 
 
F-8

 

EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
 1  Nature of Activities
 
EXFO Inc. (“EXFO”) designs, manufactures and markets test and service assurance solutions for wireless and wireline network operators and equipment manufacturers in the global telecommunications industry. The company offers core-to-edge solutions to assess the performance and reliability of converged IP (Internet protocol) fixed and mobile networks. EXFO’s products are sold in approximately 100 countries around the world.
 
 
 2  Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
 
Basis of presentation
 
These consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) in Canada, and significant differences in measurement and disclosure from U.S. GAAP are set out in note 22. These consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the company and its domestic and international subsidiaries. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated.
 
Accounting estimates
 
The preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, as well as the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting years. Significant estimates include the fair value of financial instruments, the allowance for doubtful accounts receivable, the amount of tax credits recoverable, the provision for excess and obsolete inventories, the estimated useful lives of capital assets, the valuation of long-lived assets, the impairment of goodwill, the valuation allowance for future income taxes, the amount of certain accrued liabilities and deferred revenue, as well as stock-based compensation costs. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
Foreign currency translation
 
Reporting currency and self-sustaining foreign operations
 
The principal measurement currency of the company is the Canadian dollar. The company has adopted the US dollar as its reporting currency. The financial statements are translated into the reporting currency using the current rate method. Under this method, assets and liabilities of the company and its self-sustaining foreign operations with functional currency other than the US dollar are translated in US dollars using the exchange rate in effect at the balance sheet date. Revenues and expenses are translated at the monthly average exchange rate. The cumulative foreign currency translation adjustment arising from such translation is included in accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity.
 
Foreign currency transactions
 
Transactions denominated in currencies other than the measurement currency are translated into the relevant measurement currency as follows: monetary assets and liabilities are translated at the exchange rate in effect on the date of the balance sheet, and revenues and expenses are translated at the exchange rate in effect on the date of the transaction. Non-monetary assets and liabilities are translated at historical rates. Foreign exchange gains and losses arising from such translation are reflected in the statements of earnings.
 
 
 
F-9

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 

Integrated foreign operations
 
The financial statements of integrated foreign operations are remeasured into the relevant measurement currency using the temporal method. Under this method, monetary assets and liabilities are remeasured at the exchange rate in effect on the date of the balance sheet. Non-monetary assets and liabilities are remeasured at historical rates, unless such assets and liabilities are carried at market value, in which case they are remeasured at the exchange rate in effect on the date of the balance sheet. Revenues and expenses are remeasured at the monthly average exchange rate. Foreign exchange gains and losses arising from such remeasurement are reflected in the statements of earnings.
 
In the event that management decides to declare dividends, such dividends would be declared in Canadian dollars.
 
Forward exchange contracts
 
Forward exchange contracts are utilized by the company to manage its foreign currency exposure. Forward exchange contracts, which are designated as cash flow hedging instruments, qualify for hedge accounting. They are entered into by the company to hedge anticipated US dollar-denominated sales and the related accounts receivable. The company’s policy is not to utilize those derivative financial instruments for trading or speculative purposes.
 
The company’s forward exchange contracts are recorded at fair value in the balance sheet, and changes in their fair value are reported in other comprehensive income. Any ineffective portion is recognized immediately in the statements of earnings. Upon the recognition of related hedged sales, accumulated changes in fair value are reclassified in sales in the statements of earnings.
 
Short-term investments
 
All investments with original terms to maturity of three months or less and that are not required for the purposes of meeting short-term cash requirements are classified as short-term investments. Short-term investments are classified as available-for-sale securities; therefore, they are carried at fair value in the balance sheet, and any changes in their fair value are reflected in other comprehensive income. Upon the disposal or maturity of these assets, accumulated changes in their fair value are reclassified in the statements of earnings.
 
Interest income on short-term investments is recorded in the interest and other income (expenses) line item in the statements of earnings and in cash flows from operating activities in the statements of cash flows.
 
Inventories
 
Inventories are valued on an average cost basis, at the lower of cost and net realizable value.
 
Property, plant and equipment and amortization
 
Property, plant and equipment are recorded at cost, less related government grants and research and development tax credits. Amortization is provided on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives as follows:
 
   
Term
Land improvements
 
5 years
Buildings
 
20 and 25 years
Equipment
 
2 to 10 years
Leasehold improvements
 
The lesser of useful life and remaining lease term
 
 
 
F-10

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
Intangible assets, goodwill and amortization
 
Intangible assets primarily include the cost of core technology, customer relationships and software, net of accumulated amortization. Amortization is provided on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives of five years for core technology and customer relationships and four and nine years for software.
 
Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price of acquired businesses over the fair value of net identifiable assets acquired. Goodwill is not amortized but must be tested for impairment on an annual basis or more frequently if events or circumstances indicate that it might be impaired. Recoverability of goodwill is determined at the reporting unit level, using a two-step approach. First, the carrying value of a reporting unit is compared to its fair value, which is usually determined based on discounted future cash flows. If the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step is performed. In this step, the amount of impairment loss, if any, represents the excess of the carrying value of goodwill over its fair value, and the loss is charged to earnings in the period in which it is incurred. For the purposes of the impairment test, the fair value of goodwill is estimated in the same way as goodwill is determined in business combinations; that is, the excess of the fair value of a reporting unit over the fair value of its net identifiable assets. The company performs its annual impairment test in the third quarter of each fiscal year for all its existing reporting units (note 5).
 
Impairment of long-lived assets
 
Long-lived assets are reviewed for impairment when events or circumstances indicate that cost may not be recoverable, and in the period in which they are classified as held for sale. Impairment exists when the carrying value of an asset or group of assets is greater than the undiscounted future cash flows expected to be provided by the asset or group of assets. The amount of impairment loss, if any, is the excess of the carrying value over the fair value. The company usually assesses fair value of long-lived assets based on discounted future cash flows.
 
Warranty
 
The company offers its customers warranties of one to three years, depending on the specific products and terms of the purchase agreement. The company’s typical warranties require it to repair or replace defective products during the warranty period at no cost to the customer. Costs related to original warranties are accrued at the time of shipment, based upon estimates of expected rework and warranty costs to be incurred. Costs associated with separately priced extended warranties are expensed as incurred.
 
Revenue recognition
 
For all sales, the company uses a binding purchase order as evidence that a sales arrangement exists.
 
Delivery generally occurs when the product is handed over to a transporter for shipment.
 
At the time of the transaction, the company assesses whether the price associated with its revenue transaction is fixed or determinable and whether or not collection is reasonably assured. The company assesses whether the price is fixed or determinable based on the payment terms associated with the transaction. The company assesses collection based on a number of factors, including past transaction history and the creditworthiness of the customer. Generally, collateral or other security is not requested from customers.
 
Sales arrangements may include acceptance clauses. When a sales arrangement does include an acceptance provision, acceptance occurs upon the earliest of receipt of a written customer acceptance or expiration of the acceptance period. For these sales arrangements, the sale is recognized when acceptance occurs.
 
The company’s multiple deliverable revenue arrangements may include tangible products (software and/or non-software components), extended warranties, maintenance contracts, post-contract customer support (PCS) on software components as well as installation.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
Since September 1, 2010, when a sales arrangement contains multiple elements and software and non-software components function together to deliver the tangible products’ essential functionality, the company allocates revenue to each element based on the relative selling price of each element. Under this approach, the selling price of a deliverable is determined by using a selling price hierarchy which requires the use of vendor-specific objective evidence (“VSOE”) of fair value if available, third-party evidence (“TPE”) if VSOE is not available, or best estimated selling price (“BESP”) if neither VSOE nor TPE are available.
 
The company establishes VSOE of selling price using the price charged for a deliverable when sold separately and, in some instances, using the price established by management having the relevant authority. TPE of selling price is established by evaluating similar and interchangeable competitor goods or services in sales to similarly situated customers. When VSOE or TPE are not available, the company uses BESP. The company establishes BESP using historical selling price trends, if available, and considering multiple factors including, but not limited to, geography, market conditions, competitive landscape, internal costs and pricing practices. When determining BESP, the company’s management applies judgment when establishing pricing strategies and evaluating market conditions and product lifecycles. The determination of BESP is made through consultation with and approval by the company’s management. The company may modify or develop new pricing practices and strategies in the future. As these pricing strategies evolve, the company may modify its pricing practices in the future, which may result in changes in BESP. The aforementioned factors may result in a different allocation of revenue to the deliverables in multiple-element arrangements from the current period, which may change the pattern and timing of revenue recognition for these elements but will not change the total revenue recognized for the arrangement.
 
Maintenance contracts are usually offered to customers for periods of twelve to thirty-six months. They generally include the right to unspecified upgrades and enhancements on a when-and-if-available basis as well as customer service. They qualify as a separate unit of accounting. Revenue from these contracts is recognized ratably over the terms of the maintenance contracts on a straight-line basis. The selling price of the maintenance contracts is determined using VSOE.
 
Extended warranties are usually offered to customers for periods of twelve to forty-eight months. They qualify as a separate unit of accounting. Revenue from these extended warranties is recognized ratably over the warranty period on a straight-line basis. The selling price of the extended warranties is determined using BESP.
 
When a sales arrangement contains multiple elements and software and non-software components do not function together to deliver the tangible products’ essential functionality, the company allocates revenue between the tangible products and the PCS, if any, based on VSOE of selling price of each element. PCS revenues are deferred and recognized ratably over the years of the support arrangement. PCS revenues are recognized at the time the product is delivered when provided substantially within one year of delivery, the costs of providing this support are insignificant (and accrued at the time of delivery), and no (or infrequent) software upgrades or enhancements are provided.
 
Prior to September 1, 2010, for products in which software was incidental, the company recognized revenue when persuasive evidence of an arrangement existed, the product had been delivered, the price was fixed or determinable, and collection of the resulting receivable was reasonably assured. Provisions were made for estimated returns, warranties and support obligations.
 
For products in which software was not incidental, revenues were separated into two categories: product and post-contract customer support (PCS) revenues, based upon VSOE of fair value. Product revenues for these sales were recognized as described above. PCS revenues were deferred and recognized ratably over the years of the support arrangement. PCS revenues were recognized at the time the product was delivered when provided substantially within one year of delivery, the costs of providing this support were insignificant (and accrued at the time of delivery), and no (or infrequent) software upgrades or enhancements were provided.
 
Advertising costs
 
Advertising costs are expensed as incurred.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
Government grants
 
Grants related to operating expenses are included in earnings when the related expenses are incurred. Grants related to capital expenditures are deducted from the related assets. Grants are included in earnings or deducted from the related assets, provided there is reasonable assurance that the company has complied and will comply with all the conditions related to the grant.
 
Research and development expenses
 
All expenses related to research, as well as development activities that do not meet generally accepted criteria for deferral are expensed as incurred, net of related tax credits and grants. Development expenses that meet generally accepted criteria for deferral are capitalized, net of related tax credits and grants, and are amortized against earnings over the estimated benefit period. Research and development expenses are mainly comprised of salaries and related expenses, material costs as well as fees paid to third-party consultants.
 
As at August 31, 2010 and 2011, the company had not deferred any development costs.
 
Income taxes
 
The company provides for income taxes using the liability method of tax allocation. Under this method, future income tax assets and liabilities are determined based on deductible or taxable temporary differences between financial statement values and tax values of assets and liabilities as well as the carry-forward of unused tax losses and deductions, using substantively enacted income tax rates expected to be in effect for the years in which the assets are expected to be realized or the liabilities to be settled.
 
The company establishes a valuation allowance against future income tax assets if, based on available information, it is more likely than not that some or all of the future income tax assets will not be realized.
 
Earnings per share
 
Basic earnings per share are determined using the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the year.
 
Diluted earnings per share are determined using the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the year, plus the effect of dilutive potential common shares outstanding during the year. This method requires that diluted earnings per share be calculated (using the treasury stock method) as if all dilutive potential common shares had been exercised at the latest at the beginning of the year or on the date of issuance, as the case may be, and that the funds obtained thereby (plus an amount equivalent to the unamortized portion of related stock-based compensation costs) be used to purchase common shares of the company at the average market price of the common shares during the year.
 
Stock-based compensation costs
 
The company accounts for stock-based compensation on stock options, restricted share units and deferred share units, using the fair value-based method. The company accounts for stock-based compensation on stock appreciation rights, using the intrinsic value method. Stock-based compensation costs are amortized to expense over the vesting periods.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
New accounting standards and pronouncements
 
Adopted in fiscal 2011
 
In December 2009, the Canadian Institute of Chartered Accountants’ (CICA) Emerging Issues Committee (EIC) issued EIC-175, “Multiple Deliverable Revenue Arrangements”, which is applicable prospectively (with retrospective adoption permitted) to revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables entered into or materially modified in the first annual period beginning on January 1, 2011. EIC-175 amends the guidance contained in EIC-142, “Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables”, and establishes additional requirements regarding revenue recognition related to multiple deliverables as well as supplementary disclosures. The company adopted this standard prospectively to arrangements entered into on or after September 1, 2010 and at the same time it adopted similar new U.S. GAAP requirements (note 22); its adoption had no material effect on its consolidated financial statements. However, the description of the company’s revenue recognition policy has been modified accordingly.
 
To be adopted after fiscal 2011
 
The company will cease to prepare its consolidated financial statements in accordance with Canadian GAAP as set out in Part V of the CICA Handbook – Accounting ("Canadian GAAP") for the periods beginning on September 1, 2011, when it will start to apply as its primary basis of accounting the International Financial Reporting Standards published by the International Accounting Standards Board and set out in Part I of the CICA Handbook – Accounting. Consequently, future accounting changes to Canadian GAAP are not discussed in these consolidated financial statements as they will never be applied by the company.
 
 
 3  Business Combination
 
On March 12, 2010, the company acquired 91% of the issued and outstanding common shares of NetHawk Oyj. Headquartered in Oulu, Finland, NetHawk Oyj was a privately owned company providing 2G, 3G and 4G/LTE protocol analyzers and simulators aimed mostly at network equipment manufacturers and wireless network operators.
 
On March 15, 2010, the company made a voluntary offer to purchase the remaining issued and outstanding shares; this offer expired on April 30, 2010. Simultaneously, the company entered into a statutory procedure under the Finnish Companies Act by which it acquired the remaining issued and outstanding common shares that were not tendered under the voluntary offer.
 
Total consideration was comprised of a cash consideration of €37,264,000 (US$51,139,000), including acquisition-related costs of $2,842,000, or €25,121,000 (US$34,438,000), excluding NetHawk’s cash of €12,143,000 (US$16,701,000) at the acquisition date, plus a cash contingent consideration of up to €8,700,000 (US$11,000,000) based on a certain sales volume of NetHawk products over the three years following the acquisition. The cash contingent consideration will be accounted for as additional goodwill when the amounts of any contingent consideration can be reasonably estimated and the outcome of the contingency is resolved. Acquisition-related costs included an amount of $780,000 for a statutory transfer tax payable in Finland based on the purchase price of shares.
 
This acquisition was accounted for using the purchase method under CICA Handbook Section 1581, “Business Combinations”, and the requirements of Section 1600, “Consolidated Financial Statements”; consequently, the purchase price was allocated to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on management’s best estimate of their fair value as of the acquisition date. The results of operations of the acquired business have been included in the consolidated financial statements of the company since March 12, 2010, being the date of acquisition.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
The purchase price, including acquisition related costs, was allocated based on the estimated fair value of acquired net assets at the date of acquisition as follows:
 
Assets acquired, net of cash acquired
     
Accounts receivable
  $ 7,710  
Inventories
    2,315  
Other current assets
    797  
Property, plant and equipment
    2,994  
Core technology
    8,638  
Customer relationships
    7,180  
Other intangible assets
    2,033  
Current liabilities assumed
       
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
    (5,710 )
Deferred revenue
    (1,615 )
Long-term debt
    (2,464 )
Net identifiable assets acquired
    21,878  
Goodwill
    12,560  
Purchase price, net of cash acquired
  $ 34,438  
 
Acquired intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful life of five years.
 
Future income tax assets at the acquisition date amounted to $8,066,000 and were mainly comprised of net operating losses and research and development expenses carried forward. A valuation allowance of $3,065,000 was recorded against these assets at the acquisition date. In the event that the company would reverse a portion or all of the valuation allowance, the amount of such reversal would reduce the amount of goodwill recognized at the date of acquisition.
 
Acquired goodwill mainly reflects NetHawk Oyj’s acquired work force. It also reflects the competitive advantages the company expected to realize from NetHawk Oyj’s standing in the wireless protocol testing industry as well as certain synergies with the company’s service assurance products. Acquired goodwill is not deductible for tax purposes.
 
 
 4  Discontinued Operations
 
In fiscal 2010, the company engaged in a plan to sell its Life Sciences and Industrial Division to focus its activities in the telecom test and service assurance market. On October 1, 2010, the company closed the sale of that Division for total proceeds of $21,623,000, net of a bank overdraft of $303,000, selling costs of $909,000 and future income taxes of $141,000. As such, this Division has been presented as a discontinued operation in these financial statements. Assets and liabilities for the comparative year ended August 31, 2010 have been reclassified as assets held for sale and liabilities related to assets held for sale; revenues and expenses have been classified as discontinued operations for all years presented.
 
The results of the discontinued operations are as follows:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(30 days)
             
Sales
  $ 1,991     $ 25,359     $ 19,796  
Gross margin
  $ 989     $ 13,563     $ 10,801  
Earnings (loss) from operations
  $ (6 )   $ 4,281     $ 4,179  
Gain from disposal of discontinued operations
  $ 13,212     $     $  
Net earnings from discontinued operations
  $ 12,926     $ 3,069     $ 4,272  
Basic net earnings from discontinued operations per share
  $ 0.22     $ 0.05     $ 0.07  
Diluted net earnings from discontinued operations per share
  $ 0.21     $ 0.05     $ 0.07  
 
 
 
F-15

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
The assets and liabilities of the discontinued operations as at August 31, 2010 have been reclassified and are presented as assets held for sale and liabilities related to assets held for sale as follows:
 
Assets
     
       
Current assets
     
Cash
  $ 669  
Accounts receivable
    84  
Income taxes and tax credits recoverable
    188  
Inventories
    2,670  
Prepaid expenses
    158  
Future income taxes
    222  
         
Current assets held for sale
    3,991  
         
Tax credits recoverable
    2,142  
Property, plant and equipment
    349  
Intangible assets
    48  
Goodwill
    4,769  
         
Long-term assets held for sale
    7,308  
         
    $ 11,299  
Liabilities
       
         
Current liabilities related to assets held for sale
  $ 2,531  
         
Long-term liabilities related to assets held for sale
    537  
         
    $ 3,068  
 
 
 5  Special Charges
 
Impairment of goodwill
 
Recoverability of goodwill is determined at the reporting unit level, using a two-step approach. First, the carrying value of the reporting units is compared to their fair value. If the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step is performed to determine the amount of the impairment loss. Following the decrease in the company’s stock price in June 2009, the company came to the conclusion that the carrying value of one of its reporting units exceeded its fair value, and it recorded an impairment charge of $21,713,000 in fiscal 2009, to bring the goodwill of this reporting unit to its fair value. This impairment resulted in a future income tax recovery of $2,070,000.
 
Restructuring charges
 
During fiscal 2009, the company implemented a restructuring plan to align its cost structure to the existing economic and market conditions. Under that plan, the company recorded charges of $1,171,000 in severance expenses for the 65 employees who were terminated throughout the company. From that amount, $963,000 were included in the restructuring charges in the statement of earnings for the year ended August 31, 2009 and the remaining amount of $208,000 was included in net earnings from discontinued operations in the statement of earnings for that year.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
The following tables summarize changes in restructuring charges payable since August 31, 2008:
 
Year ended August 31, 2010
 
   
Balance as at
August 31, 2009
   
Additions
   
Payments
   
Balance as at
August 31, 2010
 
Fiscal 2009 plan
                       
Severance expenses
  $ 24     $     $ (24 )   $  
 
Year ended August 31, 2009
 
   
Balance as at
August 31, 2008
   
Additions
   
Payments
   
Balance as at
August 31, 2009
 
Fiscal 2009 plan
                       
Severance expenses
  $     $ 963     $ (939 )   $ 24  
                                 
Fiscal 2008 plan
                               
Severance expenses
    292             (292 )      
                                 
Total for all plans
  $ 292     $ 963     $ (1,231 )   $ 24  
 
 
 6  Capital Disclosures
 
The company is not subject to any external restrictions on its capital.
 
The company’s objectives when managing capital are:
 
·  
To maintain a flexible capital structure that optimizes the cost of capital at acceptable risk;
·  
To sustain future development of the company, including research and development activities, market development, and potential acquisitions of complementary businesses or products; and
·  
To provide the company’s shareholders with an appropriate return on their investment.
 
The company defines its capital as shareholders’ equity, excluding accumulated other comprehensive income. Accumulated other comprehensive income’s main components are the cumulative foreign currency translation adjustment, which is the result of the translation of the company’s consolidated financial statements into US dollars (the reporting currency) as well as after-tax unrealized gains (loss) on forward exchange contracts.
 
The capital of the company amounted to $175,217,000 and $198,235,000 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
 
 7  Financial Instruments
 
Financial assets and liabilities are initially recognized at fair value and their subsequent measurement depends on their classification, as described below. Their classification depends on the intended purpose when the financial instruments have been acquired or issued, as well as on their characteristics and their designation by the company.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
Classification
 
Financial assets
 
Cash
Held for trading
Short-term investments
Available for sale
Accounts receivable
Loans and receivables
Forward exchange contracts
Cash flow hedge
 
Financial liabilities
 
Bank loan
Other financial liabilities
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
Other financial liabilities
Long-term debt
Other financial liabilities
Other liabilities
Other financial liabilities
Forward exchange contracts
Cash flow hedge
 
Held for trading, available for sale and forward exchange contracts are subsequently measured at fair value. Loans and receivables and other financial liabilities are subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method.
 
Fair value hierarchy
 
The company’s cash, short-term investments and forward exchange contracts are measured at fair value at each balance sheet date. The company’s short-term investments are classified within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy because they are valued using quoted market prices in active markets. The company’s cash and forward exchange contracts are classified within level 2 of the hierarchy because they are valued using quoted prices and forward foreign exchange rates at the balance sheet date.
 
Market risk
 
Currency risk
 
The principal measurement currency of the company is the Canadian dollar. The company is exposed to currency risks as a result of its export sales of products manufactured in Canada, China and Finland, the majority of which are denominated in US dollars and euros. This risk is partially hedged by forward exchange contracts (US dollars) and certain operating expenses (US dollars and euros). Forward exchange contracts, which are designated as cash flow hedging instruments, qualify for hedge accounting.
 
As at August 31, 2011, the company held contracts to sell US dollars for Canadian dollars at various forward rates, which are summarized as follows:
 
 
 Expiry dates
 
Contractual
amounts
   
Weighted average contractual
forward rates
 
         
 
 September 2011 to August 2012
  $ 27,500       1.0555  
 
 September 2012 to July 2013
    11,400       1.0063  
 
 Total
  $ 38,900       1.0411  
 
The carrying amount of forward exchange contracts is equal to fair value, which is based on the amount at which they could be settled based on estimated current market rates. The fair value of forward exchange contracts amounted to net gains of $597,000 and $2,278,000 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)

 
Based on the portfolio of forward exchange contracts as at August 31, 2011, the company estimates that the portion of the unrealized gains on these contracts as of that date, which will be realized and reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income to net earnings over the next 12 months, amounts to $1,701,000.
 
As at August 31, 2011, forward exchange contracts, in the amount of $1,701,000, are presented as current assets in other receivable in the balance sheet and forward exchange contracts, in the amount of $149,000, are presented as long-term assets in forward exchange contracts in the balance sheet. As at August 31, 2010, forward exchange contracts, in the amount of $754,000, were presented as current assets in other receivable in the balance sheet and forward exchange contracts, in the amount of $232,000, were presented as current liabilities in the accounts payable and accrued liabilities in the balance sheet (note 12).
 
During the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, the company recognized within its sales foreign exchange gains (losses) on forward exchange contracts of ($3,178,000), $1,517,000 and $2,795,000, respectively.
 
The following table summarizes significant derivative and non-derivative financial assets and liabilities that are subject to currency risk as at August 31, 2010 and 2011:
 
   
As at August 31,
 
                         
   
2011
   
2010
 
                         
   
Carrying/
nominal
amount
(in thousands
of US dollars)
   
Carrying/
nominal
amount
(in thousands
of euros)
   
Carrying/
nominal
amount
(in thousands
of US dollars)
   
Carrying/
nominal
amount
(in thousands
of euros)
 
                         
Financial assets
                       
Cash
  $ 10,553     1,502     $ 6,947     1,287  
Accounts receivable
    25,040       4,332       30,218       3,860  
      35,593       5,834       37,165       5,147  
Financial liabilities
                               
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
    8,706       37       8,932       438  
Forward exchange contracts (nominal value)
    5,400             5,900        
      14,106       37       14,832       438  
Net exposure
  $ 21,487     5,797     $ 22,333     4,709  
 
The value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar was CA$1.0665 = US$1.00 and CA$0.9784 = US$1.00 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
The value of the Canadian dollar compared to the euro was CA$1.3515 = €1.00 and CA$1.4094 = €1.00 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
The following sensitivity analysis summarizes the effect that a change in the value of the Canadian dollar (compared to the US dollar and euro) on financial assets and liabilities denominated in US dollars and euros, would have on net earnings, net earnings per diluted share and comprehensive income, based on the foreign exchange rates as at August 31, 2010 and 2011:
 
·  
An increase (decrease) of 10% in the period-end value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar would decrease (increase) net earnings by $2,101,000, or $0.03 per diluted share, and $1,943,000, or $0.03 per diluted share, as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)

 
·  
An increase (decrease) of 10% in the period-end value of the Canadian dollar compared to the euro would decrease (increase) net earnings by $621,000, or $0.01 per diluted share, and $831,000, or $0.01 per diluted share, as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
·  
An increase (decrease) of 10% in the period-end value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar would increase (decrease) comprehensive income by $3,238,000 and $2,404,000 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
The impact of the change in the value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar and the euro on these financial assets and liabilities is recorded in the foreign exchange gain or loss line item in the consolidated statements of earnings, except for outstanding forward contracts, which impact is recorded in other comprehensive income. The change in the value of the Canadian dollar compared to the US dollar and the euro also impacts the company’s balances of income tax and tax credits recoverable or payable and future income tax assets and liabilities related to integrated foreign subsidiaries; this may result in additional and significant foreign exchange gain or loss. However, these assets and liabilities are not considered financial instruments and are excluded from the sensitivity analysis above. The foreign exchange rate fluctuations also flow through the statements of earnings line items, as a significant portion of the company’s operating expenses is denominated in Canadian dollars and euros, and the company reports its results in US dollars; that effect is not reflected in the sensitivity analysis above.
 
Interest rate risk
 
The company is exposed to interest rate risks through its short-term investments, its bank loan and its long-term debt.
 
Short-term investments
 
Short-term investments consist of the following:
 
   
As at August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Commercial paper denominated in Canadian dollars, bearing interest at annual rates of 1.0% to 1.3% in fiscal 2011 and 0.6% to 0.9% in fiscal 2010, maturing between September and November 2011 in fiscal 2011, and in September and October 2010 in fiscal 2010
  $ 31,765     $ 6,383  
Bankers acceptance denominated in Canadian dollars, bearing interest at annual rates of 1.0% to 1.2% in fiscal 2011 and 0.8% in fiscal 2010, maturing in September and November 2011 in fiscal 2011 and in September 2010 in fiscal 2010
    15,326       3,996  
    $ 47,091     $ 10,379  
 
The fair value of short-term investments based on market value amounted to $10,379,000 and $47,091,000 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
Due to their short-term maturity of usually three months or less, the company’s short-term investments are not subject to a significant fair value interest rate risk. Accordingly, change in fair value has been nominal to the degree that amortized cost has historically approximated the fair value. Any change in fair value of the company’s short-term investments, all of which are classified as available for sale, is recorded in other comprehensive income.
 
Bank loan
 
As at August 31, 2011, the company’s bank loan, in the amount of $784,000, bears interest at 7.2%. The fair value of the bank loan approximates its carrying value due to its short-term maturity.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
Long-term debt
 
As at August 31, 2011, the company’s long-term debt, in the amount of $1,613,000, bears interest at an annual rate of 2.95% and matures in December 2013 (note 13). The fair value of the long-term debt approximates its carrying value due to its relatively short-term maturity.
 
Other financial instruments
 
Cash, accounts receivable and accounts payable and accrued liabilities are non-interest-bearing financial assets and liabilities. Accounts receivable and accounts payable are financial instruments whose fair value approximates their carrying value due to their short-term maturity.
 
Credit risk
 
Financial instruments that potentially subject the company to credit risk consist of cash, short-term investments, accounts receivable and forward exchange contracts (with a positive fair value). As at August 31, 2011, the company’s short-term investments consist of debt instruments issued by twelve (nine as at August 31, 2010) high-credit quality corporations and trusts. None of these debt instruments are expected to be affected by a significant liquidity risk. The company’s cash and forward exchange contracts are held with or issued by high-credit quality financial institutions; therefore, the company considers the risk of non-performance on these instruments to be limited.
 
Generally, the company does not require collateral or other security from customers for trade accounts receivable; however, credit is extended to customers following an evaluation of creditworthiness. In addition, the company performs ongoing credit reviews of all its customers and establishes an allowance for doubtful accounts receivable when accounts are determined to be uncollectible. Allowance for doubtful accounts amounted to $1,243,000 and $1,245,000 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively. Bad debt expense amounted to $967,000, $24,000 and $91,000 for the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
In fiscal 2010 and 2011, no customer represented more than 10% of sales. In fiscal 2009, one customer represented more than 10% of sales with 13.1% ($20,049,000).
 
The following table summarizes the age of trade accounts receivable:
 
   
As at August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Current
  $ 33,149     $ 38,663  
Past due, 0 to 30 days
    7,299       6,787  
Past due, 31 to 60 days
    2,590       1,991  
Past due, more than 60 days, less allowance for doubtful accounts of $1,243 and $1,245 as at August 31, 2010 and 2011, respectively
    2,113       2,749  
Total accounts receivable
  $ 45,151     $ 50,190  
 
 
 
F-21

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
Changes in the allowance for doubtful accounts are as follows:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Balance – Beginning of year
  $ 1,243     $ 1,220  
Addition charged to earnings
    148       150  
Write-off of uncollectible accounts
    (111 )      
Recovery of uncollectible accounts
    (35 )     (127 )
                 
Balance – End of year
  $ 1,245     $ 1,243  
 
Liquidity risk
 
Liquidity risk is defined as the potential that the company cannot meet its obligations as they become due.
 
The following tables summarize the contractual maturity of the company’s derivative and non-derivative financial liabilities:
 
   
As at August 31, 2011
 
                   
   
0-12
months
   
13-24
months
   
25-36
months
 
                   
Bank loan
  $ 784     $     $  
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
    30,319              
Long-term debt
    645       645       323  
Other liabilities
          201        
Forward exchange contracts
                       
Outflow
    27,500       11,400        
Inflow
    (29,668 )     (11,725 )      
Total
  $ 29,580     $ 521     $ 323  
 
 
   
As at August 31, 2010
 
                         
   
0-12
months
   
13-24
months
   
25-36
months
   
Over 36
months
 
                         
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
  $ 29,711     $     $     $  
Long-term debt
    568       568       568       283  
Other liabilities
          295              
Forward exchange contracts
                               
Outflow
    29,500       20,400       1,500        
Inflow
    (30,141 )     (20,662 )     (1,508 )      
Total
  $ 29,638     $ 601     $ 560     $ 283  
 
As at August 31, 2011, the company had $69,862,000 in cash and short-term investments and $45,151,000 in accounts receivable. In addition to these financial assets, the company has unused available lines of credit totaling $15,465,000 for working capital and other general corporate purposes, including potential acquisitions and its share repurchase program as well as unused lines of credit of $16,465,000 for foreign currency exposure related to its forward exchange contracts (note 11).
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
 8  Inventories
 
   
As at August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Raw materials
  $ 30,280     $ 21,505  
Work in progress
    2,206       1,975  
Finished goods
    20,268       16,848  
                 
    $ 52,754     $ 40,328  
 
The cost of sales comprised almost exclusively the amount of inventory recognized as an expense during the reporting years, except for the related amortization, which is shown separately in operating expenses.
 
Inventory write-down amounted to $2,982,000, $2,664,000 and $3,577,000 for the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, respectively.
 
 
 9  Property, Plant and Equipment
 
   
As at August 31,
 
                         
   
2011
   
2010
 
                         
   
Cost
   
Accumulated
amortization
   
Cost
   
Accumulated
amortization
 
                         
Land and land improvements
  $ 4,705     $ 1,317     $ 2,287     $ 1,200  
Buildings
    17,346       5,868       14,395       4,987  
Equipment
    44,034       32,470       39,734       28,282  
Leasehold improvements
    3,255       2,061       2,976       1,468  
Asset under construction (note 14)
    2,942                    
                                 
      72,282     $ 41,716       59,392     $ 35,937  
Less:
                               
Accumulated amortization
    41,716               35,937          
                                 
    $ 30,566             $ 23,455          
 
As at August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, unpaid purchases of property, plant and equipment amounted to $348,000, $391,000 and $2,056,000, respectively.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
 10  Intangible Assets and Goodwill
 
Intangible assets
 
   
As at August 31,
 
                         
   
2011
   
2010
 
                         
   
Cost
   
Accumulated
amortization
   
Cost
   
Accumulated
amortization
 
                         
Core technology
  $ 27,215     $ 14,455     $ 34,858     $ 17,496  
Customer relationships
    7,519       2,211       6,615       622  
Brand name
    749       220       659       62  
Software
    13,722       9,418       11,557       7,562  
                                 
      49,205     $ 26,304       53,689     $ 25,742  
Less:
                               
Accumulated amortization
    26,304               25,742          
                                 
    $ 22,901             $ 27,947          
 
Estimated amortization expense for intangible assets in each of the next five fiscal years amounts to $8,203,000 in 2012, $7,034,000 in 2013, $4,658,000 in 2014, $2,488,000 in 2015 and $284,000 in 2016.
 
Additions to intangible assets for the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011 amounted to $2,543,000, $19,369,000 and $1,763,000 respectively.
 
Goodwill
 
Changes in the carrying value of goodwill are as follows:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Balance – Beginning of year
  $ 29,355     $ 17,840  
Addition from business combination (note 3)
          12,560  
Foreign currency translation adjustment
    1,587       (1,045 )
                 
Balance – End of year
  $ 30,942     $ 29,355  
 
 
 11  Credit Facilities
 
The company has lines of credit that provide for advances of up to CA$15,000,000 (US$15,331,000) and up to US$2,000,000. These lines of credit bear interest at the Canadian prime rate. As at August 31, 2011, an amount of CA$4,972,000 (US$5,082,000) was drawn from theses lines of credit for letters of guarantee in the normal course of the company’s operations. From this amount, the company had $682,000 worth of letters of guarantee for its own selling and purchase requirements, and the remainder of $4,400,000 was used by the company to secure its line of credit in CNY. These lines of credit are subject to a negative pledge whereby the company has agreed with the bank not to pledge its assets to any other party without its consent.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)

 
The company line of credit, in CNY, provides for advances of up to US$4,000,000. This line of credit bears interest at the Chinese prime rate for advances made in CNY and at LIBOR plus 3.5% for advances made in US dollars. As at August 31, 2011, an amount of CNY5,000,000 (US$784,000) was drawn from that line of credit.
 
Finally, the company has lines of credit of US$20,050,000 for the foreign currency risk exposure related to its forward exchange contracts (note 7). As at August 31, 2011, an amount of US$3,585,000 was reserved from these lines of credit. These lines of credit are renewable annually and unsecured.
 
 
 12  Accounts Payable and Accrued Liabilities
 
   
As at August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Trade
  $ 15,717     $ 14,244  
Salaries and social benefits
    12,649       12,400  
Warranty
    1,402       579  
Forward exchange contracts (note 7)
          232  
Other
    2,369       3,415  
                 
    $ 32,137     $ 30,870  
 
Changes in the warranty provision are as follows:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Balance – Beginning of year
  $ 579     $ 647  
Provision
    1,608       810  
Settlements
    (785 )     (878 )
                 
Balance – End of year
  $ 1,402     $ 579  
 
 
 13  Long-Term Debt
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Loan collateralized by assets of NetHawk Oyj denominated in euros (€1,120), bearing interest at 2.95%, repayable in semi-annual installments of $323 (€224), maturing in December 2013 (note 3)
  $ 1,613     $ 1,987  
Less: current portion
    645       568  
                 
    $ 968     $ 1,419  
 
Capital repayments required in the next three years amount to $645,000 in 2012, $645,000 in 2013 and $323,000 in 2014.
 
 
 
F-25

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
 14  Commitments
 
a) Operating leases
 
The company entered into operating leases for certain of its premises and equipment, which expire at various dates through June 2017. As at August 31, 2011, minimum rental expenses of these operating leases in each of the next five years will amount to $4,659,000 in 2012, $2,519,000 in 2013, $1,402,000 in 2014, $1,035,000 in 2015 and $662,000 in 2016. As at August 31, 2011, total commitments for these operating leases amount to $10,802,000.
 
For the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, rental expenses amounted to $2,534,000, $3,798,000 and $5,303,000, respectively.
 
b) Property, plant and equipment
 
In fiscal 2011, the company undertook the construction of a new building in Montreal, Canada. As at August 31, 2011, the company has commitments totaling $15,200,000 (CA$14,900,000) in relation to this building. The construction is expected to be completed in the third quarter of fiscal 2012.
 
 
 15  Contingency
 
On November 27, 2001, a class action suit was filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York against the company, four of the underwriters of its Initial Public Offering and some of its executive officers pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and Rule 10b-5 promulgated thereunder and Sections 11, 12 and 16 of the Securities Act of 1933. This class action alleges that the company’s registration statement and prospectus filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 29, 2000, contained material misrepresentations and/or omissions resulting from (i) the underwriters allegedly soliciting and receiving additional, excessive and undisclosed commissions from certain investors in exchange for which they allocated material portions of the shares issued in connection with the company’s Initial Public Offering; and (ii) the underwriters allegedly entering into agreements with customers whereby shares issued in connection with the company’s Initial Public Offering would be allocated to those customers in exchange for which customers agreed to purchase additional amounts of shares in the after-market at predetermined prices.
 
On April 19, 2002, the plaintiffs filed an amended complaint containing master allegations against all of the defendants in all of the 310 cases included in this class action and also filed an amended complaint containing allegations specific to four of the company’s underwriters, the company and two of its executive officers. In addition to the allegations mentioned above, the amended complaint alleges that the underwriters (i) used their analysts to manipulate the stock market; and (ii) implemented schemes that allowed issuer insiders to sell their shares rapidly after an initial public offering and benefit from high market prices. As concerns the company and its two executive officers in particular, the amended complaint alleges that (i) the company’s registration statement was materially false and misleading because it failed to disclose the additional commissions and compensation to be received by underwriters; (ii) the two named executive officers learned of or recklessly disregarded the alleged misconduct of the underwriters; (iii) the two named executive officers had motive and opportunity to engage in alleged wrongful conduct due to personal holdings of the company’s stock and the fact that an alleged artificially inflated stock price could be used as currency for acquisitions; and (iv) the two named executive officers, by virtue of their positions with the company, controlled the company and the contents of the registration statement and had the ability to prevent its issuance or cause it to be corrected. The plaintiffs in this suit seek an unspecified amount for damages suffered.
 
In July 2002, the issuers filed a motion to dismiss the plaintiffs’ amended complaint and a decision was rendered on February 19, 2003. Only one of the claims against the company was dismissed. On October 8, 2002, the claims against its officers were dismissed, without prejudice, pursuant to the terms of Reservation of Rights and Tolling Agreements entered into with the plaintiffs (the “Tolling Agreements”). Subsequent addenda to the Tolling Agreements extended the tolling period through August 27, 2010.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
In June 2004, an agreement of partial settlement was submitted to the court for preliminary approval. The proposed partial settlement was between the plaintiffs, the issuer defendants in the consolidated actions, the issuer officers and directors named as defendants, and the issuers’ insurance companies. The court granted the preliminary approval motion on February 15, 2005, subject to certain modifications. On August 31, 2005, the court issued a preliminary order further approving the modifications to the settlement and certifying the settlement classes. The court also appointed the notice administrator for the settlement and ordered that notice of the settlement be distributed to all settlement class members by January 15, 2006. The settlement fairness hearing occurred on April 24, 2006, and the court reserved decision at that time.
 
While the partial settlement was pending approval, the plaintiffs continued to litigate against the underwriter defendants. The district court directed that the litigation proceed within a number of “focus cases” rather than in all of the 310 cases that have been consolidated. The company's case is not one of these focus cases. On October 13, 2004, the district court certified the focus cases as class actions. The underwriter defendants appealed that ruling, and on December 5, 2006, the Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit reversed the district court’s class certification decision.
 
On April 6, 2007, the Second Circuit denied the plaintiffs’ petition for rehearing of that decision and, on May 18, 2007, the Second Circuit denied the plaintiffs’ petition for rehearing en banc. In light of the Second Circuit’s opinion, liaison counsel for all issuer defendants, including the company, informed the court that this settlement cannot be approved, because the defined settlement class, like the litigation class, cannot be certified. On June 25, 2007, the district court entered an order terminating the settlement agreement. On August 14, 2007, the plaintiffs filed their second consolidated amended class action complaints against the focus cases and, on September 27, 2007, again moved for class certification. On November 12, 2007, certain defendants in the focus cases moved to dismiss the second consolidated amended class action complaints. On March 26, 2008, the district court denied the motions to dismiss, except as to Section 11 claims raised by those plaintiffs who sold their securities for a price in excess of the initial offering price and those who purchased outside of the previously certified class period. Briefing on the class certification motion was completed in May 2008. That motion was withdrawn without prejudice on October 10, 2008.
 
On April 2, 2009, a stipulation and agreement of settlement between the plaintiffs, issuer defendants and underwriter defendants was submitted to the Court for preliminary approval. The Court granted the plaintiffs’ motion for preliminary approval and preliminarily certified the settlement classes on June 10, 2009. The settlement fairness hearing was held on September 10, 2009. On October 6, 2009, the Court entered an opinion granting final approval to the settlement and directing that the Clerk of the Court close these actions. On August 26, 2010, based on the expiration of the tolling period stated in the Tolling Agreements, the plaintiffs filed a Notice of Termination of Tolling Agreement and Recommencement of Litigation against the two named executive officers. The plaintiffs stated to the Court that they do not intend to take any further action against the named executive officers at this time. Appeals of the opinion granting final approval were filed, all of which were disposed of except the appeals filed by one objector were remanded to the district court to determine standing to appeal. On August 25, 2011, the district court issued an order holding that the final objector had no standing to appeal.  The objector has appealed that decision.  Given that the district court’s August 25, 2011 remains subject to appeal, the ultimate outcome of the contingency is uncertain. However, based on the settlement approved on October 6, 2009, and the related insurance against such claims, management has determined the impact to its financial position and results of operations as at and for the year ended August 31, 2011 to be immaterial.
 
 
 16  Share Capital
 
Authorized – unlimited as to number, without par value
 
Subordinate voting and participating, bearing a non-cumulative dividend to be determined by the Board of Directors, ranking pari passu with multiple voting shares
 
Multiple voting and participating, entitling to 10 votes each, bearing a non-cumulative dividend to be determined by the Board of Directors, convertible at the holder’s option into subordinate voting shares on a one-for-one basis, ranking pari passu with subordinate voting shares
 
 
 
F-27

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)

 
The following table summarizes the share capital activity since August 31, 2008:
 
   
Multiple voting shares
   
Subordinate voting shares
       
   
Number
   
Amount
   
Number
   
Amount
   
Total
amount
 
                               
Balance as at August 31, 2008
    36,643,000     $ 1       30,783,705     $ 142,785     $ 142,786  
                                         
Exercise of stock options (note 17)
                27,500       56       56  
Redemption of restricted share units (note 17)
                106,190              
Reclassification of stock-based compensation costs to share capital upon exercise of stock awards
                      540       540  
Redemption of share capital
                (8,181,093 )     (38,536 )     (38,536 )
                                         
Balance as at August 31, 2009
    36,643,000       1       22,736,302       104,845       104,846  
                                         
Exercise of stock options (note 17)
                83,700       343       343  
Redemption of restricted share units (note 17)
                120,307              
Reclassification of stock-based compensation costs to share capital upon exercise of stock awards
                      954       954  
Redemption of share capital
                (3,600 )     (17 )     (17 )
                                         
Balance as at August 31, 2010
    36,643,000       1       22,936,709       106,125       106,126  
                                         
Conversion of multiple voting shares into subordinate voting shares
    (5,000,000 )           5,000,000              
Exercise of stock options (note 17)
                306,825       1,452       1,452  
Redemption of restricted share units (note 17)
                340,974              
Redemption of deferred shares units (note 17)
                37,491              
Reclassification of stock-based compensation costs to share capital upon exercise of stock awards
                      2,763       2,763  
                                         
Balance as at August 31, 2011
    31,643,000     $ 1       28,621,999     $ 110,340     $ 110,341  
 
 
a)
On November 6, 2008, the company announced that its Board of Directors had authorized a renewal of its share repurchase program, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market, of up to 10% of its public float (as defined by the Toronto Stock Exchange), or 2,738,518 subordinate voting shares, at the prevailing market price. The period of the normal course issuer bid commenced on November 10, 2008, and ended on November 9, 2009. The company redeemed for cancellation 488,786 subordinate voting shares for an aggregate net purchase price of $1,416,000 under that program.
 
 
b)
On November 10, 2008, the company announced that its Board of Directors had authorized a substantial issuer bid (the “Offer”) to purchase for cancellation subordinate voting shares for an aggregate purchase price not to exceed CA$30,000,000. On December 18, 2008, pursuant to the Offer, the company purchased for cancellation 7,692,307 subordinate voting shares for the aggregate purchase price of CA$30,000,000 (US$24,879,000), plus related fees of $576,000.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)

 
 
c)
On November 6, 2009, the company announced that its Board of Directors had authorized the second renewal of its share repurchase program, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market, of up to 10% of its public float (as defined by the Toronto Stock Exchange), or 2,256,431 subordinate voting shares, at the prevailing market price. The period of the normal course issuer bid started on November 10, 2009, and ended on November 9, 2010. The company redeemed for cancellation 3,600 shares under that program for an aggregate net purchase price of $14,000.

 
d)
On November 5, 2010, the company announced that its Board of Directors had authorized the third renewal of its share repurchase program, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market, of up to 10% of its public float (as defined by the Toronto Stock Exchange), or 2,012,562 subordinate voting shares, at the prevailing market price. The period of the normal course issuer bid started on November 10, 2010, and will end on November 9, 2011. As at November 7, 2011, the company had redeemed for cancellation 25,055 shares under that program for an aggregate net purchase price of $144,197.

 
e)
On November 7, 2011 the company announced that its Board of Directors approved the fourth renewal of its share repurchase program, by way of a normal course issuer bid on the open market of up to 2% of issued and outstanding subordinate voting share, representing 575,690 subordinate voting shares at the prevailing market price. The company expects to use cash, short-term investments or future cash flow from operations to fund the repurchase of shares. The normal course issuer bid will start on November 10, 2011, and will end on November 9, 2012, or on an earlier date if the company repurchases the maximum number of shares permitted under the bid. The program does not require that the company repurchases any specific number of shares, and it may be modified, suspended or terminated at any time and without prior notice. All shares repurchased under the bid will be cancelled.
 
 
 17  Stock-Based Compensation Plans
 
The maximum number of additional subordinate voting shares issuable under the Long-Term Incentive Plan and the Deferred Share Unit Plan cannot exceed 6,306,153 shares. The maximum number of subordinate voting shares that may be granted to any individual on an annual basis cannot exceed 5% of the number of outstanding subordinate voting shares. The company settles stock options and redeems restricted share units and deferred share units through the issuance of common shares from treasury.
 
The total stock-based compensation costs included in the statements of earnings for the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011 amounted to $1,409,000, $1,786,000 and $2,256,000, respectively.
 
Long-Term Incentive Plan
 
In May 2000, the company established a Stock Option Plan for directors, executive officers and employees and those of the company’s subsidiaries, as determined by the Board of Directors. In January 2005, the company made certain amendments to the existing Stock Option Plan, including the renaming of the plan to Long-Term Incentive Plan, which includes stock options and restricted share units. This plan was approved by the shareholders of the company.
 
Stock Options
 
The exercise price of stock options granted under the Long-Term Incentive Plan is the market price of the common shares on the date of grant. Stock options granted under the plan generally expire 10 years from the date of grant and vest over a four-year period, being the required period of service from employees, generally with 25% vesting on an annual basis commencing on the first anniversary of the date of grant. The Board of Directors may accelerate the vesting of any or all outstanding stock options upon the occurrence of a change of control.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
The following table summarizes stock option activity since August 31, 2008:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                                     
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                                     
   
Number
   
Weighted
average
exercise
price
   
Number
   
Weighted
average
exercise
price
   
Number
   
Weighted
average
exercise
price
 
         
(CA$)
         
(CA$)
         
(CA$)
 
Outstanding – Beginning of year
    1,348,787     $ 19       1,666,589     $ 21       1,821,481     $ 21  
Exercised
    (306,825 )     5       (83,700 )     4       (27,500 )     3  
Forfeited
    (43,541 )     14                   (1,000 )     6  
Expired
    (357,064 )     48       (234,102 )     36       (126,392 )     26  
                                                 
Outstanding – End of year
    641,357     $ 9       1,348,787     $ 19       1,666,589     $ 21  
                                                 
Exercisable – End of year
    641,357     $ 9       1,348,787     $ 19       1,660,090     $ 21  
 
The intrinsic value of stock options exercised during fiscal 2009, 2010 and 2011 was $23,000, $73,000 and $603,000, respectively.
 
The following table summarizes information about stock options as at August 31, 2011:
 
     
Stock options outstanding and exercisable
 
                           
Exercise price
   
Number
   
Weighted
average
exercise price
   
Intrinsic
 value
   
Weighted
average
remaining
contractual life
 
(CA$)
         
(CA$)
   
(CA$)
       
$ 2.50       112,025     $ 2.50     $ 453    
1 year
 
$ 4.64 to $6.28       243,529       5.48       261    
3 years
 
$ 9.02       10,000       9.02          
1 year
 
$ 14.27 to $20.00       275,803       15.73              
                                     
          641,357     $ 9.42     $ 714    
1 year
 
 
Restricted Share Units (RSUs)
 
RSUs are stock awards that rise and fall in value based on the market price of the company’s subordinate voting shares and are redeemable for actual subordinate voting shares or cash at the discretion of the Board of Directors as determined on the date of grant. Vesting dates are also established by the Board of Directors on the date of grant. The vesting dates are subject to a minimum term of three years and a maximum term of 10 years from the award date, being the required period of service from employees. Fair value of RSUs equals the market price of the common shares on the date of grant. This plan was approved by the shareholders of the company.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
The following table summarizes RSU activity since August 31, 2008:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Outstanding – Beginning of year
    1,603,048       1,339,619       847,791  
Granted
    350,382       415,538       685,972  
Redeemed
    (340,974 )     (120,307 )     (106,190 )
Forfeited
    (60,798 )     (31,802 )     (87,954 )
                         
Outstanding – End of year
    1,551,658       1,603,048       1,339,619  
 
None of the RSUs outstanding, as at August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, were redeemable. The weighted average grant-date fair value of RSUs granted during fiscal 2009, 2010 and 2011 amounted to $2.69, $4.50 and $7.26, respectively.
 
As at August 31, 2011, the intrinsic value of RSUs outstanding was $10,381,000.
 
Expected forfeitures are immaterial to the company and are not reflected in the determination of stock-based compensation costs.
 
As at August 31, 2011, unrecognized stock-based compensation costs of unvested RSUs amounted to $3,953,000. The weighted average period over which they are expected to be recognized is 2 years.
 
Deferred Share Unit Plan
 
In January 2005, the company established a Deferred Share Unit (DSU) Plan for the members of the Board of Directors as part of their annual retainer fees. Each DSU entitles the Board members to receive one subordinate voting share. DSUs are acquired on the date of grant and will be redeemed in subordinate voting shares when the Board member will cease to be Director of the company. This plan was approved by the shareholders of the company.
 
The following table summarizes DSU activity since August 31, 2008:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Outstanding – Beginning of year
    135,003       114,924       79,185  
Granted
    12,786       20,079       35,739  
Redeemed
    (37,491 )            
                         
Outstanding – End of year
    110,298       135,003       114,924  
 
None of the DSUs outstanding as at August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011 were redeemable. The weighted average grant-date fair value of DSUs granted during fiscal 2009, 2010 and 2011 amounted to $3.19, $4.79 and $7.87, respectively.
 
As at August 31, 2011, the intrinsic value of DSUs outstanding was $738,000.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
Stock Appreciation Rights Plan
 
In August 2001, the company established the Stock Appreciation Rights Plan for certain employees. Under that plan, eligible employees are entitled to receive a cash amount equivalent to the difference between the market price of the common shares on the date of exercise and the exercise price determined on the date of grant. Stock appreciation rights granted under the plan generally expire 10 years from the date of grant and generally vest over a four-year period, being the required period of service from employees, with 25% vesting on an annual basis commencing on the first anniversary of the date of grant. This plan was approved by the shareholders of the company.
 
The following table summarizes stock appreciation rights activity since August 31, 2008:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                                     
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                                     
   
Number
   
Weighted
average
exercise
price
   
Number
   
Weighted
average
exercise
price
   
Number
   
Weighted
average
exercise
price
 
                                     
Outstanding – Beginning of year
    44,374     $ 8       40,374     $ 8       30,700     $ 10  
Granted
    4,500             4,000       4       9,674       2  
Exercised
    (14,750 )     5                          
Expired
    (5,000 )     34                          
                                                 
Outstanding – End of year
    29,124     $ 3       44,374     $ 8       40,374     $ 8  
                                                 
Exercisable – End of year
    10,075     $ 5       28,318     $ 10       24,475     $ 11  
 
In fiscal 2011, the company paid $73,000 upon the exercise of stock appreciation rights (nil in 2009 and 2010).
 
The following table summarizes information about stock appreciation rights as at August 31, 2011:
 
     
Stock appreciation
rights outstanding
 
Stock appreciation
rights exercisable
 
                 
Exercise price
   
Number
 
Weighted average
remaining contractual
life
 
Number
 
                 
$    –       4,500  
9 years
     
$ 2.36       9,674  
7 years
    6,500  
$ 3.74 to $4.65       10,500  
5 years
    3,575  
$ 6.28 to $6.50       4,450  
5 years
     
                       
          29,124  
6 years
    10,075  
 
 
 
F-32

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
 18  Other Disclosures
 
Net research and development expenses
 
Net research and development expenses comprise the following:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Gross research and development expenses
  $ 57,226     $ 44,551     $ 33,584  
Research and development tax credits and grants
    (9,299 )     (6,704 )     (6,371 )
                         
    $ 47,927     $ 37,847     $ 27,213  
 
Government grants
 
The company is entitled to receive grants on certain eligible research and development projects conducted in Finland from TEKES, a Finnish technology organization, which is funding Finnish companies’ high technology, research and innovations. The company’s eligible research and development projects must be pre-approved by TEKES and the grant is subject to certain conditions. In the event a condition is not met, TEKES can require reimbursement of a portion or the entire amount of the grant received. A liability to repay the funding is recognized in the period in which conditions arise that will cause the funding to be repayable. As at August 31, 2011, the company was in compliance with the conditions of the funding. This funding is presented as a reduction of gross research and development expenses in the statements of earnings. In fiscal 2009, 2010 and 2011, the company recorded nil, $875,000 and $2,085,000, respectively, under that program in the statements of earnings.
 
Defined contribution plans
 
The company maintains separate defined contribution plans for certain eligible employees. These plans, which are accounted for on an accrual basis, are summarized as follows:
 
·  
Deferred profit-sharing plan
 
The company maintains a plan for certain eligible employees residing in Canada, under which the company may elect to contribute an amount equal to 3% (2% prior to January 2011) of an employee’s gross salary, provided that the employee has contributed at least 3% (2% prior to January 2011) of his gross salary to a tax-deferred registered retirement savings plan. Cash contributions to this plan and expenses for the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, amounted to $504,000, $592,000 and $911,000, respectively.
 
 
·  
401K plan
 
The company maintains a 401K plan for eligible employees residing in the U.S. Under this plan, the company must contribute an amount equal to 3% of an employee’s current compensation. In addition, eligible employees may contribute up to the lesser of 1% of eligible compensation or the statutorily prescribed annual limit to the 401K plan. The 401K plan permits, but does not require the company to make additional matching contributions to the 401K plan on behalf of the eligible participants, subject to a maximum of 50% of the first 6% of the participant’s current compensation subject to certain legislated maximum contribution limits. During the years ended August 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, the company recorded cash contributions and expenses totaling $544,000, $525,000 and $680,000, respectively.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
 19  Income Taxes
 
The reconciliation of the income tax provision calculated using the combined Canadian federal and provincial statutory income tax rate with the income tax provision in the financial statements is as follows:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Income tax provision at the combined Canadian federal and provincial statutory tax rate (29% in 2011, 30% in 2010 and 31% in 2009)
  $ 4,410     $ 2,724     $ (6,383 )
                         
Increase (decrease) due to:
                       
Foreign income taxed at different rates
    (327 )     (459 )     56  
Non-taxable income
    (3,404 )     (787 )     (211 )
Non-deductible expenses
    916       851       5,200  
Change in tax rates
          97        
Foreign exchange effect of translation of foreign integrated subsidiaries
    2,541       (55 )     189  
Other
    (402 )     (27 )     638  
Utilization of previously unrecognized  future income tax assets
    (61 )     (349 )     (68 )
Unrecognized future income tax assets on temporary deductible differences and unused tax losses and deductions
    5,110       3,534       845  
                         
    $ 8,783     $ 5,529     $ 266  
The income tax provision consists of the following:
                       
Current
                       
Canada
  $ 9     $ 13     $ 87  
Other
    1,916       702       500  
                         
      1,925       715       587  
Future
                       
Canada
    5,999       4,316       1,045  
Finland
    (3,156 )     (928 )      
United States
    (738 )     (1,501 )     (2,511 )
Other
    (296 )     (258 )     368  
                         
      1,809       1,629       (1,098 )
Valuation allowance
                       
Canada
    426       7       236  
Finland
    3,156       928        
United States
    1,426       2,203       604  
Other
    41       47       (63 )
                         
      5,049       3,185       777  
      6,858       4,814       (321 )
                         
    $ 8,783     $ 5,529     $ 266  
The income tax provision for the discontinued operations is as follows:
                       
Current
  $ 27     $ 163     $ (25 )
Future
    (6,649 )     972       21  
Valuation allowance
    6,823              
                         
    $ 201     $ 1,135     $ (4 )
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 

   
Years ended August 31,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Details of the company’s income taxes:
                 
Earnings (loss) before income taxes
                 
Canada
  $ 21,894     $ 12,403     $ (15,611 )
Finland
    (14,760 )     (1,921 )      
United States
    3,128       (4,546 )     (5,026 )
Other
    4,944       3,143       46  
    $ 15,206     $ 9,079     $ (20,591 )
 
Significant components of the company’s future income tax assets and liabilities are as follows:
 
   
As at August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Future income tax assets
           
Long-lived assets
  $ 5,262     $ 5,473  
Provisions and accruals
    3,279       3,797  
Deferred revenue
    1,983       1,983  
Research and development expenses
    5,515       9,954  
Losses carried forward
    45,584       34,322  
                 
      61,623       55,529  
                 
Valuation allowance
    (34,516 )     (21,277 )
                 
      27,107       34,252  
                 
Future income tax liabilities
               
Research and development tax credits
    (9,698 )     (7,793 )
Long-lived assets
    (5,168 )     (7,161 )
Deferred revenue
          (223 )
                 
      (14,866 )     (15,177 )
                 
Future income tax assets, net
  $ 12,241     $ 19,075  
 
 
 
F-35

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
As at August 31, 2011, the company had available operating losses in several tax jurisdictions, against which a valuation allowance of $20,889,000 was recorded. The valuation allowance includes $8,321,000 for which subsequently recognized benefits will be allocated to reduce goodwill. The following table summarizes the year of expiry of these losses by tax jurisdiction:
 
   
Canada
                   
Year of expiry
 
Federal
   
Provincial
   
Finland
   
United States
   
Other
 
                               
2012
  $     $     $ 2,417     $     $  
2013
                8,096              
2014
                4,896              
2015
    1,217       1,217       3,172             67  
2016
                            75  
2017
                4             4  
2018
                418             103  
2019
                      741       86  
2020
                10,197       3,470        
2021
                7,997       10,202        
2022
                      7,434        
2023
                      6,033        
2024
                      3,954        
2025
                      8,449        
2026
    1,099       1,099             4,126        
2027
    1,394       1,394             1,355        
2028
                      2,472        
2029
                      2,621        
2030
    12       12             2,713        
2031
    39       39             664        
Indefinite
                      8,824       5,137  
                                         
    $ 3,761     $ 3,761     $ 37,197     $ 63,058     $ 5,472  
 
Furthermore, as at August 31, 2011, the company had available capital losses in Canada amounting to $73,886,000 at the federal level and $74,251,000 at the provincial level, against which a valuation allowance of $9,930,000 was recorded.
 
As at August 31, 2011, in addition to operating and capital losses, the company had available research and development expenses in several tax jurisdictions. The following table summarizes the carry-forward period of theses research and development expenses by tax jurisdiction:
 
   
Canada
             
Carry-forward period
 
Federal
   
Provincial
   
Finland
   
United States
 
                         
2012
  $     $     $ 1,806     $  
2013
                1,375       1,726  
2014
                724       1,404  
2015
                113       997  
2016
                      553  
Indefinite
    12,293       5,925              
                                 
    $ 12,293     $ 5,925     $ 4,018     $ 4,680  
 
A valuation allowance of $2,917,000 was recorded against these assets for which subsequently recognized benefits will be allocated to reduce goodwill.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
In the event the company does not generate sufficient taxable income to use the available research and development expenses at the expiry of the carry-forward period in Finland and United States, the unused portion of these expenses will be included in operating losses and deferred over the losses statutory carry-forward period.
 
Finally, as at August 31, 2011, the company had non-refundable research and development tax credits in the amount of $36,620,000. The following table summarizes the year of expiry of these non-refundable research and development tax credits by tax jurisdiction:
 
   
Canada
 
Year of expiry
 
Federal
   
Provincial
 
             
2018
  $ 537     $  
2019
    1,170        
2020
    1,541        
2021
    1,774        
2022
    1,498        
2023
    1,532        
2024
    391        
2025
    3,074        
2026
    3,425        
2027
    3,931        
2028
    4,306        
2029
    4,443       280  
2030
    4,045       206  
2031
    4,237       230  
                 
    $ 35,904     $ 716  
 
 
 20  Earnings per Share
 
The following table summarizes the reconciliation of the basic weighted average number of shares outstanding and the diluted weighted average number of shares outstanding:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
Basic weighted average number of shares outstanding (000’s)
    60,000       59,479       61,845  
Plus dilutive effect of (000’s):
                       
Stock options
    266       228       131  
Restricted share units
    1,106       786       311  
Deferred share units
    116       123       94  
                         
Diluted weighted average number of shares outstanding (000’s)
    61,488       60,616       62,381  
                         
Stock awards excluded from the calculation of the diluted weighted average number of shares outstanding because their exercise price was greater than the average market price of the common shares (000’s)
    381       960       1,602  
 
For the year ended August 31, 2009, the diluted amount per share was the same amount as the basic amount per share since the dilutive effect of stock options, restricted share units and deferred share units was not included in the calculation; otherwise, the effect would have been antidilutive. Accordingly, the diluted amount per share for this year was calculated using the basic weighted average number of shares outstanding.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
 21  Segment Information
 
As a result of the disposal of the Life Sciences and Industrial Division in fourth quarter of 2010, the company has only one reportable segment.
 
Sales to external customers by geographic region are detailed as follows:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
                   
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                   
United States
  $ 89,240     $ 76,669     $ 61,757  
Canada
    30,986       18,278       17,331  
Latin America
    17,303       11,454       7,729  
                         
Americas
    137,529       106,401       86,817  
                         
United Kingdom
    15,617       10,936       6,188  
Other
    69,698       49,288       36,466  
                         
Europe, Middle-East and Africa
    85,315       60,224       42,654  
                         
China
    25,799       17,610       13,784  
Other
    21,100       18,522       9,827  
                         
Asia-Pacific
    46,899       36,132       23,611  
                         
    $ 269,743     $ 202,757     $ 153,082  
 
Sales were allocated to geographic regions based on the country of residence of the related customers.
 
Long-lived assets by geographic region are detailed as follows:
 
   
As at August 31,
 
             
   
2011
   
2010
 
                                     
   
Property,
plant and
equipment
   
Intangible
assets
   
Goodwill
   
Property,
plant and
equipment
   
Intangible
assets
   
Goodwill
 
                                     
Canada
  $ 19,696     $ 3,164     $     $ 13,753     $ 3,316     $  
United States
    1,402       4,834       17,782       1,829       7,828       17,782  
Finland
    1,544       13,324       13,160       1,606       14,906       11,573  
India
    4,709       43             3,134       43        
China
    2,696       27             2,665       33        
Other
    519       1,509             468       1,821        
                                                 
    $ 30,566     $ 22,901     $ 30,942     $ 23,455     $ 27,947     $ 29,355  
 
 
 
F-38

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
 22  United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles
 
As a registrant with the Securities and Exchange Commission in the United States (SEC), the company is required to reconcile its consolidated financial statements for significant differences in measurement and disclosure between generally accepted accounting principles as applied in Canada (Canadian GAAP) and those applied in the United States (U.S. GAAP). Furthermore, additional significant disclosures required under U.S. GAAP and Regulation S-X of the SEC are also provided in the accompanying consolidated financial statements and notes. The following summarizes the significant quantitative differences between Canadian and U.S. GAAP, as well as other significant disclosures required under U.S. GAAP and Regulation S-X of the SEC not already provided in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.
 
Reconciliation of net earnings (loss) and comprehensive income (loss) to conform to U.S. GAAP
 
The following summary sets out the significant differences between the company’s reported net earnings (loss), net earnings (loss) per share and comprehensive income (loss) under Canadian GAAP as compared to U.S. GAAP. Refer to corresponding explanatory notes in the Reconciliation Items section.
 
         
Years ended August 31,
 
                         
         
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
                         
Net earnings (loss) for the year in accordance with Canadian GAAP
        $ 19,349     $ 6,619     $ (16,585 )
Gain on disposal of discontinued operations
    a )     4,130              
Acquisition-related costs on business combination
    b )           (2,842 )      
Impairment of goodwill
    c )                 8,406  
Changes in fair value of cash contingent consideration
    b )     2,685              
                                 
Net earnings (loss) for the year in accordance with U.S. GAAP
            26,164       3,777       (8,179 )
                                 
Foreign currency translation adjustment
    b )     19,264       3,952       (10,671 )
Changes in unrealized losses on available-for-sale securities
            2             22  
Unrealized gains (losses) on forward exchange contracts
            3,413       940       (1,467 )
Reclassification of realized (gains) losses on forward exchange contracts in net earnings (loss)
            (2,191 )     (1,022 )     3,167  
Future income taxes effect of the above items
            (314 )     24       (528 )
                                 
Comprehensive income (loss) under U.S. GAAP
          $ 46,338     $ 7,671     $ (17,656 )
                                 
U.S. GAAP net earnings (loss) are comprised of:
                               
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations
          $ 9,108     $ 708     $ (12,451 )
Net earnings from discontinued operations
            17,056       3,069       4,272  
            $ 26,164     $ 3,777     $ (8,179 )
                                 
Basic net and diluted earnings (loss) from continuing operations per share in accordance with U.S. GAAP
          $ 0.15     $ 0.01     $ (0.20 )
Basic and diluted net earnings from discontinued operations per share in accordance with U.S. GAAP
          $ 0.28     $ 0.05     $ 0.07  
Basic net earnings (loss) per share in accordance with U.S. GAAP
          $ 0.44     $ 0.06     $ (0.13 )
Diluted net earnings (loss) per share in accordance with U.S. GAAP
          $ 0.43     $ 0.06     $ (0.13 )

 
F-39

 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
Reconciliation of shareholders’ equity to conform to U.S. GAAP
 
The following summary sets out the significant differences between the company’s reported shareholders’ equity under Canadian GAAP as compared to U.S. GAAP. Refer to the corresponding explanatory note in the Reconciliation Items section.
 
         
As at August 31,
 
                   
         
2011
   
2010
 
                   
Shareholders’ equity in accordance with Canadian GAAP
        $ 263,746     $ 220,419  
Goodwill
    c )     47       42  
Long-term assets held for sale
    c )           (3,988 )
Cash contingent consideration payable
    b )     (338 )     (2,660 )
Stock appreciation rights
    d )     (73 )     (73 )
                         
Shareholders’ equity in accordance with U.S. GAAP
          $ 263,382     $ 213,740  
 
Statements of cash flows
 
For the years ended August 31, 2010 and 2011, cash flows from operating activities under U.S. GAAP were $2,310,000 and $445,000 lower, respectively, compared to those established under Canadian GAAP; this difference arose from NetHawk’s acquisition-related costs paid during these years and expensed under U.S. GAAP (see reconciliation item b) below). Corresponding differences also impacted cash flows from investing activities. In addition, under U.S. GAAP, the presentation of subtotal before change in non-cash operating items is not permitted.
 
For the year ended August 31, 2009, there were no significant differences between the statements of cash flows under Canadian GAAP as compared to U.S. GAAP, except for the subtotal before change in non-cash operating items, whose presentation is not permitted under U.S. GAAP.
 
Reconciliation items
 
a)  
Gain on disposal of discontinued operations
 
Under U.S. GAAP, the carrying value of goodwill of the Life Sciences and Industrial Division (discontinued operations) was $4,130,000 lower than the carrying value under Canadian GAAP. As a result, under U.S. GAAP, the gain on the disposal of that Division was higher for the same amount (see reconciliation item c)).
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)
 
 
b)  
Business combination
 
The acquisition of NetHawk Oyj has been accounted for using the purchase method under CICA Handbook Section 1581, “Business Combinations”, and the requirements of Section 1600, “Consolidated Financial Statements”. Under U.S. GAAP, this acquisition has been accounted for under ASC Topic 805, “Business Combinations”, and ASC Topic 810, “Consolidation”. Accounting for business combinations under U.S. GAAP differs from CICA Handbook Section 1581. As a result, acquisition-related costs are not included as part of the purchase price but rather expensed as incurred. Consequently, acquisition-related costs of $2,842,000 were expensed during the year ended August 31, 2010 under U.S. GAAP with a corresponding reduction of goodwill. In addition, under U.S. GAAP, any contingent consideration needs to be accounted for at fair value on the acquisition date and remeasured at each reporting period, with any change in its fair value recorded in the statement of earnings. Under Canadian GAAP, a contingent consideration is recorded when management can reasonably estimate the amount and the outcome of the contingency is determined beyond reasonable doubt. The fair value of the cash contingent consideration payable for this acquisition was estimated at €2,099,000 (US$2,660,000) on the acquisition date and recorded in long-term liabilities under U.S. GAAP, with a corresponding increase of goodwill. The fair value of the cash contingent consideration has been reassessed as at August 31, 2010 and there was no change since the acquisition. The fair value on the acquisition date and as at August 31, 2010 was based on discounted estimated sales of certain products of NetHawk over the three-year period following the acquisition. The fair value of the cash contingent consideration was remeasured and estimated to €235,000 (US$338,000) as at August 31, 2011 based on actual sales since the acquisition and forecasted sales from September 2011 to December 2012. The decrease in the fair value of the cash contingent consideration in the amount of €1,864,000 (US$2,685,000) was recognized in the statement of earnings for the year ended August 31, 2011. The fair value of the cash contingent consideration is determined based on management’s best estimate of sales.
 
As a result of these GAAP differences, the foreign currency translation adjustment for the year ended August 31, 2011 was $135,000 lower under U.S. GAAP compared to the amount recognized under Canadian GAAP.
 
c)  
Goodwill
 
Under U.S. GAAP, until the adoption of SFAS 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets”, when assets being tested for recoverability were acquired in business combinations accounted for by the purchase method, the goodwill that arose in these transactions had to be included as part of the asset grouping in determining recoverability. The intangible assets tested for recoverability prior to the adoption of SFAS 142 were acquired in business combinations that were accounted for using the purchase method and, consequently, the company allocated goodwill to those assets on a pro rata basis, using the relative fair values of the long-lived assets and identifiable intangible assets acquired as determined at the date of acquisition. The carrying value of goodwill identified with the impaired intangible assets was written down before any reduction was made to the intangible assets.
 
Under Canadian GAAP, no allocation of goodwill was required and each asset was tested for recoverability separately based on its pre-tax undiscounted future cash flows over its expected period of use.
 
As a result of this difference, goodwill under U.S. GAAP was lower compared to Canadian GAAP. Consequently, the amount of goodwill impairment recorded in fiscal 2009 was lower under U.S. GAAP as compared to the amount recorded under Canadian GAAP.
 
d)  
Stock-based compensation costs related to stock appreciation rights
 
Under U.S. GAAP, stock-based compensation costs related to stock appreciation rights must be measured using the fair value-based method at the end of each period. The company uses the Black-Scholes options valuation model to measure the fair value of its stock appreciation rights. Under Canadian GAAP, stock appreciation rights are measured using the intrinsic value method, based on the market price of the common shares at the end of each period, and changes in the intrinsic value of these awards are charged to earnings.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)

 
e)  
Research and development tax credits
 
Under Canadian GAAP, all research and development tax credits are recorded as a reduction of gross research and development expenses in the statements or earnings. Under U.S. GAAP, tax credits that are refundable against income taxes otherwise payable are recorded in the income taxes. These tax credits amounted to $4,032,000, $3,656,000 and $4,226,000 for fiscal 2009, 2010 and 2011, respectively. This difference has no impact on the net earnings (loss) and the net earnings (loss) per share figures for the reporting years.
 
f)  
Gross margin
 
The cost of sales is exclusive of amortization, shown separately in the statements of earnings. Under U.S. GAAP, the presentation of the gross margin line item, exclusive of amortization, is not permitted.
 
g)  
New accounting standards and pronouncements
 
Adopted in fiscal 2011
 
In October 2009, the FASB issued guidance now codified as ASC Topic 985, “Software”, to change the accounting model for revenue arrangements that include both tangible products and software elements. Under this guidance, tangible products containing software components and non-software components that function together to deliver the tangible product’s essential functionality are excluded from the software revenue guidance. In addition, hardware components of a tangible product containing software components are always excluded from the software revenue guidance. This guidance is effective prospectively for revenue arrangements entered into or materially modified in fiscal years beginning on or after June 15, 2010.
 
In October 2009, the FASB amended guidance now codified as Topic 605, “Revenue Recognition”, to include a consensus relating to multiple-deliverable revenue arrangements. These amendments significantly change certain guidance pertaining to revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables and modify the separation criteria of Topic 605 by eliminating the criterion for objective and reliable evidence of fair value for the undelivered products or services. The amendments also eliminate the use of the residual method of allocation and require, instead, that arrangement consideration be allocated, at the inception of the arrangement, to all deliverables based on their relative selling price. This guidance is effective for revenue arrangements entered into or materially modified in fiscal years beginning on or after June 15, 2010.
 
The company adopted Topics 985 and 605 on September 1, 2010, at the same time it adopted similar new requirements under Canadian GAAP (note 2); adoption of Topics 985 and 605 had no significant impact on its consolidated financial statements.
 
To be adopted after fiscal 2011
 
The company will cease to reconcile its consolidated financial statements to U.S. GAAP for the periods beginning on September 1, 2011 when it will start to apply as its primary basis of accounting the International Financial Reporting Standards published by the International Accounting Standards Board and set out in Part I of the CICA Handbook – Accounting. Consequently, future accounting changes to U.S. GAAP are not discussed in these consolidated financial statements as they will never be applied by the company.
 
 
 
 
EXFO Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
(tabular amounts in thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data and as otherwise noted)

 
Unaudited pro forma information on business combination
 
Under U.S. GAAP, pro forma information must be provided as though the business combination had occurred at the beginning of the reported periods.
 
The following unaudited pro forma information reflects the results of operations as if the 2010 acquisition had been completed on September 1, 2008:
 
   
Years ended August 31,
 
             
   
2010
   
2009
 
             
   
(unaudited)
 
             
Sales
  $ 220,621     $ 191,040  
Net earnings (loss)
  $ 2,119     $ (19,317 )
Basic and diluted net earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.04     $ (0.31 )
 
Sales and net loss of the acquired company since the acquisition date included in the consolidated statement of earnings for the year ended August 31, 2010 amounted to $14,483,000 and $1,999,000, respectively.
 
Such information is not necessarily indicative of the actual results which would have been achieved, nor is it necessarily indicative of future consolidated results of the company.

 
 
F-43